CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE INC
S-4/A, 2000-04-07
SECURITY & COMMODITY BROKERS, DEALERS, EXCHANGES & SERVICES
Previous: PRIMIS INC, S-1/A, 2000-04-07
Next: NORWEST ASSET SECURITIES CORP MORT PASS THR CERT SER 2000 1, 8-K, 2000-04-07



<PAGE>


   As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 7, 2000


                                                      Registration No. 333-95561

================================================================================

                                 UNITED STATES
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                              WASHINGTON, DC 20549

                                  ___________

                                Amendment No.3
                                      to
                                   FORM S-4

                             REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                        UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                                  ___________

                        CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE INC.
             (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

                                  ___________

<TABLE>
<S>                                                          <C>                          <C>
            Delaware                                         6231                               36-4340266
(State or other jurisdiction of                   (Primary Standard Industrial               (I.R.S. Employer
incorporation or organization)                    Classification Code Number)             Identification Number)
</TABLE>

                             30 South Wacker Drive
                            Chicago, Illinois 60606
                                 (312) 930-1000
  (Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code,
                 of registrant's principal executive offices)

                             Craig S. Donohue, Esq.
                   Senior Vice President and General Counsel
                             30 South Wacker Drive
                            Chicago, Illinois 60606
                                 (312) 930-1000
 (Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code,
                             of agent for service)

                                   copies to:
                            Richard W. Astle, Esq.
                                Sidley & Austin
                  Bank One Plaza -- 10 South Dearborn Street
                            Chicago, Illinois 60603
                                (312) 853-7270
                                  ___________

     Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As
promptly as practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective and
the satisfaction or waiver of certain other conditions under the Agreement and
Plan of Merger described herein.

     If the securities being registered on this Form are being offered in
connection with the formation of a holding company and there is compliance with
General Instruction G, check the following box. [_]

     If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering
pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and
list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective
registration statement for the same offering. [_]

     If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d)
under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act
registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement
for the same offering. [_]

     The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or
dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall
file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration
Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of
the Securities Act of 1933 or until the Registration Statement shall become
effective on such date as the Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a),
may determine.

================================================================================
<PAGE>

The information in this proxy statement and prospectus is not complete and may
be changed. We may not issue these securities until the registration statement
filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This proxy
statement and prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and we are not
soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any state where the offer or sale
is not permitted.

                  SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED APRIL 7, 2000

                                    [LOGO]

                          CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE

                          CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE
                             30 SOUTH WACKER DRIVE
                            CHICAGO, ILLINOIS 60606

                                April ___, 2000

Dear Member:

     I would like to invite you to attend a special members' meeting at which we
will consider a proposed "demutualization" of our organization in which we will
change from a not-for-profit membership corporation to a for-profit stock
corporation.

     As a result of the demutualization, shares of Class B common stock will be
issued to our members in series corresponding to our present membership
divisions. Each series will confer the trading privileges associated with the
membership interests that are converted into that series along with the
traditional features of common stock. In addition, shares of Class A common
stock will be issued only to CME, IMM and IOM members and will contain only the
traditional features of common stock. We have no current plans to list these
shares on an exchange. Additional information regarding the Class A and Class B
common stock is provided in this document under "Description of Capital Stock of
New CME."

     Our board unanimously approved the proposed demutualization and unanimously
recommends that you vote for its approval. The board believes that the
demutualization will better position us to compete in the rapidly changing and
consolidating financial services industry. We will have greater organizational
flexibility and will be able to raise additional equity capital, if needed. In
addition, we will be better able to grow and to continue to provide high quality
products and services to all our customers.

     Please review the attached document which provides important information
regarding the proposed demutualization. You should consider the matters
discussed under "Risk Factors" commencing on page 10 of the attached
document.

                                Sincerely,
                                Scott Gordon
                                Chairman of the Board
<PAGE>

The Securities and Exchange Commission and state securities regulators have not
approved or disapproved these securities, or determined if this proxy statement
and prospectus is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a
criminal offense.

     This proxy statement and prospectus is dated April __, 2000 and was first
mailed to members on or about April __, 2000.
<PAGE>

                          CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE
                             30 SOUTH WACKER DRIVE
                            CHICAGO, ILLINOIS 60606

        NOTICE OF SPECIAL MEMBERS MEETING TO BE HELD ON MAY ____, 2000

To the Members of the Chicago Mercantile Exchange:

     We will hold a special meeting of the members of the Chicago Mercantile
Exchange on ____________, May _____, 2000 at _____ p.m., Central Standard Time,
at 30 South Wacker Drive, Chicago, Illinois 60606, to consider and vote on an
agreement and plan of merger whereby we would become a Delaware stock
corporation by merging into a Delaware nonstock corporation and then merging
into a Delaware stock corporation. We will not transact any other business at
the special meeting.

     Only members owning memberships at the close of business on April __, 2000,
the record date for the special meeting, are entitled to notice of, and to vote
at, the special meeting and any adjournments or postponements of it. The merger
agreement requires approval by the affirmative vote of two-thirds of the votes
present and voted, either in person or by proxy, at the special meeting.

     For more information about the demutualization, please review the attached
document. The merger agreement is attached as Exhibit B.

     Whether or not you plan to attend the special meeting, please complete,
sign and date the enclosed proxy and return it promptly in the enclosed postage-
paid envelope. The giving of a proxy does not affect your right to vote in
person in the event that you attend the special meeting. In the absence of
specific direction, proxies will be voted "FOR" approval of the merger
agreement. Proxies that are marked both "FOR" and "AGAINST" will not count and
will not be treated as votes cast. Unsigned proxies will not be counted. Proxies
must be received at the Chicago Mercantile Exchange, Membership Department, 30
South Wacker Drive, Chicago, Illinois 60606 prior to the start of the meeting in
order to be counted.

     Your Board of Directors has carefully considered the proposed
demutualization and unanimously recommends that you vote "FOR" its approval.

                        By Order of the Board of Directors,

                        Craig S. Donohue

                        Managing Director of Business Development
                        and Corporate/Legal Affairs

April ___, 2000
<PAGE>

                               TABLE OF CONTENTS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                  Page
                                                                                                  ----
<S>                                                                                               <C>
SUMMARY OF DEMUTUALIZATION PROPOSAL..............................................................    1

RISK FACTORS.....................................................................................   10
   Risks Related to Demutualization..............................................................   10
   Risks Related to Our Business.................................................................   14
   Risks Related to Regulation and Litigation....................................................   19

INFORMATION REGARDING SPECIAL MEETING............................................................   20
   Persons Making the Solicitation...............................................................   20
   Time and Place of Special Meeting.............................................................   20
   Eligibility to Vote...........................................................................   21
   Available Votes; Quorum Required for Meeting..................................................   21
   Manner of Voting..............................................................................   21
   Required Vote.................................................................................   22
   Board Recommendation..........................................................................   22
   Methods of Solicitation of Proxies; Costs.....................................................   22

DEMUTUALIZATION PROPOSAL.........................................................................   22
   Reasons for Demutualization...................................................................   23
   Description of Demutualization Transaction....................................................   25
   Conversion of Membership Interests into Shares................................................   27
   Rights of Class B Common Stock................................................................   28
   Election of Board of Directors................................................................   28
   Differences in Ownership Rights...............................................................   30
   Required Regulatory Approvals.................................................................   32
   Amendment or Termination......................................................................   33
   Conditions to Effectiveness of the Demutualization Transactions...............................   33
   Effectiveness of the Demutualization Transactions.............................................   34
   Federal Income Tax Consequences...............................................................   34

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONDENSED
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS................................................................   35

CAPITALIZATION...................................................................................   39

DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK OF NEW CME..........................................................   40
   Description of Common Stock...................................................................   40
   Description of Additional Provisions of Class B Common Stock..................................   41
   Preferred Stock...............................................................................   44
   Transfer Restrictions.........................................................................   44
   Other Charter Provisions......................................................................   45
   Transfer Agent................................................................................   46
</TABLE>
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                               <C>
MANAGEMENT.......................................................................................  47
   Directors and Executive Officers..............................................................  47
   Director Compensation.........................................................................  55
   Committees of the Board of Directors..........................................................  55
   Limitation of Liability and Indemnification Matters...........................................  56
   Executive Compensation........................................................................  57
   Employee Benefit Plans........................................................................  59
   Employment-Related Agreements.................................................................  61
   Beneficial Ownership of Management............................................................  65

BUSINESS.........................................................................................  68
   Products......................................................................................  70
   Execution Facilities..........................................................................  76
   Clearing......................................................................................  79
   Market Data...................................................................................  83
   International Alliances.......................................................................  84
   Marketing Programs and Advertising............................................................  84
   Competition...................................................................................  84
   Our Members...................................................................................  86
   Other Business Relationships And Subsidiaries.................................................  88
   Intellectual Property.........................................................................  88
   Employees.....................................................................................  89
   Facilities....................................................................................  89
   Legal Proceedings.............................................................................  89
   Regulation....................................................................................  90

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION..............................................................  92

MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS............  92
   Historical Overview...........................................................................  92
   Results of Operations.........................................................................  95
   Financial Position............................................................................  97
   Liquidity and Capital Resources...............................................................  98
   Market Risk...................................................................................  99
   Accounting Standards.......................................................................... 100

EXPERTS.......................................................................................... 100

VALIDITY OF SECURITIES........................................................................... 100

EXHIBITS
</TABLE>
<PAGE>


     This document describes a proposed series of transactions in which the
existing Chicago Mercantile Exchange will be converted from a membership
organization into a Delaware stock corporation. For ease of reference in this
document, the existing membership organization has been referred to as the
"Exchange" or "Existing CME," and the Delaware stock corporation as "New CME."
The Exchange has four membership divisions, which are referred to in this
document as "CME," meaning members of the Chicago Mercantile Exchange division;
"IMM," meaning members of the International Monetary Market division; "IOM,"
meaning members of the Index and Option Market division; and "GEM," meaning
members of the Growth and Emerging Markets division. These membership divisions,
and their relative trading rights, are described under the subheading "Our
Members" in "Business." Finally, members of the GEM division hold both full and
fractional membership interests. These fractional interests must be combined
into full interests by November 3, 2000 or, under the Exchange's rules, they
will be combined by the Exchange and sold for cash. Because of this provision,
fractional GEM membership interests have been treated differently in the
proposed demutualization than have full GEM membership interests.
<PAGE>

                      SUMMARY OF DEMUTUALIZATION PROPOSAL

         This summary highlights information contained elsewhere in this
document. It does not contain all of the information which you should consider
before voting on the proposed demutualization and may not contain all of the
information that is important to your individual situation. Consequently, you
should read this entire document carefully.

Proposed Transaction

         We are proposing to convert Existing CME from an Illinois
not-for-profit membership corporation into a Delaware for-profit stockholder
corporation. As a result, you will become a stockholder of New CME.

         The demutualization will be effected in a three-step process. First,
our existing corporation will be merged into an intermediate Delaware nonstock
membership corporation, which we have formed called "CME Transitory Co." Second,
CME Transitory Co. will be merged into a Delaware stock corporation. Third, the
stock issued by the Delaware stock corporation in the second step merger will be
converted into shares of Class A and Class B common stock of the Delaware stock
corporation in a recapitalization. These steps are depicted in the following
chart.

         [Graphic: Three rectangular boxes aligned from left to right, with an
arrow silhouette pointing from the first to the second box and pointing from the
second to the third box. Inscribed in the first box is "Chicago Mercantile
Exchange (Illinois not-for-profit corporation)", inscribed in the second is "CME
Transitory Co. (Delaware nonstock corporation)", and inscribed in the third is
"Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc. (Delaware stock corporation)". Written above
the first arrow is the number "1" and below the arrow the phrases the phrases
"Merger" and "Membership Interests for Membership Interests". Written above the
second arrow is the number "2" and below the arrow the phrases "Merger" and
"Membership Interests for five classes of common stock". A third arrow
silhouette pointing to the right is set forth below the third box. Written above
the arrow is the number "3" and below the arrow the word "Recapitalization". The
arrow points to the phrase "Five classes of common stock converted into series
of Class B shares and, in the case of CME, IMM and IOM members, Class A
shares".]

         Immediately after the demutualization transactions are completed,
Exchange members will be the only stockholders of New CME.

Conversion of Membership Interests into Shares of Stock

         Existing memberships will be converted into shares of Class B common
stock of New CME and, in the cases of the CME, IMM and IOM memberships, shares
of Class A common stock. Both Class A and Class B shares will have the
traditional features of common stock; however, the primary purpose of the Class
B shares is to confer the trading privileges associated with the memberships in
Existing CME. Consequently, the Class B shares will be issued in four series
corresponding to those existing membership divisions, with a fifth series
corresponding to the GEM fractional membership interests. Each series will
confer the trading privileges associated with the membership interest that is
converted into that series. These conversions are illustrated below:

                                       1
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
    Distribution of Class A and B Shares By Individual Membership Interest
   ------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  Number of Shares to be Received Per Membership Interest
     Membership                                     Class B Shares
                                          ---------------------------------
      Division        Class A Shares          Number            Series
      --------        --------------          ------            ------
   <S>                <C>                 <C>                   <C>
        CME               16,200                1                 B-1
        IMM               10,800                1                 B-2
        IOM                5,400                1                 B-3
        GEM                                     1                 B-4
   GEM Fractions                                1                 B-5
</TABLE>

         The following table indicates the number of outstanding memberships and
members in each membership division of the Exchange. The tables below that table
indicate the relative distribution of shares of Class A and B common stock
following the demutualization:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                             Membership Divisions
   ------------------------------------------------------------------------
     Membership        Number of          Number of          Percentage of
      Division         Memberships         Members           Total Members
      --------         -----------         -------           -------------
   <S>                 <C>                <C>                <C>
        CME                625                512                 15.3%
        IMM                813                676                 20.3
        IOM              1,287              1,026                 30.8
        GEM*               253                217                  6.5
   GEM Fractions*        2,140                902                 27.1
   ------------------------------------------------------------------------
                         5,118              3,333                100.0%
                       ====================================================
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
          Distribution of Class A and B Shares By Membership Division
   ------------------------------------------------------------------------
     Membership    Aggregate Class A      Class A        Aggregate Class B
      Division          Shares           Percentage            Shares
      --------          ------           ----------            ------
   <S>             <C>                   <C>             <C>
        CME         10,125,000              39.1%               625
        IMM          8,780,400              34.0                813
        IOM          6,949,800              26.9              1,287
        GEM*                                                    253
   GEM Fractions*                                             2,140
   ------------------------------------------------------------------------
                    25,855,200             100.0%             5,118
                    ==========             =====              =====
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                   Distribution of Relative Equity by Membership Division
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                             Equivalent       Total Equity      Percentage of
                                           Class A Shares    (expressed in          Equity
Membership          Class A    Class B     Represented by      equivalent        Distributed to
 Division           Shares     Series     Class B Shares**  Class  A shares)       Members
 --------           ------     ------     ----------------  ----------------       -------
<S>               <C>          <C>        <C>               <C>                 <C>
 CME              10,125,000     B-1         1,125,000         11,250,000            39.1%
 IMM               8,780,400     B-2           975,600          9,756,000            33.9
 IOM               6,949,800     B-3           772,200          7,722,000            26.8
 GEM*                            B-4            25,300             25,300             0.1
 GEM Fractions*                  B-5            21,400             21,400             0.1
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 Total            25,855,200                 2,919,500         28,774,700           100.0%
                  ==========                 =========         ==========           =====
</TABLE>

___________________

*  Each Class B share is treated as representing a specified number of Class A
   shares for purposes of dividends, liquidating distributions and voting on
   matters on which holders of Class A and Class B shares vote together. See
   "Class A Equivalence" below.

** Based upon outstanding GEM fractions as of December 31, 1999. The conversion
   of additional GEM fractions into full GEM membership interests prior to the
   effectiveness of the demutualization will reduce the number of series B-5
   shares issued and increase the number of series B-4 shares actually
   issued.

                                       2
<PAGE>

Description of Class B Shares to be Received

         The following table summarizes several features of the Class B shares
that will be issued to members in the demutualization:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           Number of Votes on            Equivalent Class A Shares
                                                              "Core Rights"                Represented by Series
                                                           ------------------            -------------------------
                                          Number of                                                     As Percentage
             Maximum                      Directors                As Percentage                        of Aggregate
             Number of      Trading         Series       Per        of Aggregate       Number of           Class A
Series       Shares        Privileges     Can Elect     Share      Class B Vote*         Shares          Equivalents
- ------       -------       ----------     ---------     -----      -------------       -----------       -----------
<S>         <C>            <C>            <C>           <C>       <C>                  <C>              <C>
  B-1         625             CME             3              6          55.7%            1,125,000            3.9%
  B-2         813             IMM             2              2          24.1               975,600            3.4
  B-3       1,287             IOM             1              1          19.1               772,200            2.7
  B-4         253             GEM*            0            1/6           0.6                25,300            0.1
  B-5       2,140             GEM             0           1/60           0.5                21,400            0.1
                           Fractions*
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
            5,118                             6                        100.0%            2,919,500           10.2%
            =====                         =========                =============       ===========       ===========
</TABLE>

_______________________
*    Based upon outstanding GEM fractions as of December 31, 1999. The
     conversion of additional GEM fractions into full GEM membership interests
     prior to the effectiveness of the demutualization will reduce the number of
     series B-5 shares issued and increase the number of series B-4 shares
     actually issued.

          Election of Directors. New CME's board of directors will ultimately
consist of 19 directors. Holders of series B-1, B-2 and B-3 shares will have the
right to elect the number of directors set forth in the table. Holders of all
series of Class B shares will have the right, voting together with holders of
the Class A shares, to elect the remaining 13 directors. See "Board of
Directors" below for more information.

          "Core Rights." New CME's charter grants solely to holders of Class B
shares the right to approve changes to specified "rights" associated with the
trading privileges conferred by those shares. Those rights, referred to as "Core
Rights" in the charter and this document, consist of:

          .    the allocation of products which a holder of a series of Class B
               shares is permitted to trade on New CME's exchange facilities
          .    the trading floor access rights and privileges which a holder of
               a series of Class B shares has, including the circumstances under
               which New CME can determine that an existing open outcry-traded
               product will no longer be traded by means of open outcry
          .    the number of authorized and issued shares of any series of Class
               B shares
          .    the eligibility requirements to hold shares of a series of Class
               B shares or to exercise the associated trading rights or
               privileges

As indicated in the table, votes on changes to Core Rights are weighted by
series. Changes to Core Rights must be approved by a majority of the votes cast
by the holders of the Class B shares. Due to the weighted voting, this statement
means that a change to Core Rights may be effected by the approval of the
holders of the series B-1 shares even though the holders of the other series
voted against the change. This result is consistent with the result that would
be

                                       3
<PAGE>

obtained under the Exchange's existing rules and procedures. Holders of Class A
shares do not have the right to vote on changes to Core Rights.

          Class A Equivalence. Each Class B share is treated as representing the
number of Class A shares specified in the table above for purposes of:

          .    voting on matters on which holders of Class A and B shares vote
               together, including the election of 13 directors

          .    the receipt of dividends if, and when, declared by the board

          .    the receipt of liquidating distributions if New CME is liquidated
               and dissolved

Shares of Class B common stock will represent approximately 10% of the
outstanding equity of New CME following the demutualization. Consequently, the
voting privileges of the Class B shares will not have any significant impact on
matters put to a vote that includes both the Class A and B stockholders. Class A
stockholders do not have the right to vote on Core Rights or in the election of
the six directors to be elected by the series of Class B shares. For information
regarding the method by which Class A equivalence was determined, see "Factors
Considered in Arriving at Allocation Methodology" under the subheading "Reasons
for Demutualization" under "Demutualization Proposal" below.

          Series B-5 Shares. The series B-5 shares will be issued to holders of
GEM fractional membership interests. Each GEM fractional membership interest
represents one-tenth of a full GEM membership interest and will be converted
into one series B-5 share. There were 2,140 GEM fractional membership interests
outstanding as of December 31, 1999 held by 902 members. Series B-5 shares may
be converted into series B-4 shares by their holders at the ratio of ten series
B-5 shares for one series B-4 share. Individuals holding less than the necessary
ten shares may either sell their shares to another holder so that holder will
obtain the necessary ten shares, or purchase additional shares from other
holders to obtain the necessary ten shares. The process by which a holder may
purchase or sell series B-5 shares is expected to be similar to the process
currently followed for the purchase and sale of GEM fractions. In the event that
a holder does not convert his or her series B-5 shares on or before November 3,
2000, those shares will be converted automatically into shares of Class A common
stock at the rate of ten Class A shares for each series B-5 share.

Differences in Ownership Rights

          Following the demutualization, you will become a stockholder in a
Delaware corporation as opposed to a member in an Illinois not-for-profit
corporation. There are differences in your ownership rights that will result
from this change in structure that you should consider.

          Some of these differences arise from differences between the corporate
law applicable to Illinois not-for-profit corporations versus Delaware stock
corporations. These differences include the ability of Delaware corporation to
pay, and their stockholders to receive, dividends based upon earnings; the
availability under Delaware law of dissenters' rights in connection with mergers
or sales of all of the corporate assets; and the availability under Delaware law
of class voting for stockholders in the event that a charter amendment adversely
affects their rights.

                                       4
<PAGE>


          Some of these differences arise from choices that we have made in
drafting the charter and by-laws for New CME. These differences include our
decision to insert antitakeover provisions into the charter of New CME; changes
in the composition of our board; changes in the vote required to approve major
corporate transactions, including charter amendments, mergers and sales of all
of the corporate assets; and changes in liquidation rights.

          These differences are described under the subheading "Differences in
Ownership Rights" under "Demutualization Proposal."

Market for Shares; Stock Exchange Listing

          No market presently exists for either the Class A shares or the Class
B shares. We expect a market for the Class B shares will develop that is similar
to the current market for corresponding membership interests. The current
markets for CME, IMM, IOM and GEM membership interests, and for GEM fractional
membership interests, should facilitate the development of new markets for each
series of Class B shares. We expect that, over time, a market for Class A shares
will develop. We will undertake educational and promotional efforts to
communicate the value of Class A shares to holders of those shares and to
potential investors.

          We have no current plans to list either the Class A or B shares on a
stock exchange.

Transfer Restrictions

          Class B shares will not be subject to any transfer restrictions;
however, the exercise of the associated trading privileges will be subject to
compliance with our existing eligibility requirements for trading. Class A
shares will be subject to transfer restrictions, which will fall away over time.
For the first six months, Class A shares may be transferred only with the
associated Class B shares. Thereafter, an increasing portion of the Class A
shares (in 25% increments each three months) may be transferred to nonmembers.
After fifteen months, the Class A shares will not be subject to the transfer
restrictions.

Board of Directors

          Following the demutualization, the size of the board of directors will
be reduced from 39 to 30 directors at the December 2000 annual meeting of
stockholders, and further reduced to 19 at the December 2001 annual meeting of
stockholders. In addition, the manner in which the directors are nominated and
elected will change. These changes are illustrated in the table below.

                                       5
<PAGE>

                 Nomination and Election of Board of Directors

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ----------------------------------------------------            ------------------------------------------------------
                 Current Provisions                                               After Demutualization

  Number of    Candidates                                          Number of    Candidates
  Directors    Nominated By        Elected By                      Directors    Nominated By             Elected By
- ----------------------------------------------------            ------------------------------------------------------
<S>            <C>                 <C>                          <C>             <C>                      <C>
     12        CME Nominating      CME members                         3        Series B-1 Nominating    Series B-1
               Committee                                                        Committee                holders

      8        IMM Nominating      IMM members                         2        Series B-2 Nominating    Series B-2
               Committee                                                        Committee                holders

      4        IOM Nominating      IOM members                         1        Series B-3 Nominating    Series B-3
               Committee                                                        Committee                holders

      1        GEM Nominating      GEM members                         0
               Committee

     12        Chairman of         Board of Directors                  0
               the Board

      2        *                   *
                                                                      13        Board Nominating         Class A and B
                                                                                Committee                stockholders

- ----------------------------------------------------            ------------------------------------------------------
  Total  39                                                        Total 19
- ----------------------------------------------------            ------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

*    The Exchange's President serves as a non-voting member of the board. Leo
     Melamed serves as a non-voting member of the board.

The Exchange's directors serve staggered two-year terms and will continue to
serve as directors of New CME for the remainder of their present terms.
Directors of New CME will also serve staggered two-year terms. The reduction in
the size of the board will be implemented by electing fewer directors than the
directors whose terms expire. A listing of the present directors and when their
terms expire is set forth under the subheading "Directors and Executive
Officers" under "Management."

     The right of series B-1, B-2 and B-3 stockholders and Class A and B
stockholders to elect directors will be phased-in as the terms of the existing
directors expire. This phase-in is described in a table under the subheading
"Election of Board of Directors" under "Demutualization Proposal."

Federal Income Tax Consequences

     We are seeking a ruling from the Internal Revenue Service to the effect
that, for federal income tax purposes, you will not recognize any gain or loss
strictly as a result of receiving Class A common stock and Class B common stock
(or Class B common stock only for holders of GEM memberships or GEM fractional
membership interests) in conversion of your membership interest. Assuming this
nonrecognition treatment, the tax basis in your membership interest would
carryover to the stock received. If you received both Class A and Class B common
stock, your membership basis would be allocated between the two classes in
proportion to the relative fair market values of those shares at the time of the
demutualization.

                                       6
<PAGE>

Accounting Treatment

     The demutualization transaction will be treated in a manner similar to
"pooling-of-interests" accounting. Under this method of accounting, no gain or
loss will be recognized, and the assets and liabilities of Existing CME will
appear on the books of New CME at their same recorded amounts.

Risk Factors

     There are risks associated with the proposed demutualization that you
should consider. These and other risks are discussed under "Risk Factors" below.
These risks include our ability to implement in a timely and successful manner
changes to our organizational and managerial structure that are required in
order to operate in a manner that will enhance stockholder value. Although the
Exchange has a long history of operating as a successful member-owned
institution, changes will be required in the manner in which we evaluate and
undertake activities.

Reasons for Demutualization

    Your board believes that the change in our structure resulting from
demutualization will accomplish the following objectives:

     .    Improve our governance and managerial structure to facilitate more
          accelerated decision-making

     .    Change our financial decision-making model to emphasize stockholder
          value

     .    Create a catalyst for pursuing new business strategies

     .    Unlock members' equity values by allowing them to sell a portion of
          their interest in the Exchange, should they so desire

     .    Provide a signal and currency for working with strategic partners

Conditions to Demutualization

     The completion of the demutualization is subject to the following principal
conditions:

     .    Receipt of a favorable ruling from the Internal Revenue Service
          regarding the federal income tax consequences to our members and the
          Exchange of the contemplated transactions. We filed a ruling request
          on December 30, 1999.

     .    Completion of the cash purchase by Existing CME of the assets and
          business of P-M-T Limited Partnership, which requires the approval of
          the holders of two-thirds of the 4,786 Class A limited partnership
          units of that partnership, not including the 321 units held by the
          Exchange. P-M-T Limited Partnership provides electronic trading
          services for the Exchange and owns the GLOBEX(R) servicemark.

     .    Approval by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission of changes to our
          rules to reflect the demutualization. These approvals will be sought
          after the special meeting

                                       7
<PAGE>


          of members. These changes generally relate to the changes in our
          structure resulting from the conversion to a stock corporation and the
          fact that our existing rules will be reflected in the charter, by-laws
          and rules of New CME.


Our Business

     Founded in 1898, the Exchange provides facilities so that our members may
trade futures and options on futures contracts. These facilities include
physical floor trading facilities where our members may come together to trade
in a process known as "open outcry" and, through P-M-T Limited Partnership,
electronic trading facilities known as GLOBEX2. Members are able to trade
futures and options on futures contracts based upon interest rates, stock
indices, foreign currencies, agricultural commodities and other underlying
instruments and risk-based activities. We also match, clear, settle and
guarantee all transactions executed on the Exchange through the CME Clearing
House, and we engage in extensive regulatory, compliance, market surveillance
and financial supervision activities designed to ensure market integrity and
provide financial safeguards for users of our markets. Our offices are located
at 30 South Wacker Drive, Chicago, Illinois 60606, and our telephone number is
(312) 930-1000.

Absence of Appraisal or Dissenters' Rights

     Members who object to the demutualization will have no appraisal or
dissenters' rights under applicable law. Appraisal or dissenters' rights, if
available, would allow a member who voted against the proposal and followed a
prescribed statutory process, to receive a cash payment equal to the fair value
of the member's membership interest in the Exchange. If the demutualization
transaction is completed and regardless of whether you voted for or against it,
your membership interest will be converted into stock of New CME.

                                       8
<PAGE>

Selected Consolidated Financial Information

         Selected consolidated financial data is set forth below. The income
statement and balance sheet data are taken from the audited consolidated
financial statements of the Exchange. The results of prior periods are not
necessarily indicative of future results. This data should be read in
conjunction with the audited consolidated financial statements of the Exchange
and related notes, and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations" included toward the end of this document.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  Selected Consolidated Financial Data
                                                          (amounts in thousands)

                                                            As of or for the
                                                         Year Ended December 31,
                                              --------------------------------------------------
                                                 1999       1998      1997       1996      1995
                                                 ----       ----      ----       ----      -----
     <S>                                      <C>        <C>       <C>        <C>       <C>
     Income Statement Data:
     Total revenues                           $208,488   $195,216  $177,644   $164,212  $164,459
     Operating expenses                        201,844    181,023   158,586    151,803   149,689
     Other income (1)                               --         --        --     15,717        --
     Limited partners' interest in
      earnings of P-M-T Limited Partnership      2,126      2,849        --         --        --
     Net income                                  2,663      7,029     8,667     15,068     8,631


     Balance Sheet Data:
     Total assets                              301,703    293,205   348,732    243,754   199,733
     Current assets                            176,728    203,301   270,081    161,272   114,395
     Current liabilities                       109,953    110,670   180,210     83,584    57,780
     Long-term obligations and limited
        partners' interest in P-M-T             23,087     15,638     8,968      9,539     7,845
     Members' equity                           168,663    166,897   159,554    150,631   134,108

     Other Data:
     Total trading volume (round turn trades)  200,737    226,619   200,742    177,042   181,806
     GLOBEX trading volume                      16,135      9,744     4,388      2,018     1,326
     Open interest at period-end                 6,412      7,282     6,479      5,361     5,254
</TABLE>

     (1)  Consists of a 1996 return of contributions and interest from the CME
          Trust resulting from an agreement reached with the Internal Revenue
          Service over the deductibility of contributions made by the Exchange.

                                       9
<PAGE>

                                 RISK FACTORS

         Upon demutualization your existing membership interest will be
converted into shares of New CME. Although New CME will succeed to our existing
business, demutualization will change our business model from a membership-owned
non-stock organization to an investor-owned stock corporation. We expect that
this change in form will have a significant impact on us and on the risks of
owning us. You should carefully consider the following risk factors, together
with the other information in this document, before casting your vote or
executing your proxy.

Risks Related to Demutualization

 .  We have no internal experience, and little representative external
   experience, upon which to draw in operating as a for-profit enterprise.

         We have always operated as a not-for-profit corporation for the benefit
   of our members, where we have focused on delivering member benefits at
   reasonable cost. Internal experience would assist us in dealing with the
   problems of changing to, and operating as, a for-profit enterprise. The
   experience of others would assist us in identifying problems and possible
   solutions; however, there is little history or experience of U.S. futures
   exchanges with for-profit operations. Consequently, our transition to for
   profit operations will be subject to risks, expenses and difficulties which
   we cannot predict and may not be capable of handling in an efficient
   manner.

 .  Our new managers and staff may not be successful in running a for-profit
   entity.

         Our future success depends, in significant part, on our new chief
   executive officer and on his ability to utilize new and existing management
   and staff in the context of a for-profit corporation. Our success also
   depends on their ability to operate successfully an exchange and, in
   particular, an exchange that is transitioning to a for-profit structure. We
   can provide no assurance that our CEO, other members of management, and our
   employees, will be successful in running a for-profit entity. The new CEO may
   desire or need to recruit additional management or staff. We can provide no
   assurance that we can successfully recruit these persons.

 .  Our board's role will change over a long transition period, which may delay
   needed operational changes.

         Our board has historically been involved actively in the day-to-day
   functioning of our business. This role will change as management of New CME
   assumes greater responsibility for operations. Management will assume greater
   responsibility as the size of the board is reduced; however, the reduction
   will not be completed until December 2001. The timing of this role transition
   may slow changes in operations and procedures desired by management to
   operate a for-profit enterprise.

                                       10
<PAGE>

 .  The change in the board election process may reduce the direct influence of
   our members on the action of our board.

          Holders of Class B shares will elect 6 of 19 directors of New CME and
   will vote together with holders of Class A shares in the election of the
   remaining 13 directors. The voting power of the holders of the Class B
   shares, however, will represent only about 10% of the overall vote available
   to be cast for those 13 directors. Members of the Exchange will own 100% of
   the Class A shares following the demutualization; however, subsequent sales
   of Class A shares by their holders, as well as subsequent issuances and sales
   by New CME, will cause that percentage to fall.

 .  Other changes in our operating structure may diminish the influence of
   members and may affect their desire to remain members, which ultimately may
   affect our business.

         We are currently served by a large number of member-dominated
   committees. Our professional staff provides support to these committees but
   members generally retain decision-making authority. As part of the
   demutualization, we will eliminate many of these committees, convert some
   into advisory bodies and change the membership of other committees.
   Management will generally make decisions designed to enhance stockholder
   value, which may lead to operational decisions or outcomes with which members
   disagree. These changes may make us less attractive to our current members
   and clearing members and encourage them to conduct their business at, or seek
   membership in, another exchange. A loss or material diminishment of member
   trading activity could negatively impact liquidity and trading volumes in our
   products. A loss or material reduction in the number of our clearing member
   firms and the capital they provide to guarantee their trades and the trades
   of their customers could diminish the strength and attractiveness of our
   Clearing House and our markets.

 .  Our valuation of membership interests, and the assignment of relative equity
   values, contains an element of uncertainty.

          Our Board considered a number of factors in arriving at the relative
   equity values of the existing membership interests. Ultimately, the board
   based the assignment of those values on our prior 1987 experience with
   respect to the allocation of equity interest in P-M-T Limited Partnership.
   There are other equity allocation methods that might produce different
   results if applied, including prevailing market prices for membership
   interests, trading volumes, relative rights and other measures. The board
   considered these alternatives but determined that the chosen formula best
   accomplished a fair allocation of the equity values among the members. See
   the subheading "Legal Proceedings" under "Business" for information regarding
   claims made by several GEM members regarding the allocation of equity in the
   proposed demutualization.

 .  The absence of a prior public market limits our ability to predict whether,
   and to what extent, a public market will develop in our shares.

          Currently, there are no public holders of New CME's stock and no
   market for that stock. Further, we have not undertaken the traditional
   marketing activities associated with bringing

                                       11
<PAGE>


a company to the public markets, because we are not offering any shares to
outside investors, and have no current plans to list our shares on a stock
exchange. We do not know whether third parties will find our shares to be
attractive or whether firms will be interested in making a market in our stock.
Consequently, we cannot assure you that a trading market will develop or, if it
develops, how strong it may be.

 .  We can give no assurance that an orderly market in our common stock will
   develop.

         We have adopted transfer restrictions for the Class A shares, which
   will gradually expire over a fifteen-month period following the
   demutualization, in order to foster the development of an orderly market in
   our common stock. We cannot guarantee that these restrictions will achieve
   their intended purpose.

         If our stockholders sell a large number of Class A shares upon the
   expiration of some or all of the transfer restrictions, the market prices for
   our common stock could decline significantly. Additionally, the transfer
   restrictions that we have adopted will not restrict a sale to a single
   purchaser of Class A shares in conjunction with a simultaneous sale of the
   related Class B share, in part, to allow a clearing member firm to liquidate
   the full value of a member's interest in New CME if that member is in a
   deficit position. Any forced sales of Class A or B shares during the time in
   which an orderly market is being developed could negatively impact the market
   price for the shares.

 .  The market prices for our shares may fluctuate widely and trade at prices
   below the recent price of the membership that the shares replace.

         The market price of Class A and B shares received by you in the
   demutualization may fluctuate widely. Factors causing these fluctuations will
   include our perceived prospects, the prospects of the financial industry and
   exchanges in general, differences between our actual financial and operating
   results and those expected by investors and analysts, and changes in
   analysts' recommendations or projections. In addition, changes in general
   economic or market conditions and broad market fluctuations may influence the
   market prices for our stock. As a result, Class A and B shares may trade at
   prices significantly below the price of the membership for which they were
   exchanged. The value of Class B shares is likely to be driven primarily by
   the perceived value, and the demand for, the related trading privileges.

 .  The issuance of additional shares may dilute the market value of the shares
   we issue to you.

         New CME will have authorized but unissued Class A shares that may be
   issued at the discretion of New CME's board. If we issue a large number of
   Class A shares in connection with future acquisitions or otherwise, which
   fail to increase our overall value, your equity could be diluted and the
   market price of your shares could decline significantly. The board of New CME
   will consider the potential dilutive effects of any subsequent issuance of
   Class A shares in relation to the value generated or expected to be generated
   in connection with their issuance.

                                       12
<PAGE>

 .  Decisions made by management or the board of New CME, or changes in the
   business or operations of New CME, may negatively impact Class B stockholders
   or affect Class A and B stockholders differently.

         The conversion to a stockholder owned for-profit corporation will
   require management to make decisions and take actions designed to maximize
   profits and stockholder value. While holders of Class B shares will have
   protections with respect to Core Rights that may limit management's decision-
   making authority, management will nonetheless acquire substantial decision-
   making responsibility compared to Existing CME. It is possible that decisions
   or changes which benefit the value of Class A shares will negatively impact
   the value of Class B shares or, conversely, that decisions or changes which
   benefit the value of Class B shares will negatively impact the value of Class
   A shares.

 .  The exercise by Class B stockholders of their reserved rights could affect
   adversely the market price of the Class A shares.

         Class B stockholders will have the ability to preserve their trading
   rights through special approval rights. In addition, holders of series B-1,
   B-2 and B-3 shares will have the right to elect 6 of 19 directors, even
   though those holders only represent approximately 10% of the overall equity
   interest. Those directors will also participate in the nomination of
   additional directors and the election of a chairman. The special approval
   rights and, to a lesser degree, the election of directors, could be used to
   block changes that management desires to make to enhance stockholder
   value.

 .  Delaware law may protect decisions of New CME's board that have a different
   effect on Class A and B stockholders.

         Delaware law generally provides that a board of directors owes an equal
   duty to all stockholders, regardless of class or series, and does not have
   separate or additional duties to different groups of stockholders--subject to
   applicable provisions set forth in a company's charter. With respect to
   decisions not involving the Core Rights of Class B stockholders, you may not
   be able to challenge decisions that have an adverse effect on the value of
   your Class A or B shares if our board acts in a disinterested, informed
   manner with respect to these decisions, in good faith and in the belief that
   it is acting in the best interests of our stockholders.

 .  Effects of antitakeover provisions that we have inserted in the governing
   documents of New CME could enable the board to prevent or delay a change of
   control of New CME and adversely affect market value.

         We have inserted antitakeover provisions into the charter and by-laws
   of New CME. These provisions, along with provisions of Delaware law, could,
   together or separately:

         .  discourage potential acquisition proposals;
         .  delay or prevent a change in control; and
         .  limit the price that investors might be willing to pay in the future
            for shares of our common stock.

                                       13
<PAGE>


   These antitakeover provisions are described under the subheading "Other
   Charter Provisions" under "Description of Capital Stock of New CME."

 .  Not paying dividends can have an adverse effect on the stock price.

         We do not anticipate paying dividends on our shares in the foreseeable
   future. This decision may affect the market price of our stock to the extent
   that it causes investors seeking current income in the form of dividends not
   to purchase our stock.


Risks Related to Our Business

 .  Our decision to operate both pit-based, open outcry trading systems and
   electronic trading systems may adversely affect our operating costs and our
   markets.

         It may be expensive to continue operating two trading systems for the
   same product. Substantial expenses and delays may be caused by efforts to
   create trading links between the separate trading platforms. Any loss of
   efficiency or increase in time to market of new or improved products could be
   detrimental to our business plans in a highly competitive market. Further, if
   both trading methods continue, liquidity on each may be less than the
   liquidity on a competitive unified trading platform.

 .  Our trading volumes could be adversely affected if our customers prefer
   conducting business on a mutual exchange.

         The success of our business depends, in part, on our ability to
   maintain and increase our trading volume by maintaining and expanding our
   product offering and our customer base. Our success also depends on our
   ability to offer competitive prices and services in an increasingly price
   sensitive business. We cannot assure you that we will be able to continue to
   expand our product lines, or that we will be able to retain our current
   customers. We also cannot assure you that we will not lose customers to low-
   cost competitors with comparable or potentially superior products. If we fail
   to expand our product line or lose current customers, our ability to realize
   our financial objectives will be adversely affected.

 .  Our status as a for-profit enterprise may intensify competition we face from
   our member firms and other entities.

         As a mutual company, we provide services to our member firms without
   seeking a profit. With the advent of a for-profit enterprise, those firms may
   seek to internalize some functions that we presently perform or may to
   establish and use exchanges in which they have a more substantial ownership
   interest. A number of our member firms are substantially larger than us and
   have greater resources. In addition, many of our competitors and potential
   competitors are more established, have more financial resources and have
   greater marketing capabilities and technological and personnel resources.
   These factors may enable them to develop similar products, to provide better
   transaction costs and execution, and to carry out their business strategies
   faster. We expect that competition will increase in the future.

                                       14
<PAGE>


 .  Our market data fees may be reduced or eliminated by the growth of electronic
   trading and electronic order entry systems.

         Electronic trading systems do not usually impose distinct charges for
   supplying market data to trading terminals. If we follow that business model
   and trading terminals with access to our markets become widely available, we
   can expect to lose quote fee revenue from those persons who have access to
   trading terminals. We may experience a reduction in our revenues if we are
   unable to recover that lost revenue through terminal usage fees or
   transaction fees.

 .  The value of our skill set and assets for operating a physical exchange may
   be lost if futures trading migrates to electronic trading systems.

         We own and lease significant assets devoted to operating a physical,
   open outcry exchange. Many of those assets will have little or no residual
   value if futures trading migrates to an electronic trading system. Our skill
   at operating a complex physical exchange is also a significant asset that
   would be lost in that migration. The competitive advantages that we own by
   reason of these assets may be eroded by a transfer of trading activity to an
   electronic trading system. The costs associated with those leases and
   disposition of those assets may hurt profitability.

 .  The number and quality of companies providing electronic transaction services
   in competition with us may increase significantly.

         Our current and prospective competitors are numerous and include
   securities exchanges, futures exchanges, market data and information vendors,
   electronic communications networks, crossing systems and similar entities,
   consortia of large customers and some of our clearing member firms, and
   interdealer brokerage firms. Two other significant U.S. futures exchanges are
   in the process of demutualizing, which may intensify competition for
   electronic transaction services.

         Securities exchanges are planning to expand into derivative transaction
   services. The existing option exchanges may expand their electronic
   transaction services. A new electronic option exchange also has been licensed
   by the SEC.

         We may also face competition from computer software companies, and
   media and technology companies. The number of businesses providing Internet-
   related financial services is rapidly growing, and other companies have
   entered into or are forming joint ventures or consortia to provide services
   similar to those provided by us.

 .  We may not effectively manage our growth.

         Growth in our business may place a significant strain on our
   management, personnel, systems and resources. We will need to continue to
   improve our operational and financial systems and managerial controls and
   procedures, and to continue to expand, train and manage our technology
   workforce. We will need to maintain close coordination among our

                                       15
<PAGE>


   technology, compliance, accounting, finance, marketing and sales
   organizations. We cannot assure you that we will manage this growth
   effectively, and failure to do so could have a material adverse effect on our
   business, financial condition and operating results.

 .  We cannot predict our future capital needs or our ability to secure
   additional financing.

         We anticipate, based on management's experience and current industry
   trends, that our existing cash resources will be sufficient to meet our
   anticipated working capital and capital expenditure requirements for at least
   the next twelve months. However, we may need to raise additional funds to:

         .     support more rapid growth;
         .     develop new or enhanced services and products;
         .     respond to competitive pressures;
         .     acquire or develop complementary technologies; and
         .     respond to unanticipated requirements.

   We cannot assure you that we will be able to obtain additional financing on
   acceptable terms.

 .  Adverse economic and political conditions may cause declines in the global
   financial markets and adversely affect our operating results.

         The global financial services business is, by its nature, risky and
   volatile and is directly affected by many national and international factors
   that are beyond our control. Any one of these factors may cause a substantial
   decline in the U.S. and global financial services markets, resulting in
   reduced trading volume. These events could materially adversely affect our
   business. These factors include:

         .  economic and political conditions in the United States and
            elsewhere in the world;
         .  concerns over inflation and wavering institutional/consumer
            confidence levels;
         .  the availability of cash for investment by mutual funds and other
            wholesale and retail investors; and
         .  legislative and regulatory changes.

 .  Failures in our computer and communications systems and capacity constraints
   could harm our reputation and our business.

         We rely and expect to continue to rely on third parties for various
   computer and communications systems, such as telephone companies, on-line
   service providers, data processors, clearance organizations and software and
   hardware vendors. Failures in our systems or those of our third party
   providers could cause:

         .  unanticipated service disruptions;
         .  slower response times and delays in trade execution;
         .  decreased customer satisfaction;
         .  incomplete or inaccurate accounting, recording or processing of
            trades;

                                       16
<PAGE>


         .  financial losses;
         .  security breaches; and
         .  customer claims, litigation and regulatory sanctions.

   We cannot assure you that we will not experience system failures, outages or
   interruptions that negatively impact our business. Any failure that causes an
   interruption in service or decreases our responsiveness, including failures
   caused by customer error or misuse of our systems, could impair our
   reputation, damage our brand name and have a material adverse effect on our
   business, financial condition and operating results. A failure to monitor or
   maintain our computer systems and network services or, if necessary, to find
   a replacement for our technology in a timely and cost-effective manner, could
   affect materially and adversely our reputation, business, financial condition
   and operating results.

 .  We may not be able to keep up with rapid technological changes.

         To remain competitive, we need to continue to enhance and improve the
   responsiveness, functionality, accessibility and features of our proprietary
   software, network distribution systems and other technologies. The financial
   services and e-commerce industries are characterized by rapid technological
   change, changes in use and customer requirements and preferences, frequent
   product and service introductions embodying new technologies and the
   emergence of new industry standards and practices that could render our
   existing proprietary technology and systems obsolete. Our success will
   depend, in part, on our ability to:

         .  develop or license leading technologies useful in our business;
         .  enhance our existing services;
         .  develop new services and technology that address the increasingly
            sophisticated and varied needs of our existing and prospective
            clients; and
         .  respond to technological advances and emerging industry standards
            and practices on a cost-effective and timely basis.

     We cannot assure you that we will successfully implement new technologies
     or adapt our proprietary technology and transaction-processing systems to
     customer requirements or emerging industry standards. We cannot assure you
     that we will be able to respond in a timely manner to changing market
     conditions or customer requirements, and a failure to respond could have a
     material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and operating
     results.

 .  Our financial position could be adversely impacted by a clearing member
   default.

         We insure contract performance for all transactions in our products.
   Upon acceptance of a contract, we are substituted as the counter-party to
   each trade and we provide a financial guarantee of performance. Each of our
   clearing member firms, in turn, provides a financial guarantee to our
   Clearing House for all transactions executed by persons trading through that
   clearing member. Although we maintain significant financial resources and
   safeguards, we cannot assure you that we will not be adversely affected by a
   clearing member default. A clearing member default could severely and
   negatively impact our reputation, business, financial condition and operating
   results.

                                       17
<PAGE>


 .  Our existing and future revenues depend upon maintaining current volume
   levels in Eurodollar and S&P 500(R) futures and options contracts and in our
   foreign currency Exchange-for-Physicals ("EFP") market.

         Clearing fees account for approximately 70% of our total revenues.
   Approximately 37% of clearing fees are attributable to transactions in
   Eurodollar futures and options contracts, approximately 24% are attributable
   to transactions in S&P 500 futures and options contracts, and approximately
   27% are attributable to foreign currency EFP transactions. Any significant
   decline in our trading volumes in these products or markets could negatively
   impact our business, financial condition and operating results.

 .  Our prospects are subject to risks, expenses and uncertainties encountered by
   companies in the new and rapidly evolving market with and for electronic
   transaction services.

         These risks include our failure or inability to:

         .  provide reliable and cost-effective services to our customers;
         .  attract independent software vendors to write front-end software
            that effectively accesses our electronic trading and automated
            order-routing systems;
         .  match prices or offer trade execution alternatives provided by
            competitors operating under more favorable regulations;
         .  increase the number of devices (trading and order routing terminals)
            capable of sending orders to our floor and to our electronic trading
            system;
         .  increase awareness of our brand or market positioning; and
         .  respond to technological developments or service offerings by
            competitors.

   If we are not successful, our business or future financial condition or
   operating results could suffer.

 .  Our marketing and strategic alliances may not generate increased trading in
   our electronic marketplaces.

         We have entered into strategic alliances with exchanges and
   clearinghouses in order to increase client access to and use of our
   electronic platforms. The success of these relationships will depend, in
   part, on the amount of increased trading in our products generated by the
   members and customers of these partners. These arrangements may not generate
   the expected increased trading volume we are seeking. In addition, these
   alliances may constrain our resources and limit our ability to pursue other
   strategic and business initiatives.

                                       18
<PAGE>

Risks Related to Regulation and Litigation

 .  The existing legal framework for our industry may be modified to lower entry
   costs of competitors.

         The existing legal and regulatory structure of the futures industry has
   discouraged new entrants. A consensus is growing among legislators and
   regulators that the Commodity Exchange Act ("CEA") should be modified by
   amendment or administrative exemption to facilitate over-the-counter
   derivative transactions and the development of other transaction execution
   facilities with lesser regulatory compliance requirements and lesser levels
   of regulatory oversight. These facilities may be authorized to compete for
   our major customers and may take volume or place competitive pressure on the
   fees we are able to charge.

 .  We may not be able to maintain our self regulatory responsibilities.

         Some financial services regulators have publicly stated their concerns
   about the ability of a financial exchange, organized as a for-profit
   corporation, to discharge adequately its self-regulatory responsibilities. We
   believe our regulatory programs and capabilities contribute significantly to
   our brand name and reputation. Although we believe that we will retain these
   responsibilities, we cannot assure you that we will not be required to modify
   or restructure our regulatory functions in order to address these concerns.
   If we are required to rely on a third party to perform regulatory and
   oversight functions, we may incur substantial expenses and suffer severe harm
   to our reputation if the regulatory services are inadequate.

 .  We face regulatory burdens and obstacles in securing permission from foreign
   regulatory and governmental authorities to allow foreign entities and
   individuals to access and trade on our GLOBEX2 system from foreign locations.


         The placement of GLOBEX2 terminals, and the provision of access to our
   GLOBEX2 system from foreign locations, typically requires permission or
   authorization from foreign regulatory and governmental authorities. These
   permissions and authorizations can be difficult and/or time-consuming to
   acquire. We cannot assure you that we will be successful in expanding global
   access to our GLOBEX2 markets. We have received permission to place GLOBEX2
   terminals in the U.K., Japan and various other major world financial centers.


 .  Litigation risks are significant to financial service providers such as the
   Exchange.

         Many aspects of our business involve substantial risks of liability.
   Dissatisfied customers frequently make claims regarding quality of trade
   execution, improperly settled trades, mismanagement or even fraud against
   their service providers. We may become subject to these claims as the result
   of failures or malfunctions of systems and services provided by us. We could
   incur significant legal expenses defending claims, even those without merit.
   Although the CEA and our Commodities Futures Trading Commission ("CFTC")-
   approved disclaimer and limitation of liability rules offer us some
   protections, an adverse resolution of any lawsuits or claims against us could
   have a material adverse effect on our reputation,

                                       19
<PAGE>


   business, financial condition and operating results.

         In addition, we may also become subject to legal proceedings and claims
   as a result of the demutualization transactions. See the subheading "Legal
   Proceedings" under "Business" for information regarding claims made by
   several GEM members regarding the allocation of equity in the proposed
   demutualization.

 .  Any infringement by us on patent rights of others could result in litigation
   and could affect our operations.

         Our competitors as well as other companies and individuals may obtain,
   and may be expected to obtain in the future, patents that concern products or
   services related to the types of products and services we offer or plan to
   offer. We cannot assure you that we are or will be aware of all patents
   containing claims that may pose a risk of infringement by our products and
   services. In general, if one or more of our products or services were to
   infringe patents held by others, we may be required to stop developing or
   marketing the products or services, to obtain licenses to develop and market
   the services from the holders of the patents or to redesign the products or
   services in such a way as to avoid infringing on the patent claims. If we
   were unable to obtain such licenses, we may not be able to redesign our
   products or services to avoid infringement, which could materially adversely
   affect our business, financial condition and operating results.

 .  Employee or member misconduct could harm us and is difficult to detect.

         There have been a number of highly publicized cases involving fraud or
   other misconduct by employees in the financial services industry in recent
   years, and we run the risk that employee misconduct could occur. Misconduct
   by employees could include concealing from us unauthorized or unsuccessful
   activities. In either case, this type of conduct could result in unknown and
   unmanaged risks or losses. Similarly, we run the risk that members and other
   persons who use our markets will engage in fraud or other misconduct, which
   could result in regulatory sanctions and serious reputational harm. It is not
   always possible to deter misconduct, and the precautions we take to prevent
   and detect this activity may not be effective in all cases.


                     INFORMATION REGARDING SPECIAL MEETING

Persons Making the Solicitation

         The proxy solicitation represented by this document is being made on
behalf of the board of directors of the Exchange.

Time and Place of Special Meeting

         The special meeting will be held on __________, May __, 2000 at _____
p.m., Central Standard Time, at 30 South Wacker Drive, Chicago, Illinois 60606.


                                       20
<PAGE>

Eligibility to Vote

         You are eligible to vote at the special meeting only if you owned a
membership in the Exchange at the close of business on April __, 2000, which is
the record date for the special meeting.

Available Votes; Quorum Required for Meeting

         On the record date for the special meeting, we had 625 CME memberships,
813 IMM memberships, 1,287 IOM memberships, 253 GEM memberships and 2,140 GEM
fractional memberships. Under our rules, CME members will have six votes for
each CME membership owned, IMM members will have two votes for each IMM
membership owned, IOM members will have one vote for each IOM membership owned,
GEM members will have one-sixth vote for each full GEM membership owned, and
owners of GEM fractional membership interests will have one-sixtieth vote for
each GEM fractional membership interest owned. The presence in person or by
proxy of 250 members shall constitute a quorum for the consideration of the
proposal at the meeting. For the purpose of determining the presence of a
quorum, each member who is present in person or by proxy is counted only once
regardless of the number of membership interests that he or she holds.

Manner of Voting

         You may vote on the demutualization proposal by attending, in person or
by proxy, the special meeting and registering your vote. You may also complete
the enclosed proxy to register your vote on the proposal. You may revoke your
proxy at any time before it is voted at the meeting. You may revoke it in any of
three ways:

         .   By sending written notice to Ms. Ann Cresce, Acting Director, CME
             Membership Department, 30 South Wacker Drive, Chicago, Illinois
             60606;

         .   By signing a later dated proxy; or

         .   By attending the meeting and voting in person.

         Attendance at the meeting will not automatically revoke your proxy. All
membership interests represented by properly executed and unrevoked proxies
received in the accompanying form in time for the meeting will be voted at the
meeting or at any adjournment of the meeting.

         You may vote for, against or abstain on the demutualization proposal,
although an abstention has the legal effect of voting against the proposal. To
vote using the enclosed proxy, you should indicate your vote on the
demutualization proposal by checking FOR, AGAINST or ABSTAIN. A proxy received
without an indication of the manner in which it is to be voted will be voted FOR
approval of the demutualization proposal. A ballot which has more than one box
marked will not be valid and will not be regarded as a vote cast. You must sign
and date your proxy, and return it in the postage-paid envelope enclosed with
this mailing. You can also mail or deliver your completed proxy to Ms. Ann
Cresce, Acting Director, CME Membership

                                       21
<PAGE>

Department, 30 South Wacker Drive, Chicago, Illinois 60606. Your proxy must be
received prior to the start of the meeting in order to be counted.

         To obtain a replacement proxy, please call Ms. Ann Cresce, Acting
Director, CME Membership Department, at (312) 930-3488, between the hours of
7:00 a.m. and 5:00 p.m., Central Standard Time.

Required Vote

         The proposal will require the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds
of the votes present and voted either in person or by proxy for approval.

         Directors and officers of the Exchange hold memberships entitling them
to cast an aggregate of 143.63 votes on the proposal, representing 2.13% of the
total membership votes that may be cast.

Board Recommendation

         Your board unanimously recommends that you vote FOR the
demutualization.

Methods of Solicitation of Proxies; Costs

         The cost of soliciting proxies will be borne by the Exchange. In
addition to solicitation by mail, our directors, officers and employees may
solicit proxies in person or by telephone.


                           DEMUTUALIZATION PROPOSAL

         Your board of directors unanimously believes that it is in the best
interests of the Exchange and its members to change its corporate structure from
a member-owned not-for-profit corporation to a stockholder-owned for-profit
corporation.

         This belief is founded on the results of a year-long process in which
demutualization was examined. Last year, the board adopted a five-point plan to
improve the operation of the Exchange--including an element regarding
demutualization. Since that time, the Strategic Planning Committee of the board
has studied the structure of possible transactions to effect the conversion to a
for-profit corporation and considered a number of the issues posed by those
transactions. Based upon those studies and considerations, the Strategic
Planning Committee developed and recommended to the board a plan to effect the
demutualization. This plan was then unanimously approved by the board.

         It is intended that the demutualization transaction will not have any
adverse federal income tax consequences to our members. We have applied for a
ruling from the Internal Revenue Service to confirm these intentions, and the
completion of the demutualization transaction is conditioned, among other
conditions, upon the receipt of this ruling. No gain or loss will be recognized
by the Exchange for Federal income tax purposes as a result of the
demutualization.

                                       22
<PAGE>

Reasons for Demutualization

         The financial and risk management markets in which we operate are
experiencing significant and rapid changes. These changes are largely due to
advances in technology, a relaxation of regulatory barriers and resultant cost
efficiencies. Computer and telecommunications systems today can efficiently and
economically bring buyers and sellers together in ways that present new
challenges to the traditional exchange model of centralized physical auction
markets. The Internet and proprietary networks are changing investor behavior
and revolutionizing how investors interface with financial markets. Other
technological innovations are reducing the costs and barriers to entry for
alternative exchange-type systems.

         The traditional exchange model is undergoing a significant
transformation with the emergence of electronic trading technologies.
Technological innovations and reduced regulatory burdens in the global financial
markets have lowered barriers to entry, have created new competitors, and are
encouraging traditional exchanges to modernize their operations. In order to
achieve the necessary economies of scale and remain competitive in a
low-price/high-volume environment, consolidation among exchanges and financial
intermediaries is likely to continue. With respect to exchanges, large market
users are expected to continue to seek more efficient trading, processing and
clearing facilities. Although these users currently justify membership in
multiple exchanges and clearing organizations, they are likely to concentrate
their business activity in those exchanges and clearing organizations that offer
standardized systems, a full spectrum of financial products that can be traded
and cleared through a single entity, and low operating costs and capital
efficiencies for member intermediaries.

         Notwithstanding these changes and increased competitive activity, the
board believes that Existing CME is well-positioned in today's marketplace to
preserve and enhance our position. The board also believes, however, that we
will be better able to respond to this competition if we are reorganized as a
commercially-operated enterprise with a true oversight board and a team of
professional business managers. These managers will leverage the substantial
existing assets and strengths of Existing CME into new business strategies
designed to maximize stockholder returns.

         Objectives of Demutualization.  We have identified five major
 objectives to be achieved by demutualization:

     .   Improved Governance and Managerial Structure

              The traditional distinctions between our activities and the
         activities of our members and clearing members are becoming
         increasingly blurred. On the one hand, members and clearing members
         decide our affairs; while on the other hand, some of them compete
         directly with us by developing off-exchange products and business and
         by joining alternative market initiatives. Our board believes that
         demutualization will enable management to reduce the impact of these
         conflicts and to increase our enterprise value for the benefit of our
         equity owners.

              Increasingly, our competitors are for-profit companies operating
         with a singular purpose to maximize stockholder value. Our board
         believes that demutualization will

                                       23
<PAGE>

         create a governance and management structure that is more agile and
         swift in its ability to respond to competition. Management of the
         demutualized entity will be free to make decisions regarding listing
         contracts electronically if they will be more successful in that forum,
         changing clearing and transaction fees when appropriate, or expanding
         our existing product and service offerings.

     .   Improved Financial Decision-Making Model

              Our board believes that changing to a for-profit model will result
         in improved financial decision-making to enhance stockholder value. For
         example, management of the demutualized entity will judge investments
         and expenditures on, among other reasons, the basis of stockholder
         return. Commercial decision-making will diminish political member
         influences. Commercial pricing of services and a profit-making
         objective will ensure that resources are allocated to those business
         initiatives and ventures that enhance, or have the potential to
         enhance, stockholder value. Our ability to obtain financing at
         favorable rates will depend on whether lenders believe we are investing
         prudently.

     .   Create a Catalyst for Pursuing New Business Strategies

              Continuing financial innovation and demand for new risk management
         and derivative products are fueling global growth in exchange-traded
         and over-the-counter products. To capitalize on this potential, we may
         need to attract outside investment, further expand our current
         technology platforms, and broaden our product and service offerings.

     .   Unlock Members' Equity Values

              Our owners are a heterogeneous group with different economic
         interests. During the last several years, and prior to the recent
         increases in seat prices and lease rates, many of our retired owners
         experienced substantial declines in their seat values and, hence,
         income from leasing. These owners are generally less interested in
         member opportunity on the floor and more interested in maintaining
         their asset values and deriving income from their assets. In this
         sense, many of these owners already have begun to look more like
         traditional stockholders than exchange members. Demutualization will
         unlock the equity value in a membership and allow our management to
         provide stockholder returns to these members.

              Many of our members are interested in selling only a portion of
         their interest in the Exchange. Under the existing structure, these
         members have been unable to do so because they cannot sell less than an
         entire membership or seat. Demutualization will allow members to sell
         only a portion of their interest in New CME (i.e., all of their Class B
         shares or all or a portion of their Class A shares).

     .   Provide a Signal and a Currency for Working with Strategic Partners

              Our board believes that technology firms, as well as firms
         interested in acquiring an equity stake in us, will have a strong
         preference for working with a demutualized

                                       24
<PAGE>

         corporation, rather than a member-owned mutual organization. The board
         believes that we will benefit from entering into strategic alliances
         with partners or investors who can provide technology and capital
         resources. Demutualization and conversion of memberships into shares
         will create a valuable currency for working with these partners,
         facilitating our ability to enter into these transactions in the
         future.

         Factors Considered in Arriving at Allocation Methodology.  The board
approved the allocation of equity, as represented by the Class A shares and the
equity component or Class A equivalence of the Class B shares, in connection
with its approval of the demutualization. This approval was based upon the
recommendation delivered by the Strategic Planning Committee as well as the
board's own consideration of possible allocation scenarios.

         Both the Strategic Planning Committee and the board considered various
allocation methods in arriving at their decision. In these considerations, the
directors took into account historical membership prices, trading volume and
open interest information regarding products traded by the membership divisions,
and relative contributions by the membership divisions. The board believed that
setting an allocation based entirely on seat prices was not entirely fair
inasmuch as those prices reflected the value of trading rights which were being
captured, at least to some degree, in the Class B shares. Other factors,
including trading volume, governance and relative voting power, did not
necessarily reflect the relative contribution that the various membership
divisions had made, or could in the future make, to the Exchange. Ultimately,
the board found the mechanism for the allocation of equity in the P-M-T Limited
Partnership, followed in 1987 in connection with the organization of that
partnership, to be a useful precedent to the allocation of equity in the
demutualization.

Description of Demutualization Transaction

         The proposed demutualization transaction will be effected through a
two-step merger which is illustrated below:

         [Graphic: Three rectangular boxes aligned from left to right, with an
arrow silhouette pointing from the first to the second box and pointing from the
second to the third box. Inscribed in the first box is "Chicago Mercantile
Exchange (Illinois not-for-profit corporation)", inscribed in the second is "CME
Transitory Co. (Delaware nonstock corporation)", and inscribed in the third is
"Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc. (Delaware stock corporation)". Written above
the first arrow is the number "1" and below the arrow the phrases the phrases
"Merger" and "Membership Interests for Membership Interests". Written above the
second arrow is the number "2" and below the arrow the phrases "Merger" and
"Membership Interests for five classes of common stock". A third arrow
silhouette pointing to the right is set forth below the third box. Written above
the arrow is the number "3" and below the arrow the word "Recapitalization". The
arrow points to the phrase "Five classes of common stock converted into series
of Class B shares and, in the case of CME, IMM and IOM members, Class A
shares".]

         First Step: Illinois to Delaware.  In the first step, Existing CME will
merge with and into a recently formed, membership Delaware nonstock corporation
for the purpose of reincorporating us in Delaware. No substantive change will
occur in the members' current rights as a result of the merger, except for
changes that result from being incorporated as a membership corporation in
Delaware as opposed to in Illinois. Under Illinois law, an Illinois
not-for-profit

                                       25
<PAGE>


corporation cannot merge directly into a for-profit corporation; however, a
merger with a Delaware not-for-profit corporation is permissible.

         This merger will be effected under an agreement and plan of merger
between Existing CME and the nonstock corporation, which is named "CME
Transitory Co." Under this merger agreement, each membership interest in
Existing CME will be converted into an equivalent membership interest in CME
Transitory Co. The completion of the merger is subject to several conditions,
which are described below under "Conditions to Effectiveness." A copy of the
merger agreement is attached to this document as Exhibit B.

         CME Transitory Co. was formed by the Exchange for the sole purpose of
effecting the demutualization transaction. It has no present assets or any
business operations, other than activities associated with preparing for the
demutualization transaction. Existing CME is its sole present member, and that
membership interest will be cancelled upon the effectiveness of the merger. Your
board of directors has approved this first step merger. CME Transitory Co.'s
board of directors and Existing CME, as its sole member, have also approved this
merger.

         The merger agreement grants the board the authority to amend its
provisions as long as those changes do not materially and adversely affect the
members. We do not expect to use this authority; however, it may be used if
minor changes are required as a condition to receiving a favorable ruling from
the Internal Revenue Service.

         Second Step: Delaware Nonstock to Delaware Stock Corporation.  In the
second step, CME Transitory Co. will merge with and into a recently formed, for-
profit Delaware stock corporation. There will be changes in the rights of
members as a result of this merger and the third step recapitalization, which
are described below under the subheading "Differences in Ownership Rights."

         This merger will be effected under an agreement and plan of merger
between CME Transitory Co. and New CME. Under this merger agreement, the
membership interests in CME Transitory Co. will be converted into shares of five
classes of common stock of New CME. This merger is conditioned upon the
completion of the first step merger of our existing corporation into CME
Transitory Co. A copy of this merger agreement is filed as an exhibit to the
registration statement that we filed with the SEC.

         New CME was formed by Existing CME solely for the purpose of effecting
the demutualization transaction. It has no present assets or any business
operations, other than activities associated with preparing for the
demutualization transaction. CME Transitory Co. is its sole present stockholder,
and that stock interest will be cancelled upon the effectiveness of the merger.
CME Transitory Co.'s board of directors and Existing CME, as its sole member,
have approved this second step merger. New CME's board of directors and CME
Transitory Co., as its sole stockholder, have also approved this merger.

         The merger agreement grants the board the authority to amend its
provisions as long as those changes do not materially and adversely affect the
members. We do not expect to use this authority; however, it may be used if
minor changes are required as a condition to receiving a favorable ruling from
the Internal Revenue Service.

                                       26
<PAGE>


         Third Step: Recapitalization of Stock of Delaware Stock Corporation.
In the third and final step, the shares of stock issued in the second step
merger will be converted into shares of Class A and Class B common stock. As
noted, there will be changes in the rights of members as a result of the second
step merger and this recapitalization, which are described below under the
subheading "Differences in Ownership Rights."

         This recapitalization will be effected pursuant to a plan of
recapitalization adopted by the board of New CME. Under this plan, the shares of
common stock issued in the second step merger will be converted into shares of
Class A and Class B common stock as described in the following section. This
recapitalization is conditioned upon the completion of the second step merger of
CME Transitory Co. into New CME. A copy of the plan of recapitalization is filed
as an exhibit to the registration statement that we filed with the SEC.

         The plan of recapitalization grants the board the authority to amend
its provisions as long as those changes do not materially and adversely affect
the members. We do not expect to use this authority; however, it may be used if
minor changes are required as a condition to receiving a favorable ruling from
the Internal Revenue Service.

Conversion of Membership Interests into Shares

         As a result of the consummation of the transactions described above,
membership interests in Existing CME will be converted into shares of the
capital stock of New CME. Specifically, each membership interest in Existing CME
will be converted into shares of a series of Class B common stock and, in the
cases of the CME, IMM and IOM membership interests, shares of Class A common
stock, as indicated below:

                            Number of Shares To Be Received Per Membership
                                        Interest (or Fraction)
                                                     Class B Shares
     Membership Division       Class A Shares      Number      Series
     -------------------       --------------      ------      ------
     CME                           16,200             1          B-1
     IMM                           10,800             1          B-2
     IOM                            5,400             1          B-3
     GEM                                              1          B-4
     GEM Fractions                                    1          B-5

The principal purpose of the Class B shares is to confer the trading privileges
associated with the membership interests in Existing CME. Those shares will also
have traditional equity rights. The Class A shares will represent solely equity
rights. A description of the rights of the various series of Class B shares and
the Class A shares is set forth below under "Description of Capital Stock of New
CME."

         The following tables illustrate the relative equity that will be
received by an Exchange member in respect of each membership division in the
demutualization. As discussed below, several series of Class B shares will have
the right to elect one or more members of the board, and all of the Class B
shares have the right to vote, as a single class or group, on changes to Core
Rights. These special voting rights are not illustrated in the following tables.

                                       27
<PAGE>

                           Distribution to Individual Members
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            Total Equity
                                       Equivalent Class A Shares           per Membership
Membership     Class A     Class B      Represented by Class B        (expressed in equivalent
 Division      Shares      Series              Shares                      Class A shares)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>            <C>         <C>         <C>                            <C>
CME            16,200       B-1                1,800                       18,000
IMM            10,800       B-2                1,200                       12,000
IOM             5,400       B-3                  600                        6,000
GEM                         B-4                  100                          100
GEM Fractions               B-5                   10                           10
</TABLE>

             Distribution of Relative Equity by Membership Division

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           Total Equity
                                                          Equivalent      (expressed in      Percentage
                                            Class       Class A Shares      equivalent       of Equity
Membership      Number of      Class A        B         Represented by       Class A         Distributed
 Division      Memberships     Shares       Series      Class B Shares       shares)         to Members
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>            <C>             <C>          <C>         <C>               <C>                <C>
CME                  625       10,125,000     B-1       1,125,000            11,250,000        39.1%
IMM                  813        8,780,400     B-2         975,600             9,756,000        33.9%
IOM                1,287        6,949,800     B-3         772,200             7,722,000        26.8%
GEM*                 253                      B-4          25,300                25,300         0.2%
GEM Fractions*     2,140                      B-5          21,400                21,400
                  -------     ------------             -----------          -----------        -----
Total              5,118       25,855,200               2,919,500            28,774,700         100%
                  =======     ============             ===========          ===========        =====
</TABLE>

* Based on full and fractional GEM memberships as of December 31, 1999. The
  conversion of additional GEM fractions into full GEM membership interests
  prior to the effectiveness of the demutualization will reduce the number of
  series B-5 shares issued and increase the number of series B-4 shares actually
  issued.


Rights of Class B Common Stock

         Each series of Class B shares will carry traditional equity rights and
also will confer the trading rights of the associated membership division.
Holders of shares of each series of Class B common stock will have special
voting rights, consisting of the right (of B-1, B-2 and B-3 stockholders) to
elect a total of six members of the board of directors of New CME and the right
to approve actions that affect Core Rights. Holders of Class B shares will also
have the right to vote with holders of Class A shares in the election of the
remaining members of the board of directors of New CME, as well as on other
matters for which a vote of stockholders is required. These concepts are
explained below under the subheading "Description of Additional Provisions of
Class B Common Stock" under "Description of Capital Stock of New CME."

Election of Board of Directors

         Board Size.  The size of our board, and the manner in which directors
are elected, will be changed in the demutualization. Initially, New CME's board
will consist of 39 directors; and the existing directors of the Exchange will
continue as directors of New CME. The size of New

                                       28
<PAGE>

CME's board will be reduced in two steps: first by nine members at the December
2000 annual meeting of stockholders; and second by eleven members at the
December 2001 annual meeting of stockholders. These reductions will be effected
by electing fewer directors that the number of directors whose terms expire.

     Board Selection. We also have changed the manner in which directors will be
elected to the board. Under New CME's charter and by-laws, members of the board
will be nominated and elected as follows:



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
  Number of
  Directors               Candidates Nominated By                    Directors Elected By
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>            <C>                                            <C>
     13         Board Nominating Committee, elected by the    Holders of Class A and B shares,
                board                                         voting together

      3         Series B-1 Nominating Committee, elected by   Holders of series B-1 shares
                holders of series B-1 shares

      2         Series B-2 Nominating Committee, elected by   Holders of series B-2 shares
                holders of series B-2 shares

      1         Series B-3 Nominating Committee, elected by   Holders of series B-3 shares
                holders of series B-3 shares
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

All directors will serve for two-year terms. Terms have been staggered so that
approximately one-half of the directors will be elected each year. The following
table indicates the number of directors to be elected at the annual stockholders
meeting each year, and who has the right to vote on their election:


       ----------------------------------------------------------------------
                                            Number of Directors to be Elected
                                               At Annual Stockholders Meeting
       ----------------------------------------------------------------------
                                              Even Years        Odd Years
        Directors To Be Elected By            (Starting         (Starting
                                            December 2000)    December 2001)

       ----------------------------------------------------------------------

           Holders of Class A and Class             6                   7
           B shares, voting together
           Holders of series B-1 shares             1                   2
           Holders of series B-2 shares             1                   1
           Holders of series B-3 shares             1
             Total                                  9                  10
       ----------------------------------------------------------------------


     Board Nominations.  A nominating committee, composed of members of New
CME's board, will nominate the slate of candidates for the thirteen directors to
be elected by the holders of the Class A and Class B shares, voting together.
This committee will be responsible for assessing the qualifications of
candidates as well as ensuring that regulatory requirements with respect to the
composition of New CME's board are met.  Candidates nominated by this committee
could include New CME's President and CEO, other executive staff members,
representatives from the futures commission merchants community, and public
directors from outside the industry as required by regulations of the CFTC.

                                       29
<PAGE>

     Consistent with our current practice, the series B-1, B-2 and B-3 holders
will have the right to elect members of nominating committees for their
respective series, which would be responsible for nominating candidates for
election by their series. Each committee will be responsible for assessing the
qualifications of candidates to serve as directors to be elected by that series.
In accordance with our current practice, New CME's charter requires that
director-candidates for election by a series of Class B shares own, or be
recognized under its rules as a permitted transferee (other than temporary
lease-type transfers) of, at least one share of that series. For purposes of the
elections to be held in December 2000, the members of the series B-1, B-2 and B-
3 nominating committees will be the members of the present corresponding CME,
IMM and IOM nominating committees of Existing CME.

Differences in Ownership Rights

     The demutualization will cause changes in your ownership rights. Some of
these differences arise from differences that exist between the corporate law
governing Illinois not-for-profit corporations and Delaware stock corporations.
The remainder of the differences result from changes that we have made in
drafting the charter and by-laws for New CME. These differences are described in
the following table:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                             New CME                                     Existing CME
                             --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Dividends                    Stockholders may receive dividend           Members are not allowed to receive
                             distributions based on current or           dividends based on earnings.
                             accumulated earnings.
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                          <C>                                         <C>
Authorized Capital           Charter authorizes issuance of up to (i)    Charter and by-laws authorize the
                             100,000,000 shares of Class A common        issuance of (i) 625 CME memberships, (ii)
                             stock, (ii) 5,332 shares of Class B         813 IMM memberships, (iii) 1,287 IOM
                             common stock in five series and (iii)       memberships and (iv) 467 GEM memberships.
                             10,000,000 shares of preferred stock.
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Transfer Restrictions        Class B share transfers will not be         Membership transfers are subject to
                             subject to restrictions; although           compliance with rules, which require
                             exercise of the associated trading          purchasers of membership interests to
                             privileges will be subject to the           apply for membership.  Applicants must be
                             eligibility requirements that presently     adults of good moral character,
                             apply to the exercise of those trading      reputation and business integrity, and
                             privileges.                                 have adequate financial resources and
                                                                         credit.
                             Class A share transfers will be subject
                             to restrictions during the first 15
                             months following the demutualization.
                             See "Transfer Restrictions" under
                             "Description of Capital Stock of New CME."
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

                                       30
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                             New CME                                     Existing CME
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                          <C>                                         <C>

Voting:

     Directors               Holders of Class B shares will have the     Members have the right to elect an
                             right to elect an aggregate of 6            aggregate of 25 directors as follows:
                             directors as follows:

                                     Associated                          Membership       Number of
                                     Membership     Number of            Division         Directors
                             Series  Division       Directors            --------         ---------
                             ------  --------       ---------
                                                                         CME                  12
                             B-1        CME             3                IMM                   8
                             B-2        IMM             2                IOM                   4
                             B-3        IOM             1                GEM                   1

                             Class B stockholders in each series         Members in a division have the right to
                             entitled to elect a director will have      elect individuals to a nominating
                             the right to elect individuals to a         committee, which slates candidates for
                             nominating committee, which slates          election by members of that division.
                             candidates for election by stockholders
                             of that series.
                                                                         The Chairman is empowered to appoint up
                             Holders of Class A and B shares will have   to 12 directors, who must be approved by
                             the right to vote in the election of the    the board.
                             remaining 13 directors, who will be
                             nominated by the Nominating Committee of
                             the board of New CME.
 ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     Rule Changes            Charter and by-laws do not pick-up the      Members have the right, in what is called
                             "referendum" process.  Class B              a "referendum," to initiate rule changes,
                             stockholders will be given the right        including adopting new rules and amending
                             under the charter to approve changes to     or repealing existing rules of the
                             (i) products permitted to be traded by      Exchange.  If the board does not approve
                             each series, (ii) floor access rights and   a member-initiated proposal, members have
                             privileges, including commitment to         the right, in essence, to override that
                             maintain open outcry trading, (iii) the     action by vote - provided at least
                             authorized and issued shares of each        one-half of the votes eligible to be cast
                             series and (iv) eligibility to hold         on the matter are cast and it is approved
                             shares of a series.  Voting will be on a    by a majority of the votes cast.
                             weighted basis, with series B-1 holders     Weighted voting by membership division is
                             (CME) having 6 votes per share, series      required on matters related to voting,
                             B-2 holders (IMM) having 2 votes per        board or executive committee
                             share, series B-3 holders (IOM) having 1    representation, trading rights, rights
                             vote per share, series B-4 holders (GEM)    upon dissolution or any other issue for
                             having 1/6/th/  vote per share, and         which the board determines weighted
                             series B-5 holders (GEM fractions) having   voting to be appropriate.  Under weighted
                             1/60/th / vote per share.  See              voting, CME members have 6 votes per
                             "Description of Additional Provisions of    membership, IMM members have 2 votes per
                             Class B Common Stock" under "Description    membership, IOM members have 1 vote per
                             of Capital Stock of New CME."               membership, GEM members have 1/6/th/ vote
                                                                         per membership, and holders of GEM
                                                                         fractions have 1/60/th/  vote per faction.
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

                                       31
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                             New CME                                     Existing CME
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                          <C>                                         <C>
     Extraordinary           Approval of a majority of the outstanding   Approval of two-thirds of votes present
     Transactions            shares will be required to authorize        and voting is required to authorize
                             charter amendments, mergers, sales of all   charter amendments, mergers, sales of all
                             of the corporate assets or a dissolution.   of the corporate assets or a dissolution.
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
     Class/Series            Holders of a class or series of stock       No comparable statutory provision.
     Voting                  will have the right by statute to vote as
                             a separate class or series on charter
                             amendments that would adversely affect
                             their rights granted by the charter.
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Dissenters' Rights           In transactions involving a merger or       No dissenters' rights.
                             sale of all of the assets, stockholders
                             will have the right to dissent and, by
                             following a statutory procedure, receive
                             a cash payment equal to the appraised
                             fair value of their shares.
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Liquidation Rights           Liquidating distributions will be made to   Liquidating distributions are based on
                             stockholders based on the number of Class   aggregate amounts originally paid-in for
                             A shares they hold or are considered to     memberships.
                             hold.  The charter treats each series of
                             Class B shares as representing a
                             specified number of Class A shares.  See
                             "Description of Common Stock" under
                             "Description of Capital Stock of New CME."
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Board of Directors           19 members (after December 2001).           39 members.
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ability to Limit Personal    Allowed.  Charter will contain provision    Not allowed.
Liability of Directors       adopting the maximum permitted limitation.
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Antitakeover Provisions      Charter will contain antitakeover           None
                             provisions.  See "Other Charter
                             Provisions" under "Description of Capital
                             Stock of New CME."
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

Required Regulatory Approvals


     Many of the terms of the demutualization transaction relating to board
composition and elections, membership privileges and voting rights, and trading
rights and access, will either

                                       32
<PAGE>


require new rules or amendments to existing rules, or will be required to comply
with provisions of the Commodity Exchange Act or the regulations issued by the
CFTC. We intend to make any necessary submissions to the CFTC prior to the
special meeting of members.

     In addition, the registration statement that New CME filed with the SEC,
which contains this document, must be declared effective by the SEC.

Amendment or Termination

     Our board may amend any of the terms of the first step merger agreement at
any time before or after its approval by our members, but not after the time
that the merger of the Exchange into CME Transitory Co. has been effected.  No
amendment may, in the sole judgment of the board, materially and adversely
affect the rights of our members.  The second step merger agreement may be
similarly amended.

     The merger agreements may be terminated, and the demutualization
transaction abandoned, at any time before or after our members have approved the
demutualization transaction, by action of our board if it determines that
consummation of the transactions provided for in the merger agreements would,
for any reason, be inadvisable or not in the best interests of the Exchange or
its members.  However, the board may not terminate the second step merger
agreement between CME Transitory Co. and New CME unless the first step merger
agreement between the Exchange and CME Transitory Co. is also terminated.

Conditions to Effectiveness of the Demutualization Transactions


     Consummation of the first step merger of Existing CME into CME Transitory
Co. is subject to the following principal conditions:


     .    Approval of the demutualization transaction by our members

          The first step merger must be approved by our members by the
          affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the votes present and
          voted, either in person or by proxy.

     .    The Class A limited partners in P-M-T Limited Partnership shall have
          approved the sale of all of the assets and business of that
          partnership to New CME

          An offer by New CME to purchase all of the assets and business of P-M-
          T Limited Partnership for cash shall have been approved by the holders
          of two-thirds of the 4,786 outstanding P-M-T Class A limited
          partnership units, excluding the 321 units held by the Exchange. The
          purchase will be consummated concurrently with the consummation of the
          demutualization transaction.

     .    Receipt of a favorable ruling from the Internal Revenue Service

          We have asked the Internal Revenue Service to confirm that our
          proposed demutualization transaction will not cause our members to
          recognize a gain or loss upon the conversion of their membership
          interests into Class A and Class B shares.

                                       33
<PAGE>


          We filed the ruling request on December 30, 1999. We do not expect to
          receive that ruling until after the special meeting.

     .    Receipt of regulatory approvals

          We will need to receive the approval of the CFTC to rule changes that
          we need to make to recognize the change in our structure that will
          occur as a part of the demutualization. These changes relate to the
          fact that our existing rules will be reflected in New CME's charter,
          by-laws and rules and that membership interests will be represented by
          shares of stock.


Effectiveness of the Demutualization Transactions


     After the conditions described above have been satisfied, we will cause the
necessary documents to be filed with the Secretaries of State of Illinois and
Delaware in order to effect the first step merger of the Exchange into CME
Transitory Co., whereupon it will become effective.  Promptly following that
effectiveness, we will cause the necessary documents to be filed with the
Delaware Secretary of State in order to cause the merger of CME Transitory Co.
into New CME, whereupon it will become effective.  Finally, we will cause an
amendment to the charter of New CME to be filed with the Delaware Secretary of
State in order to effect the recapitalization.  Upon the effectiveness of that
filing, the demutualization will have been effected and you will hold shares of
New CME.


Federal Income Tax Consequences


     One of the conditions to the closing of the demutualization transaction is
our receipt of a private letter ruling from the Internal Revenue Service
generally to the effect that, for federal income tax purposes, no gain or loss
will be recognized by a member on the conversion of his or her membership
interest in the Exchange into Class A common stock and Class B common stock or
for Class B common stock only. Assuming this nonrecognition treatment, the
members would have the following additional federal income tax consequences:


     .    The aggregate basis of the shares of New CME received by a member in
          conversion of a membership interest will equal the basis of the
          membership interest. In the case of a member who receives both Class A
          common stock and Class B common stock, that basis will be allocated in
          proportion to the fair market value of each on the date of the
          mergers.

     .    The holding period of the Class A common stock and Class B common
          stock received by a member in conversion of a membership interest will
          include the period for which the membership interest has been held,
          provided that the membership interest is held as a capital asset on
          the date of the conversion.



     The Exchange will not recognize any gain or loss as a result of the
transfer of its assets to New CME and the assumption by New CME of the
liabilities of the Exchange.

                                       34
<PAGE>

     We filed a request for the foregoing ruling with the Internal Revenue
Service on December 30, 1999.  Because of the novelty of the demutualization
transactions, it is unclear at this time whether the Internal Revenue Service
will issue a favorable ruling or, if the Internal Revenue Service is willing to
issue a ruling, when the ruling will be received.  Any such ruling would
generally be binding on the Internal Revenue Service.  Although an Internal
Revenue Service ruling can be revoked or modified retroactively under some
extraordinary circumstances, we are not aware of any such circumstances that
would cause the Internal Revenue Service to revoke or modify any such ruling
with respect to the demutualization transactions.


     Because of the complexity of the tax laws, and because the tax consequences
of the demutualization to you may be affected by matters not discussed in this
section, you are urged to consult your own tax advisor with respect to your own
particular circumstances and with respect to the specific tax consequences of
the demutualization to you, including the applicability and effect of state,
local and foreign tax laws and any proposed changes in applicable tax laws.



                         UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONDENSED
                       CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS


     The following unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial
statements give effect to (i) the proposed acquisition of the limited partners'
interest in P-M-T Limited Partnership and (ii) the issuance of 25,855,200 shares
of Class A common stock and 5,118 shares of Class B common stock in connection
with the proposed demutualization and conversion of membership interests as
described elsewhere in this document as if they had occurred as of December 31,
1999, for purposes of the unaudited pro forma consolidated balance sheet, and as
of the beginning of the year for purposes of the unaudited pro forma
consolidated statement of income for the year ended December 31, 1999.

     The unaudited pro forma information reflects the acquisition of the limited
partners' interest in P-M-T Limited Partnership through a cash payment equal to
the carrying value of the limited partners' interest, which amounted to
$3,018,000 at December 31, 1999. This acquisition will be effected through the
purchase of the assets and business of P-M-T Limited Partnership at fair market
value on the date of the transaction. Because the purchase price, market value
and carrying value are approximately the same, there will be no goodwill or
other purchase accounting adjustments resulting from this transaction. P-M-T
Limited Partnership, for which the Exchange has acted as the sole general
partner since its inception, will be liquidated, with proceeds distributed to
its partners, after the proposed transaction has been completed. As of December
31, 1999, there were 4,786 Class A limited partnership units and 90 Class B
limited partnership units outstanding in P-M-T. As of that date, the Exchange
held 321 Class A units and 34 Class B units, representing 6.7% and 37.7%,
respectively, of the outstanding units of those classes.

     The unaudited pro forma information also reflects the issuance of
25,855,200 Class A shares and 5,118 Class B shares in exchange for previously
existing membership interests. No cash will be paid or received. The Class B
shares are considered the equivalent of 2,919,500 Class A shares for purposes of
calculating pro forma earnings per share.

                                       35
<PAGE>


     The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements are
based on available information and on assumptions management believes are
reasonable and that reflect the effects of the transactions described above.
These unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements are
provided for informational purposes only and should not be construed to be
indicative of the Exchange's consolidated financial position or results of
operations had these transactions been consummated on the dates assumed and do
not in any way represent a projection or forecast of the Exchange's consolidated
financial position or results of operations for any future date or period.  The
unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statements should be read
in conjunction with the audited consolidated financial statements of the
Exchange, together with the related notes and report of independent public
accountants, and with the information set forth under "Management's Discussion
and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and
"Business."

                                       36
<PAGE>


                          CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE
           Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheet
                               December 31, 1999


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                          Pro Forma After
                                                                                    ----------------------------
                                                                                    Acquisition    Issuance of
                                                                                    of Interest    Class A and
                                                                     Historical       in P-M-T       B Shares
                                                                    -------------   -------------  -------------
Assets                                                                        (dollars in thousands)
<S>                                                                 <C>             <C>            <C>
Current assets:
   Cash and cash equivalents                                        $    14,249     $    11,231    $    11,231
   Investments                                                           60,156          60,156         60,156
   Accounts receivable and prepaid expenses                              29,189          29,189         29,189
   Cash performance bonds and security deposits                          73,134          73,134         73,134
                                                                    -----------     -----------    -----------
Total current assets                                                    176,728         173,710        173,710

Property, net of accumulated depreciation and amortization               93,531          93,531         93,531
Other assets                                                             31,444          31,444         31,444
                                                                    -----------     -----------    -----------
Total Assets                                                        $   301,703     $   298,685    $   298,685
                                                                    ===========     ===========    ===========

Liabilities and Equity
Current liabilities:
   Accounts payable                                                 $    15,569     $    15,569    $    15,569
   Other current liabilities                                             21,250          21,250         21,250
   Cash performance bonds and security deposits                          73,134          73,134         73,134
                                                                    -----------     -----------    -----------
Total current liabilities                                               109,953         109,953        109,953

Limited Partners' interest in P-M-T Limited Partnership                   3,018              --             --
Other liabilities                                                        20,069          20,069         20,069
                                                                    -----------     -----------    -----------

Total liabilities                                                       133,040         130,022        130,022

Members' and Stockholders' equity:
    Preferred stock, $.01 par value,                                                                        --
       10,000,000 shares authorized, none issued and outstanding
    Class A common stock, $.01 par value,
       100,000,000 shares authorized,
       25,855,200 shares issued and outstanding                                                            259
    Class B common stock, $.01 par value,
       5,332 shares authorized, 5,118 shares issued and
       outstanding                                                                                          --
    Additional paid-in capital                                                                          43,346
    Retained earnings                                                   125,421         125,421        125,421
    Proceeds from issuance of memberships                                43,605          43,605             --
    Accumulated unrealized losses on securities                            (363)           (363)          (363)
                                                                    -----------     -----------
    Total members' equity                                           $   168,663     $   168,663             --
                                                                    -----------     -----------    -----------
    Total stockholders' equity                                                                     $   168,663
                                                                                                   -----------
Total Liabilities and Equity                                        $   301,703     $   298,685    $   298,685
                                                                    ===========     ===========    ===========
</TABLE>

          The accompanying introduction is an integral part of this
           Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheet.


                                       37
<PAGE>

                          CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE
             Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Statement of Operations
                     For the Year Ended December 31, 1999

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                           Pro Forma After
                                                                                 -----------------------------------
                                                                                  Acquisition         Issuance of
                                                                                  of Interest         Class A and
                                                                 Historical         in P-M-T           B Shares
                                                               ----------------  ---------------    ----------------
                                                                 (amounts in thousands, except per share amount)
<S>                                                            <C>                <C>               <C>
Revenues:
Clearing fees                                                  $      138,526    $     138,526      $      138,526
Quotation data fees                                                    43,005           43,005              43,005
Communication fees                                                      8,165            8,165               8,165
Investment income                                                       9,091            9,038               9,038
Other operating revenue                                                 9,701            9,701               9,701
                                                               --------------    -------------      --------------
Total revenues                                                        208,488          208,435             208,435
                                                               --------------    -------------      --------------

Expenses:
Salaries and benefits                                                  80,957           80,957              80,957
Occupancy                                                              17,773           17,773              17,773
Professional fees, outside services and licenses                       28,319           28,319              28,319
Communications and computer and software maintenance                   28,443           28,443              28,443
Depreciation and amortization                                          25,274           25,274              25,274
Public relations and promotion                                          7,702            7,702               7,702
Other operating expense                                                13,376           13,376              13,376
                                                               --------------    -------------      --------------
Total expenses                                                        201,844          201,844             201,844
                                                               --------------    -------------      --------------

Income before limited partners' interest in P-M-T and
   provision for income taxes                                           6,644            6,591               6,591

Limited partners' interest in earnings of P-M-T                        (2,126)              --                  --

Provision for income taxes                                             (1,855)          (2,684)             (2,684)
                                                               --------------    -------------      --------------

Net income                                                     $        2,663    $       3,907      $        3,907
                                                               ==============    =============      ==============

Net income per share                                                                                $         0.14
                                                                                                    ==============
Shares used in the calculation of net income per share                                                      28,775
                                                                                                    ==============

</TABLE>

           The accompanying introduction is an integral part of this
      Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations.

                                       38
<PAGE>

                                CAPITALIZATION


         The following table sets forth the capitalization of the Exchange as of
December 31, 1999 (i) on an historical basis, (ii) on a pro forma basis giving
effect to the proposed acquisition of the limited partners' interest in P-M-T
Limited Partnership, and (iii) on a pro forma basis as adjusted to give effect
to the issuance by New CME of 25,855,200 Class A shares and 5,118 Class B shares
in connection with the demutualization transactions. The table should be read in
conjunction with "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
and Results of Operations," the consolidated financial statements and related
notes of the Exchange included elsewhere in this document and "Unaudited Pro
Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements."

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                   As of December 31, 1999
                                                                          -------------------------------------------
                                                                                               Pro Forma After
                                                                                         ---------------------------
                                                                                          Acquisition    Issuance of
                                                                                          of Interest    Class A and
                                                                           Historical       in P-M-T      B Shares
                                                                          ------------   -------------  ------------
                                                                                         (in thousands)
<S>                                                                       <C>            <C>            <C>
Limited partners' interest in P-M-T                                       $     3,018     $         --   $        --
Capitalized lease obligations                                                   8,132            8,132         8,132
Other long-term debt                                                               --               --            --
                                                                          -----------     ------------   -----------
Total limited partners' interest and long-term debt                            11,150            8,132         8,132
                                                                          -----------     ------------   -----------

Equity:
    Preferred stock, $.01 par value,
      10,000,000 shares authorized, none issued and
    outstanding                                                                                                   --
    Class A common stock, $.01 par value,
      100,000,000 shares authorized,
      25,855,200 shares issued and outstanding                                                                   259
    Class B common stock, $.01 par value,
      5,332 shares authorized, 5,118 shares issued and
      outstanding                                                                                                 --
    Additional paid-in capital                                                                                43,346
    Retained earnings                                                         125,421          125,421       125,421
    Proceeds from issuance of memberships                                      43,605           43,605            --
    Accumulated unrealized losses on securities                                  (363)            (363)         (363)
                                                                          -----------     ------------
    Total members' equity                                                     168,663          168,663            --
                                                                          -----------     ------------   -----------
    Total stockholders' equity                                                                               168,663
                                                                                                         -----------

Total Capitalization                                                      $   179,813     $    176,795   $   176,795
                                                                          ===========     ============   ===========
</TABLE>

                                       39
<PAGE>

                    DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK OF NEW CME

     The authorized capital stock of New CME will consist of 100,000,000 shares
of Class A common stock, $.01 par value, 5,332 shares of Class B common stock,
$.01 par value and 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock, $.01 par value. The
shares of Class A common stock and Class B common stock issued in connection
with the demutualization will be fully paid and non-assessable.

Description of Common Stock

     Dividend Rights. Dividends on shares of common stock may be paid only if
holders of Class A and B shares receive dividends. If, and when, the board
declares any dividends on the outstanding shares of common stock, it is expected
that an amount per Class A share will be declared and paid. A holder of a Class
B share will be entitled to receive an amount equal to that amount per Class A
share multiplied by the number of shares of Class A stock which the holder's
Class B share represents, as shown in the table under "Description of Additional
Provisions of Class B Common Stock" below. For example, if a dividend of $.25
per Class A share is declared, a holder of a Series B-2 share, which represents
1,200 Class A shares, would be entitled to receive $300.

     Voting. Holders of Class A and B shares will have the right to vote in the
election of 13 directors to New CME's 19-member board of directors. See
"Election of Directors" under Demutualization Proposal" above for additional
information. Holders of common stock do not have the right to cumulate votes in
the election of directors. Under cumulative voting, a holder would have a number
of votes equal to the votes to which his or her shares are entitled, multiplied
by the number of directors to be elected, and may cast those votes for a single
nominee or allocate them among several nominees. The nominees receiving the
greatest number of votes would, under cumulative voting, be elected to fill the
available positions. A New CME common stockholder may not allocate his or her
aggregate votes among candidates but may vote only all or none. The nominees
receiving a plurality of the votes cast at a meeting at which a quorum is
present shall be elected to the board.

     With the exception of the matters reserved to holders of Class B common
stock, holders of common stock will vote together on all matters for which a
vote of common stockholders is required. In these votes, a holder of Class A
shares has one vote per share and a holder of Class B shares has a number of
votes equal to the number of Class A shares represented by his or her share.
Matters reserved to the holders of Class B common stock are described below
under "Description of Additional Provisions of Class B Common Stock."

     No Conversion, Preemptive or Subscription Rights. Holders of common stock
have no conversion, preemptive or subscription rights.

     Liquidation Rights. Upon liquidation of New CME and subject to the rights
of any outstanding series of preferred stock, holders of common stock are
entitled to receive a distribution of the remaining assets. The amount to be
distributed per Class A share will be determined by dividing the aggregate
amount available for distribution to common stockholders by the total of the
number of outstanding Class A shares plus the number of Class A shares

                                       40
<PAGE>

represented by the outstanding Class B shares. The amount to be distributed per
Class B share will be determined by multiplying the amount to be distributed per
Class A share by the number of Class A shares represented by that Class B share.

     Class A Equivalence of Class B Shares. Each Class B share represents a
specified number of Class A shares for purposes of determining its rights to
vote for directors to be elected by both the Class A and Class B stockholders,
to vote on matters submitted to a vote by both the Class A and Class B
stockholders, to receive dividends or to receive liquidating distributions.
These numbers, which are shown in the table below under "Description of
Additional Provisions of Class B Common Stock," are set forth in the charter.
The charter provides for an adjustment of these numbers in the event of a stock
split or stock dividend affecting the number of outstanding Class A shares. For
example, a 2-for-1 split of the outstanding Class A shares, which would have the
effect of doubling the number of outstanding Class A shares, would cause a
doubling of the number of Class A shares represented by each series of Class B
shares. In addition, an adjustment is provided if New CME issues shares of Class
A common stock (including options and rights for, and securities convertible
into, shares of Class A common stock) at a price below their fair market value
at the time of issuance or grant. No adjustment is provided in respect of
specified issuances or grants, such as the issuance of shares of Class A common
stock upon any conversion of the series B-5 shares, any dividend on the Class B
shares payable in shares of Class A common stock, or shares issuable to
employees, officers, directors or consultants to New CME.

Description of Additional Provisions of Class B Common Stock

         The authorized shares of Class B common stock will be divided into five
series, having the following characteristics:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                 Maximum                             Number of           Number of Votes     Equivalent Class A
                Number of        Trading          Directors Series        Per Share on       Shares Represented
  Series         Shares        Privileges            Can Elect            "Core Rights"       by Class B Shares
  ------         ------        ----------            ---------            -------------       -----------------
  <S>           <C>            <C>                <C>                    <C>                 <C>
   B-1              625            CME                   3                      6                     1,800
   B-2              813            IMM                   2                      2                     1,200
   B-3            1,287            IOM                   1                      1                       600
   B-4              467            GEM                   0                     1/6                      100
   B-5            2,140       GEM Fractions              0                    1/60                       10
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

     Trading Privileges. Each series of Class B shares will have the trading
privileges currently encompassed in the existing membership interest associated
with that series. New CME's rules will provide as follows:

     .  Floor Access. A holder of a series of Class B shares who meets New CME's
        membership and eligibility criteria will be entitled to appear upon the
        floor of New CME and to act as a floor broker and/or trader for the
        contracts assigned to that series. The current product allocation rules
        applicable to a particular membership division will be associated with
        the corresponding series of Class B shares.

                                       41
<PAGE>

     .    Electronic Trading Rights. A holder of a series of Class B shares who
          meets New CME's membership and eligibility criteria will have the
          right to trade electronically through the GLOBEX2 system. This right
          is restricted, when accessing GLOBEX2 terminals from the trading
          floors, to trading only contracts assigned to that series. Otherwise,
          the holder may trade any product listed on the GLOBEX2 system.

     .    Use and Leasing of Trading Privileges. A holder of Class B shares may
          use the trading privileges associated with those shares or may lease
          those privileges to another person who satisfies the membership and
          eligibility requirements imposed by New CME. These requirements are
          expected to be substantially the same as the requirements set forth in
          our current rules.

     .    Clearing fees. New CME will continue to differentiate fees on cleared
          trades based on the trader for whom the trades are being cleared. In
          recognition of the importance of the liquidity provided by holders of
          Class B shares, New CME will continue to charge a lower clearing fee
          on Exchange products for trades made for their own accounts by a
          holder of a Class B share or by a lessee of the trading privileges of
          a Class B share. New CME will not charge a higher clearing fee for any
          trade executed in the open outcry environment than charged for the
          execution of the same trade in another trading environment. New CME's
          management may lower clearing fees or provide other incentives with
          respect to trades of other persons, including persons considered to be
          especially important as providers of market liquidity.

     .    Clearing Memberships. The right to be a clearing member will require
          an ownership interest in New CME equivalent to the requirements under
          our current rules.

In addition, New CME's charter sets forth a commitment to maintain open outcry
floor trading for a particular traded product as long as the open outcry market
is "liquid." The commitment requires New CME to maintain a facility for
conducting business, for disseminating price information, and for clearing and
delivery, and to provide reasonable financial support (consistent with 1999
budget levels) for technology, marketing and research for open outcry markets.
An open outcry market will be deemed liquid for these purposes if it meets any
of the following tests on a quarterly basis:

     .    if a comparable exchange-traded product exists, the New CME open
          outcry market has maintained at least 30 percent of the average daily
          volume of the comparable product (including, for calculation purposes,
          volume from Exchange-For-Physicals transactions in the open outcry
          market); or

     .    if a comparable exchange-traded product exists and New CME's product
          trades exclusively by open outcry, New CME's open outcry market has
          maintained at least 30 percent of the open interest of the comparable
          product; or

     .    if no comparable exchange-traded product exists, New CME's open outcry
          market has maintained at least 40 percent of the average quarterly
          volume in that market in 1999 (including, for calculation purposes,
          volume from Exchange-For-Physicals transactions in the open outcry
          market); or

                                       42
<PAGE>

     .    if no comparable exchange-traded product exists and New CME's product
          trades exclusively by open outcry, New CME's open outcry market has
          maintained at least 40 percent of the average open interest in that
          market in 1999.

If a market is deemed illiquid as a result of a failure to meet any of the
foregoing tests, management of New CME will make commercial decisions consistent
with the best interests of the stockholders.

     Voting for Directors. Holders of series B-1, B-2 and B-3 shares will have
the right to elect the number of directors set forth in the table on page 41.
See "Election of Directors" under "Demutualization Proposal" for additional
information regarding the size of the board and the process for selecting and
electing candidates to the board.

     Voting on Core Rights. Holders of Class B shares will have the right to
approve changes to specified "rights" associated with the trading privileges
conferred by those shares. These "Core Rights" consist of:

     .    the allocation of products which a holder of a series of Class B
          shares is permitted to trade on New CME's exchange facilities;

     .    the trading floor access rights and privileges which a holder of a
          series of Class B shares has, including the circumstances under which
          New CME can determine that an existing open outcry-traded product will
          no longer be traded by means of open outcry;

     .    the number of authorized and issued shares of any series of Class B
          shares (other than the issuance of series B-4 shares upon the
          conversion of series B-5 shares); and

     .    the eligibility requirements to hold shares of a series of Class B
          shares or to exercise the associated trading rights or privileges.

As indicated in the table on page 41, votes on changes to Core Rights are
weighted by series. The approval of a majority of the votes cast by the holders
of Class B shares is required in order to approve any changes to Core Rights.
Holders of Class A shares do not have the right to vote on changes to Core
Rights.

     Under Delaware law, changes to the number of authorized shares of a series
also will require the approval of the holders of a majority of the outstanding
shares of that series. Otherwise, changes may be effected upon the approval of a
majority of the votes cast by the holders of Class B shares. Due to the weighted
voting, this statement means that a change to Core Rights may be effected by the
approval of the holders of the series B-1 shares even though the holders of the
other series voted against the change. This result is consistent with the result
that would be obtained under the Exchange's existing rules and procedures.

     Shares Not Convertible in Class A Shares. Class B shares are not
convertible into Class A shares except to the limited extent otherwise provided
with respect to series B-5 shares.

         Conversion Rights of Series B-5 Shares. Series B-5 shares will be
convertible at the

                                       43
<PAGE>

option of their holder, at any time on or before November 3, 2000, into whole
shares of series B-4 stock at the ratio of ten series B-5 shares for each series
B-4 share. These shares also are subject to mandatory conversion into Class A
shares at the close of business on November 3, 2000, if not previously converted
into whole shares of series B-4 stock. In any mandatory conversion, one series
B-5 share is converted into ten Class A shares.

     Individuals holding less than the necessary ten shares may either sell
their shares to another holder so that holder will obtain the necessary ten
shares, or purchase additional shares from other holders to obtain the necessary
ten shares. The process by which a holder may purchase or sell series B-5 shares
will be similar to the process currently followed for the purchase and sale of
GEM fractions. In this process, the Exchange will act as a intermediary for the
dissemination of bid and asked prices with respect to series B-5 shares. Prices
with respect to those shares will be determined by the persons seeking to buy or
sell those shares. Any person will be eligible to buy a series B-5 share,
although the exercise of the underlying trading privilege will be subject to the
Exchange's eligibility requirements. There will be no limitation on the number
of series B-5 shares that a person may hold.

Preferred Stock

     New CME will be authorized to issue up to 10,000,000 shares of preferred
stock. The charter authorizes the board to issue these shares in one or more
series, to establish from time to time the number of shares to be included in
each series, to fix the rights, preferences and privileges of the shares of each
wholly unissued series and any of its qualifications, limitations or
restrictions. The board may increase or decrease the number of shares of any
series, but not below the number of shares of that series then outstanding,
without any further vote or action by the stockholders of New CME. The board may
authorize the issuance of preferred stock with voting or conversion rights that
could adversely affect the voting power or other rights of the holders of Class
A shares and Class B shares. We have no current plans to issue any shares of
preferred stock.

Transfer Restrictions

     Class B and Class A shares will be subject to transfer restrictions
following the completion of the demutualization transaction. Class B shares will
be subject to the same transfer process as applies to your current membership
interest. Under that process, any adult of good moral character, reputation and
business integrity, with adequate financial resources and credit to assume the
responsibilities and privileges of membership, is eligible for election to
membership in the Exchange. Our Membership Committee reviews applicants and
conducts proceedings to determine whether candidates meet our membership
criteria. Consistent with our present practice, a purchaser of Class B shares
will be required to agree to be bound by the rules and regulations adopted by
the board with respect to the shares.

     Class A shares will be subject to transfer restrictions, which will fall
away over time. For the first six months following completion of the
demutualization transaction, those shares may only be transferred with the
associated Class B shares. Each three months thereafter, a portion of the Class
A shares (in 25% increments) will become transferable. After fifteen months, the
Class A shares would not be subject to these transfer restrictions.

                                       44
<PAGE>

Other Charter Provisions

     New CME's charter and by-laws will, upon consummation of the
demutualization transactions, include a number of antitakeover provisions that
may have the effect of encouraging persons considering unsolicited tender offers
or other unilateral takeover proposals to negotiate with New CME's board of
directors rather than pursue non-negotiated takeover attempts. These provisions
include:

     Classified Board of Directors; Removal for Cause; Filling Vacancies. New
CME's charter will provide for a board of directors divided into two classes,
with one class to be elected each year to serve for a two-year term. The terms
of the initial classes of directors will terminate on the date of the annual
meetings of stockholders in December 2000 and 2001. As a result, at least two
annual meetings of stockholders may be required for the stockholders to change a
majority of the board. Directors elected by Class A and Class B stockholders may
be removed for cause only by the affirmative vote of the holders of not less
than two-thirds of the outstanding votes entitled to vote in the election.
Vacancies resulting from that removal or any other reason shall be filled by the
board. Directors elected by the Class B stockholders may be removed for cause
only by the affirmative vote of the holders of two-thirds of the shares entitled
to vote in the election of the director to be removed. Vacancies resulting from
that removal or any other reason shall be filled by the board of directors from
the candidates who ran in the previous election for the directorship and
received the next highest number of votes for election. The classification of
directors and the inability of stockholders to remove directors without cause
and to fill vacancies on the board will make it more difficult to change the
composition of the board, but will promote a continuity of existing management.

     Advance Notice Requirements. New CME's by-laws will establish advance
notice procedures with regard to stockholder proposals relating to the
nomination of candidates for election as directors or new business to be brought
before meetings of stockholders. These procedures provide that notice of
stockholder proposals must be timely and given in writing to the Secretary of
New CME prior to the meeting at which the action is to be taken. Generally, to
be timely, notice must be received at the principal executive offices of New CME
not less than 90 days nor more than 120 days prior to the first anniversary date
of the annual meeting for the preceding year. The notice must contain the
information required by the by-laws, including information regarding the
proposal and the proponent.

     Special Meetings of Stockholders. The charter and by-laws deny stockholders
the right to call a special meeting of stockholders. The charter and by-laws
provide that only the Chairman of the Board or a majority of the board of
directors may call special meetings of the stockholders.

     No Written Consent of Stockholders. The charter requires all stockholder
actions to be taken by a vote of the stockholders at an annual or special
meeting, and does not permit the stockholders to act by written consent, without
a meeting.

     Amendment of By-Laws and Charter. The charter generally requires the
approval of not less than two-thirds of the voting power of all outstanding
shares of capital stock entitled to vote to amend any by-laws by stockholder
action or the charter provisions described in this section. Provisions in the
by-laws regarding the trading rights and privileges available to the Class
B

                                       45
<PAGE>


stockholders may be amended only with the approval of the Class B stockholders.
Those provisions will make it more difficult to dilute the antitakeover effects
of our by-laws and our charter.

     Stockholder Rights Provisions. The charter authorizes the board of
directors to create and issue rights entitling their holders to purchase shares
of New CME's stock or other securities. Those rights might be used to affect the
ability of a third party to initiate a transaction designed to takeover New CME.
The board is considering the adoption of a plan that would create these rights.
These plans typically provide for dividend distributions of rights to holders of
common stock that is, or subsequently becomes, outstanding. The rights entitle
their holders to purchase a specified fraction of a newly-issued share of a
series of stock (typically preferred stock) at a specified exercise price. The
rights become exercisable, and transferable apart from the common stock, upon
the earlier to occur of (i) the date that a person or group (an "Acquiring
Person") acquires beneficial ownership of at least a specified percentage
(possibly 15%) of New CME's common stock or (ii) the commencement of, or
announcement of an intent to begin, a tender offer or exchange offer for a
similar specified percentage of New CME's common stock. If a person becomes an
Acquiring Person and the rights are not redeemed, each right would entitle its
holder to receive, upon payment of the exercise price, that number of shares of
common stock of the issuing entity which have a market value typically equal to
twice the exercise price. If the issuer of the rights is acquired by an
Acquiring Person in a merger or other business combination, or fifty percent or
more of its assets or earning power are transferred to a third party, each right
would entitle its holder to receive, upon payment of the exercise price, common
stock of the Acquiring Person or third party with a market value equal to twice
the exercise price. The rights are typically redeemable by the issuing company
at a nominal price at any time, but not after a specified limited period
following the existence of an Acquiring Person. The potential economic dilution
inherent in the rights is intended to cause potential acquirers to approach and
negotiate with the board so that, assuming a satisfactory transaction is
negotiated, the rights will be redeemed. The rights would have an expiration
date. The actual terms of any rights plan adopted by the board may vary from the
foregoing description and would be forwarded to stockholders following any plan
adoption.

     To the extent that the adoption of a rights plan would make more difficult
or discourage a proposed takeover of New CME, its adoption would increase the
likelihood that the then incumbent directors and management of New CME would
retain their positions. However, a rights plan, in combination with the existing
provisions of New CME's charter, should provide meaningful assurance that the
board, if confronted by a surprise proposal from a third party, will have
sufficient time to review the proposal, as well as appropriate alternatives to
it, and thereby will be in a more favorable position to protect the best
interest of New CME and its stockholders.

     A rights plan is intended to encourage persons seeking to acquire control
of the Company to engage in arms-length negotiations with the board and New
CME's management. However, a rights plan, if adopted, might also have the effect
of discouraging a person from making a tender offer (even at a premium over the
then prevailing market price) for shares of New CME's common stock or otherwise
attempting to obtain control, even though an attempt could be beneficial to New
CME and its stockholders.

Transfer Agent

                                       46
<PAGE>

     New CME will serve as transfer agent for Class B shares. New CME expects to
select a third party to serve as transfer agent and registrar for the Class A
shares.


                                  MANAGEMENT

Directors and Executive Officers

     The Exchange's board of directors currently consists of thirty-nine
persons. There is presently one vacancy. With the exceptions of Leo Melamed and
James J. McNulty, directors serve two-year terms, which are staggered so
approximately one-half of the board is elected at each annual meeting. Mr.
Melamed, who is our Chairman Emeritus and Senior Policy Advisor, serves as a
permanent, non-voting member of the Exchange's board. Mr. McNulty, who is our
President and Chief Executive Officer, serves as a non-voting member of our
board under the Exchange's rules.

     The Exchange's directors are elected in one of two ways. Twenty-five
directors are elected by the members as follows: 12 directors are elected by the
CME members from candidates nominated by the CME Nominating Committee; 8
directors are elected by the IMM members from candidates nominated by the IMM
Nominating Committee; 4 directors are elected by the IOM members from candidates
nominated by the IOM Nominating Committee; and one member is elected by the GEM
members from candidates nominated by the GEM Nominating Committee. The members
of these nominating committees are elected by the respective CME, IMM, IOM and
GEM members. Twelve directors are elected by the members of the board, who were
elected by the Exchange's members, from persons appointed by the Chairman of the
Board. As noted, Messrs. Melamed and McNulty round-out the remaining members of
the board.

     Following the effectiveness of the demutualization transactions, our board
will consist of the same people who were directors immediately before the
demutualization. At the annual meeting of stockholders in 2000, the size of our
board will be reduced by nine members; and at the annual meeting in 2001, the
size of our board will be further reduced by eleven members. Thereafter, the
size of the board will be nineteen. See "Election of Directors" under
"Demutualization Proposal" for more information.

     Set forth below is information about our current board of directors and
executive officers.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
        Name                      Age    Positions Held                                                Term Ends
        ----                      ---    ---------------                                               ---------
<S>                               <C>    <C>                                                           <C>
Scott Gordon                      47     Chairman of the Board and Director                              12/01
Terrence A. Duffy                 41     Vice Chairman of the Board and Director                         12/00
James E. Oliff                    51     Second Vice Chairman of the Board and Director                  12/00
Martin J. Gepsman                 47     Secretary of the Board and Director                             12/01
Thomas A. Kloet                   41     Treasurer and Director                                          12/01
Leo Melamed                       67     Chairman  Emeritus,  Senior  Policy  Advisor and  Non-Voting      *
                                         Member of the Board
</TABLE>

_____________________
*    Mr Melamed currently serves as a non-voting member of the board. Mr.
     Melamed will continue as a non- voting member of the board of New CME until
     annual meeting in December 2001.

                                       47
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
        Name                      Age    Positions Held                                                Term Ends
        ----                      ---    ---------------                                               ---------
<S>                               <C>    <C>                                                           <C>
John F. Sandner                    58    Special Policy Advisor and Director                             12/00
James J. McNulty                   48    President and Chief Executive  Officer and Non-Voting Member     **
                                         of the Board
H. Jack Bouroudjian                38    Director                                                        12/01
Timothy R. Brennan                 58    Director                                                        12/01
Leslie Henner Burns                44    Director                                                        12/01
Jeffrey R. Carter                  37    Director                                                        12/00
E. Gerald Corrigan                 58    Director                                                         ***
Rahm Emanuel                       40    Director                                                        12/00
Yra G. Harris                      46    Director                                                        12/00
Robert L. Haworth                  52    Director                                                        12/00
Bruce F. Johnson                   57    Director                                                        12/01
Gary M. Katler                     53    Director                                                        12/00
Paul Kimball                       48    Director                                                        12/00
John W. Lacey                      61    Director                                                         ***
Merton H. Miller                   76    Director                                                         ***
William P. Miller II               44    Director                                                        12/00
Laurence E. Mollner                58    Director                                                         ***
Patrick J. Mulchrone               42    Director                                                        12/01
John D. Newhouse                   54    Director                                                        12/01
Mark G. Papadopoulos               27    Director                                                        12/01
Ward Parkinson                     54    Director                                                         ***
Robert J. Prosi                    52    Director                                                        12/01
David M. Pryde                     50    Director                                                        12/00
Irwin Rosen                        61    Director                                                        12/00
William G. Salatich, Jr.           48    Director                                                        12/00
Verne O. Sedlacek                  45    Director                                                        12/00
Leon C. Shender                    45    Director                                                        12/00
William R. Shepard                 53    Director                                                        12/00
Howard J. Siegel                   43    Director                                                        12/01
David I. Silverman                 40    Director                                                        12/00
Jeffrey L. Silverman               53    Director                                                        12/01
Paul Simon                         71    Director                                                        12/00

Craig S. Donohue                   38    Managing Director of Business Development and
</TABLE>

_____________________
**   Mr McNulty is a non-voting member of the board as long as he is President
     and Chief Executive Officer of the Exchange. Mr. McNulty will continue as a
     non-voting member of the board of New CME until the annual meeting in
     December 2001.

***  A director appointed by the Chairman of the Board. Each of the indicated
     persons was appointed for a term ending on the later of December 1999 or
     the date on which his successor is appointed by the Chairman of the Board
     and elected to office by the board.

                                       48
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
        Name                      Age    Positions Held                                                Term Ends
        ----                      ---    ---------------                                               ---------
<S>                               <C>    <C>                                                           <C>
                                         Corporate/Legal Affairs
Phupinder Gill                     39    Managing Director and President, Clearing House Division
David G. Gomach                    41    Managing Director and Chief Financial Officer
Satish S. Nandapurkar              36    Managing Director of e-Business
Amy M. Savin                       37    Managing Director and Chief Marketing Officer
Donald D. Serpico                  54    Managing Director of Operations
Lewis C. Ting                      48    Managing Director of Organizational Development
</TABLE>


     Scott Gordon has been Chairman of our board since 1988 and an IMM director
since 1982. He also served as Vice Chairman from 1995 to 1997 and our Secretary
from 1984 to 1985 and 1994 to 1999. Mr. Gordon has been President and Chief
Operating Officer of Tokyo-Mitsubishi Futures (USA), Inc., a CME clearing member
firm wholly owned by the Bank of Tokyo-Mitsubishi, Ltd., since 1999, having
previously served as its Executive Vice President and Director. Mr. Gordon also
serves on the CFTC's Global Markets Advisory Committee and the Advisory
Committee to the Illinois Institute of Technology Center for the Study of Law
and Financial Markets. He is a director of the National Futures Association and
of the Futures Industry Institute. A member of the Exchange for more than
twenty-two years, Mr. Gordon owns one IMM membership in trust.

     Terrence A. Duffy has been Vice Chairman of our board since 1998 and a CME
Director since 1995. He has been President of TDA Trading, Inc. for the past
five years and an independent floor broker and trader since 1981. A member of
the Exchange for more than seventeen years, Mr. Duffy owns one CME membership
and one GEM membership interest.

     James E. Oliff has been Second Vice Chairman of our board since 1998 and an
IMM Director since 1996. Mr. Oliff previously served on the board from 1985 to
1992, and as Second Vice Chairman from 1989 to 1992 and Secretary in 1996. He
has been Executive Director of International Futures and Options Associates and
President of FILO Corp, a floor brokerage business, since 1982, and he is a
visiting lecturer in Financial Market Ethics at the Lemberg School of
International Finance and Economics at Brandeis University in Waltham,
Massachusetts. Mr. Oliff serves on the board of directors of Matla Group
Holdings. A member of the Exchange for more than twenty-two years, Mr. Oliff
owns one IMM membership interest.

     Martin J. Gepsman has been Secretary of our board since 1998 and an IOM
Director since 1994. He has been an independent floor broker and trader since
1985 and a member of the Exchange for more than fifteen years. Mr. Gepsman owns
one IOM membership and six fractional GEM membership interests.

     Thomas A. Kloet has been our Treasurer since 1999 and an IMM Director
since January 1996. He also served as our Treasurer in 1997 and in December
1998. Mr. Kloet has been Senior Managing Director of ABN AMRO Incorporated and
Senior Vice President ABN AMRO Bank, N.V. since 1997. From 1990 to 1997, he was
the Chief Operating Officer, Chief Financial Officer and Corporate Secretary of
Credit Agricole Futures, Inc. and was Chief Financial Officer

                                       49
<PAGE>


and Secretary of Segesper Capital Markets, Inc., the parent of Credit Agricole
Futures, Inc. He also serves as Director of ABN AMRO Futures (UK), Ltd. and of
ABN AMRO Futures Singapore Ltd. He is a certified public accountant and a member
of both the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and the Illinois
CPA Society. Mr. Kloet is also a member of the Board of Governors of Elmhurst
Memorial Hospital and a Trustee of the Elmhurst Memorial Health System. A member
of the Exchange for more than eleven years, Mr. Kloet owns one IMM membership
and has voting/investment power over one IMM membership in the name of ABN AMRO
Bank, N.V.

     Leo Melamed is our Chairman Emeritus and Senior Policy Advisor. Mr. Melamed
is currently appointed as a permanent non-voting member of the board, but was
previously elected and appointed for twenty-six years. He is a founding member
of and was Chairman of the International Monetary Market, was Special Counsel to
the board from 1977 until 1991, and was Special Counsel and Chairman of the
Exchange's Executive Committee from 1985 until 1991. Mr. Melamed previously
served as Chairman of the Exchange for four years and has been a member of the
Exchange for more than forty-five years. For more than five years, he has been
Chairman and CEO of Sakura Dellsher, Inc., one of our clearing member firms. Mr.
Melamed owns one CME membership, one IMM membership, two IOM membership and six
fractional GEM membership interests.

     John F. Sandner has been the Special Policy Advisor since January 1998 and
a CME Director since 1977. Mr. Sandner previously served as Chairman of the
Exchange for thirteen years and was appointed chairman of GLOBEX in 1993. He has
been President and CEO of RB&H Financial Services L.P., a futures commission
merchant and one of our clearing member firms, for more than five years. A
member of the Exchange for more than twenty-seven years, Mr. Sandner owns three
CME membership, two IMM membership, four IOM membership and fourteen fractional
GEM membership interests. He also has voting power over two IOM membership
interests.

     James J. McNulty became our President and Chief Executive Officer on
February 7, 2000, having previously served as Managing Director and Co-Head of
the Corporate Analysis and Structuring Team in the Corporate Finance Division at
Warburg Dillon Read, an investment banking firm, for over the past five years.

     H. Jack Bouroudjian has been an elected IOM Director since 1996. He has
been Senior Vice President of Equity Futures with Commerz Futures since 1999.
Prior to that time, he was Vice President of Equity Futures with Nikko
Securities from 1997 until 1999 and with Credit Agricole Futures, Inc. from 1995
until 1997. A member of the Exchange for more than twelve years, Mr. Bouroudjian
owns one IOM membership.

     Timothy R. Brennan has been a CME Director since 1990. He has been a floor
broker and trader since 1974 and Vice President of RB&H Financial Services,
L.P., one of our clearing member firms, for more than five years. A member of
the Exchange for more than twenty-four years, Mr. Brennan owns one CME
membership, one IOM membership and two fractional GEM membership interests.

     Leslie Henner Burns has been a CME Director since January 2000. She has
been a self-employed floor trader since 1978 and was President of Leslie A.
Henner, Inc., a floor brokerage

                                       50
<PAGE>

business, from 1981 until 1999. A member of the Exchange for more than twenty-
two years, Ms. Burns owns one CME membership and two fractional GEM membership
interests.

     Jeffrey R. Carter has been a CME Director since 1999. He has been a market
maker-local trader since 1988. A member of the Exchange for more than ten years,
Mr. Carter owns one CME membership and one IOM membership interest in a self-
directed IRA.

     E. Gerald Corrigan has been a director since October 1998. He has been
Managing Director at Goldman, Sachs & Co., an investment banking firm, for more
than five years. He has also served as co-chairman of its Risk Committee and
Global Compliance and Controls Committee. Prior to his employment by Goldman,
Sachs & Co., he was President and Chief Executive Officer of the Federal Reserve
Bank of New York and a member of the Federal Open Market Committee.

     Rahm Emanuel has been a director since May 1999. He has been Managing
Director of Wasserstein Perella & Co., Inc., an investment banking firm, since
January 1999. Prior to March 1998, he was Senior Advisor to the President for
Policy and Strategy in the Clinton Administration and Executive Assistant to the
Chief of Staff. Mr. Emanuel also serves as a director of RxDrugstore.

     Yra G. Harris has been an IMM Director since 1997. He has been a self-
employed floor trader since 1977. A member of the Exchange for more than twenty-
two years, Mr. Harris owns two IMM memberships and one IOM membership interest,
and he has sole voting power over one IMM membership for which he does not
disclaim beneficial ownership.

     Robert L. Haworth has been a CME Director since 1998. He served as our
Treasurer in 1998 and was Vice President of the CME Audit Department in 1979.
Mr. Haworth has been a self-employed floor trader since 1979. He is a certified
public accountant and a member of both the American Institute of Certified
Public Accountants and the Illinois CPA Society. A member of the Exchange for
more than twenty years, Mr. Haworth owns one CME membership and one GEM
membership interest.

     Bruce F. Johnson has been a CME Director since 1998. He has been President
and part owner of Packers Trading Company, a futures commission merchant and
former clearing member firm, for over the past five years. A member of the
Exchange for more than twenty-nine years, Mr. Johnson owns one CME membership
and one GEM membership.

     Gary M. Katler has been an IOM Director since 1993. He has been Senior Vice
President of ING Barings Futures and Options Inc. since 1994. Mr. Katler has
voting power over one IOM membership and one GEM membership interest, both of
which are owned by his employer and of which he disclaims beneficial interest.

     Paul Kimball has been a director since February 1999. He has been Managing
Director and Global Co-Head of the Foreign Exchange Department of Morgan Stanley
Dean Witter, an investment banking firm, for over the past five years. Mr.
Kimball is also Chairman of the Foreign Exchange Committee, an industry
oversight group that advises the Federal Reserve Bank of New York on issues
related to foreign exchange markets.

                                       51
<PAGE>

     John W. Lacey has been a director since February 1998. He has been a
Partner in the Lacey Ranches, a family cow-calf operation, the Margarita Cattle
Company in Santa Margarita, California, and the Centennial Livestock. Mr. Lacey
is also Director of the National Cattlemen's Beef Association and Chairman of
the California Beef Council and past president of the California Cattlemen's
Association and the National Cattlemen's Association. He serves on the Advisory
Council of the College of Agriculture at California Polytechnic and is its
immediate past chairman.

     Merton H. Miller has been a director since January 1990. He has been the
Robert R. McCormick Distinguished Service Professor of Finance Emeritus at the
Graduate School of Business, University of Chicago, for more than five years.
Professor Miller is also a director of Dimensional Fund Advisors Inc., located
in Santa Monica, California. Professor Miller was awarded the Nobel Memorial
Prize in Economic Science in 1990 for his work in the area of corporate
finance.

     William P. Miller II has been a director since February 1999. He has been
Senior Vice President and Independent Risk Oversight Officer for the Common Fund
Group, an investment management firm for educational institutions, since
September 1996. Prior to that, he was Director, Trading Operations and Asset Mix
Management with General Motors Investment Management Corporation. He is also a
director of the Association for Financial Professionals and of the Investment
Risk Institute, and Chairman, Executive Committee, End Users of Derivatives
Council.

     Laurence E. Mollner has been a director since February 1991. He has been
President of Mariah Investment Company, a futures, equities and real estate
investment firm, since 1998. He was President of Carr Futures from August 1997
through January 1998 and was responsible for the sale and transition of the
Institutional Futures Division of Dean Witter Reynolds Inc. to Carr Futures.
Prior to that, he was Executive Vice President for Dean Witter Reynolds Inc.,
Director of its Futures Markets Division, and a member of the board of directors
of Dean Witter International Limited in London. He joined Dean Witter Reynolds
Inc. in 1979. Mr. Mollner is the former Chairman of the Futures Industry
Association, and he currently serves as a director of both the Futures Industry
Association and National Futures Association.

     Patrick J. Mulchrone has been an IMM Director since 1998. He was previously
a director from 1991 to 1996 and served as our Second Vice Chairman from 1993 to
1996. Mr. Mulchrone has been owner of P.J. Mulchrone Co. and a floor broker and
trader since 1979. A member of the Exchange for more than twenty years, Mr.
Mulchrone owns one CME membership, one IMM membership, one IOM membership and
one GEM membership interest.

     John D. Newhouse has been an IMM Director since 1996 and was previously a
director from 1987 to 1988. He has been a floor broker and trader since 1974 and
President of Euro Spread Brokers, a broker association filling orders in
Eurodollars, since 1980. A member of the Exchange for more than twenty-five
years, Mr. Newhouse owns three IMM membership, one IOM membership and four
fractional GEM membership interests.

     Mark G. Papadopoulos has been a GEM Director since January 2000. He was
Vice Chairman of the Mexican Peso Futures Pit Committee, a position with the
CME, from 1998-1999, and has been an independent floor trader since 1996. Prior
to that, he was an Arbitrage

                                       52
<PAGE>

Clerk with several independent floor trades from 1994 to 1996. A member of the
Exchange for more than three years, Mr. Papadopoulos owns two GEM membership
interests.

     Ward Parkinson has been a director since February 1998. He is Founder
of Micron Technology, a manufacturer of computer and memory chips, and he was
its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer from 1978 to 1986 and Vice Chairman
until 1989. He has been consulting in the electronics field for more than five
years. Mr. Parkinson has also been a partner in and director of PYCO, which
invests in commercial real estate, and a board member of Parkinson-Yanke Real
Estate and Parkinson-Nelson Real Estate for over the past five years. Mr.
Parkinson serves on the board of Ovonyx, sign-me-up.com and Odessy Computers.

     Robert J. Prosi has been a CME Director since January 1998. He has been
First Vice President, Salomon Smith Barney Inc., an investment banking firm, for
more than five years. Mr. Prosi is also a member of the Chicago Council on
Foreign Relations. A member of the Exchange for more than twenty-three years,
Mr. Prosi owns one CME membership and one IOM membership interest, and he has
voting/investment power over one IOM membership interest for which he has not
disclaimed beneficial interest.

     David M. Pryde has been a director since February 1997. He has been
Managing Director at J. P. Morgan & Co. Inc., an investment banking firm, with
global responsibility for its futures and options business. Prior to assuming
his current role, he was Head of Global Commodities for Morgan Guaranty Trust
Company. He is currently a member of the Executive Committee of the Futures
Industry Association and the National Futures Association. Mr. Pryde was
formerly Vice Chairman of the Commodity Exchange Inc. in New York and was a
member of the Executive Committee of its Board of Governors. Mr. Pryde has
voting/investment power over one CME membership, three IMM membership, nine IOM
membership and seventeen GEM fractional membership interests owned by various J.
P. Morgan Futures Inc. employees and for which he has not disclaimed beneficial
interest.

     Irwin Rosen has been a CME Director since January 1997. He is an attorney
and has represented clients before the CME tribunal, for more than five years
and has been an independent floor broker and trader since 1970. A member of the
Exchange for more than twenty-nine years, Mr. Rosen owns one CME membership, one
IOM membership and one fractional GEM membership interest all held in
trust.

     William G. Salatich, Jr. has been a CME Director January 1997. He has been
an independent floor broker and trader since 1970. A member of the Exchange for
more than twenty-four years, Mr. Salatich owns one CME membership and two
fractional GEM membership interests.

     Verne O. Sedlacek has been a director since February 1997. He has been
President and Chief Operating Officer of John W. Henry & Company, Inc., a
commodity trading advisor, and member of its Investment Policy Committee, and
President and Director of Westport Capital Management Corporation and Global
Capital Management Limited, both investment management firms, since 1998. Prior
to that, he was the Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of the
Harvard Management Company, Inc., a wholly owned subsidiary of Harvard
University, since 1983. He is a member of the Global Markets Advisory Committee
of the Commodity Futures Trading Commission and a member of the Board of
Trustees of

                                       53
<PAGE>


Commonfund Capital, Inc. Mr. Sedlacek is a director of the Futures Industry
Association and is a certified public accountant.

     Leon C. Shender has been an IOM Director since January 1999. He has been a
floor trader since 1976. A member of the Exchange for more than twenty-three
years, Mr. Shender owns one IOM membership.

     William R. Shepard has been an IMM Director since January 1997. He is the
founder of and has been President of Shepard International, Inc., a futures
commission merchant, for more than five years. A member of the Exchange for more
than twenty-six years, Mr. Shepard owns one CME membership, one IMM membership,
one IOM membership and five fractional GEM membership interests.

     Howard J. Siegel has been a CME Director since January 2000. He has been a
floor trader since 1977. A member of the Exchange for more than twenty-two
years, Mr. Siegel owns one CME membership, one IOM membership and three
fractional GEM membership interests.

     David I. Silverman has been an IMM Director since 1995 and was previously a
director from 1990 to 1991. He was chairman of GFX Corporation, a subsidiary of
the Exchange, from 1997 until 2000. He has been an independent trader since
1982. A member of the Exchange for more than seventeen years, Mr. Silverman owns
one IMM membership interest.

     Jeffrey L. Silverman has been a CME Director since 1994 and was our
Secretary in 1995. He has been a floor trader since 1979. A member of the
Exchange for more than twenty years, Mr. Silverman owns one CME membership and
two fractional GEM membership interests, and his wife owns one CME membership
and one fractional GEM membership interest.

     Paul Simon has been a director since February 1997. He has been a Professor
at Southern Illinois University since 1997. He also serves on the board of Penn-
American Insurance Co. Mr. Simon was a U.S. Senator from Illinois from 1984
through 1997. Prior to that, he was a U.S. Congressman.

     Craig S. Donohue has been the Managing Director of Business Development and
Corporate/Legal Affairs since March 2000, having previously served since October
1998 as Senior Vice President and General Counsel. Prior to that he was Vice
President, Market Regulation from 1997 to 1998 and Vice President and Associate
General Counsel from 1995 to 1997.

     Phupinder Gill has been the Managing Director and President of the Clearing
House Division since March 2000, having previously served as President, Clearing
House Division since July 1998. Prior to that, he served as Senior Vice
President, since May 1997, and Vice President, since May 1994. Mr. Gill has held
numerous other positions with the Exchange since 1988.

     David G. Gomach has been Managing Director and Chief Financial Officer
since March 2000, having previously served as Senior Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer since January 1998. Prior to that, he served as Vice
President, Administration and Finance, since December 1996. He is a certified
public accountant.

                                       54
<PAGE>


     Satish Nandapurkar has been Managing Director of e-Business since joining
the Exchange in March 2000. Prior to joining the Exchange, he was Head of
Strategic Solutions for OptiMark Technologies. Prior to that, he served as
Managing Director and Global Head of Foreign Exchange Options for the Bank of
America in Chicago from 1997 to 1999, Managing Director and Head of Structured
Equity Products Trading at Deutsche Morgan Grenfell from 1996 to 1997, and
Managing Director and Global Head of Exotic Options and Quantitative
Methodologies for Swiss Bank Corporation in London from 1994 to 1996.

     Amy M. Savin has been Managing Director and Chief Marketing Officer since
March 2000, having previously served as Senior Vice President of Marketing
Programs and services since joining the Exchange in 1998. For seven years prior
to that, she was a Senior Brand Manager at Kraft Foods.

     Donald D. Serpico has been Managing Director of Operations since March
2000, having previously served as Executive Vice President, Operations since
July 1994. He previously served as our Senior Vice President, Operations, since
1988, Senior Vice President of the Clearing House from 1987, and Vice President
of Management Information Systems from 1985.

     Lewis C. Ting has been Mnaging Director of Organizational Development since
joining the Exchange in March 2000. Since 1996, he has owned a consulting
business specializing in human resources, employee development and
organizational change. Prior to that, he served as a Senior Vice President for
Talegen, an insurance subsidiary of Xerox's Financial Services Division.

Director Compensation

     Each director of New CME will receive an annual directors fee of $20,000,
plus a meeting attendance fee of $1,000 for each regular meeting of the board
that they attend, excluding special administrative meetings. Directors also
receive reimbursement of expenses for travel to board meetings.

     The Chairman of the Board receives an annual stipend of $350,000, plus
reimbursement of other board-related expenses. The four additional board
officers each receive an annual stipend of $50,000 and a meeting attendance fee
of $1,000 for each regular meeting of the board that they attend, plus
reimbursement of other board-related expenses. The Chairman Emeritus and Senior
Policy Advisor, and the Special Policy Advisor, each receive an annual stipend
of $200,000, plus reimbursement of other board-related expenses.

Committees of the Board of Directors

     New CME's board of directors will have an Executive Committee, an Audit
Committee, a Compensation Committee and a Nominating Committee. It is expected
that members of these committees will be elected by New CME's board following
the effectiveness of the demutualization transactions. These committees will
have the following functions:

     Executive Committee. This committee has and may exercise the authority of
the board of directors, when the board is not in session, except in cases where
action of the entire board is

                                       55
<PAGE>

required by the charter, the by-laws or applicable law.

     Audit Committee. New CME will have an Audit Committee, composed of
directors who are not employees, which will review the results and scope of the
audit and other services provided by our independent auditors as well as our
accounting and internal control procedures and policies.

     Compensation Committee. New CME will have a Compensation Committee composed
of directors who are not employees. It will oversee the compensation and
benefits of New CME's management and employees.

     Nominating Committee. This committee will review the qualifications of
potential candidates and will propose nominees for the thirteen positions on the
board of directors that are nominated by the board. This committee will be
comprised of five directors selected by the board. The board will strive to have
a Nominating Committee that reflects the diversity of the board. It is expected
that seven of the thirteen positions to be filled by the Nominating Committee
will be filled with candidates who satisfy the public participation regulatory
requirements to which the Exchange is subject. This committee will consider
nominees recommended by stockholders if the recommendations are submitted in
writing, accompanied by a description of the proposed nominee's qualifications
and other relevant biographical information and evidence of the consent of the
proposed nominee. The recommendations should be addressed to the Nominating
Committee, in care of the Corporate Secretary. Under New CME's by-laws,
nominations may not be made at the annual meeting.

Limitation of Liability and Indemnification Matters

     New CME's charter limits the liability of directors to the maximum extent
permitted by Delaware law. Delaware law provides that directors of a corporation
will not be personally liable for monetary damages for breach of their fiduciary
duties as directors, except liability for:

     .    any breach of their duty of loyalty to the corporation or its
          stockholders;

     .    acts or omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional
          misconduct or a knowing violation of law;

     .    unlawful payments of dividends or unlawful stock repurchases or
          redemptions; or

     .    any transaction from which the director derived an improper personal
          benefit.

This limitation of liability does not apply to liabilities arising under the
federal securities laws and does not affect the availability of equitable
remedies (i.e., injunctive relief or rescission).

     New CME's charter and by-laws provide that it shall indemnify its directors
and executive officers and may indemnify its other officers and employees and
other agents to the fullest extent permitted by law. We believe that
indemnification under the provisions of the by-laws covers at least negligence
and gross negligence on the part of the indemnified parties. The by-laws also
permit New CME to secure insurance on behalf of any officer, director, employee

                                       56
<PAGE>

or other agent for any liability arising out of his or her actions in that
capacity, regardless of whether the by-laws would permit indemnification.

Executive Compensation

     The following table sets forth information relating to the compensation
paid to, accrued or earned by our chief executive officers and each of the next
four most highly compensated executive officers for services rendered during the
year ended December 31, 1999.

                                       57
<PAGE>

                          Summary Compensation Table

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                            Annual Compensation
                                              ------------------------------------------------
                                                                             Other Annual           All Other
Name and Principal Position                       Salary        Bonus        Compensation        Compensation (3)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                           <C>               <C>          <C>                 <C>
T. Eric Kilcollin (1)                              $143,000            $0                 $0             $1,063,890
     President and Chief Executive
     Officer (CEO)

Scott Gordon (2)                                          0             0            350,000                      0
     Chairman of the Board of
     Directors (CEO)

Fred D. Arditti                                     522,500       260,000                  0                140,599
     Senior Executive Vice President,
     Planning & Development

Gerald D. Beyer                                     522,500       210,000                  0                132,796
     Executive Vice President and
     Chief Operating Officer

Phupinder S. Gill                                   400,000       160,000                  0                 80,914
     President, Clearing House
     Division

William W. Jenks                                    270,000       120,000                  0                 65,111
     Executive Vice President,
     Management Information
     Systems
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

(1)  Mr. Kilcollin served as President through March 1999. In addition to his
     salary for the first three months of 1999 and the contributions made on his
     behalf to the qualified benefit plans outlined in note (3) below, Mr.
     Kilcollin received a cash payment at the date of his departure in the
     amount of $1,047,130. This table excludes amounts paid to Mr. Kilcollin
     under our qualified and non-qualified benefit plans relating to services
     performed in prior years.

(2)  Mr. Gordon served as Chairman of the Board of Directors during 1999 and
     received a stipend in the amount of $350,000 for these services. He has
     served as our chief executive officer during the remainder of 1999
     following the departure of Mr. Kilcollin.

(3)  The following table shows the amount of each category of "all other
     compensation" earned by each of the named individuals, in addition to the
     payment described in note (1) above:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>


                                    401(k) Matching      Pension        Supplemental        SERP*
                                     Contribution     Contribution          Plan        Contribution        Total
                                     ------------     ------------        ---------     ------------        -----
        <S>                         <C>               <C>               <C>             <C>                <C>
        Mr. Kilcollin (1)                $3,960         $12,800               $0              $0           $16,760
        Mr. Gordon                            0               0                0               0                 0
        Mr. Arditti                       4,800          14,400           62,599          58,800           140,599
        Mr. Beyer                         4,800          12,800           56,623          58,573           132,796
        Mr. Gill                          4,800           8,000           25,705          42,409            80,914
        Mr. Jenks                         4,800          11,200           18,693          30,418            65,111
</TABLE>

- ----------------------------------
* Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan.  See description below.

                                       58
<PAGE>

Employee Benefit Plans

     Omnibus Stock Plan. New CME has adopted an Omnibus Stock Plan under which
stock based awards may be made to employees of New CME. An aggregate of
2,600,000 Class A shares has been reserved for awards under the plan. Other than
the award made during 2000 to Mr. McNulty, described below under "Employment-
Related Agreements," no awards have been made to date under the plan.

     The plan authorizes the making or grant of the following types of awards
singly, in combination, or in tandem: (i) stock options, which may be either
"incentive stock options" (within the meaning of Section 422 of the Internal
Revenue Code) or non-qualified stock options; (ii) stock appreciation rights,
which allow the recipient to receive a payment equal to the appreciation in
market value of a stated number of Class A shares; (iii) stock awards, which may
be restricted or unrestricted; and (iv) other stock based awards.

     The plan will be administered by the Compensation Committee of New CME's
board. The Compensation Committee has the authority to interpret the plan, to
select employees of New CME to receive awards under the plan, and to determine
the form, amount and other terms and conditions of the awards. The committee
also has the power to modify or waive restrictions on awards, to amend awards
and to grant extensions and accelerate awards. No member of the Compensation
Committee is eligible to participate in the plan because committee members may
not include employees.

     401(k) Plan. The Exchange sponsors a 401(k)-type plan known as the "Tax
Efficient Savings Plan," which is a defined contribution retirement plan
intended to qualify under Section 401 of the Internal Revenue Code. Employees
are eligible to participate in this plan from the first day of employment. The
Plan permits additional contributions at the discretion of the Exchange.

     The following table describes the employee and employer contributions
permitted under the plan, and the vesting of those contributions:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                       Employee
                    Contributions                                 Employer Contributions
                    -------------                                 ----------------------
<S>               <C>                         <C>
Amount            1-15% of base pay*          Matching amount up to 3% of base pay
                                              Additional amount up to 2% of base pay based upon specified increases
                                              in trading volume

Vesting           100%                        100% at end of second plan year following year in which contributions
                                              made; 100% after five years of eligible service
</TABLE>

- ----------------
*Subject to plan limits and statutory annual limit.

                                       59
<PAGE>

The following chart demonstrates how vesting in the non-trading volume matching
contributions occurs with respect to a hypothetical employee who was hired on
August 1, 1995:

                       Vesting in Matching Contributions

                  Year Contribution                  Date the Contribution
                  Is Made                            Becomes Vested
                  -------                            --------------
                  1995                               December 31, 1997
                  1996                               December 31, 1998
                  1997                               December 31, 1999
                  1998                               August 1, 2000
                  1999                               August 1, 2000
                  2000                               August 1, 2000

Also, an employee becomes 100% vested in the matching contributions if they
reach age 65 or become disabled or die before they complete five years of
service with the Exchange.

     Pension Plan. We also maintain a non-contributory defined benefit cash
balance pension plan for eligible employees. To be eligible, an employee must
have completed a continuous 12-month period of employment with us and have
reached the age of 21. Effective January 15, 1995, the pension plan was amended
to provide for an age-based contribution to a cash balance account, and to
include cash bonuses in the definition of considered earnings. Our policy is to
fund currently required pension costs. Participants become vested in their
accounts after five years of service. An individual pension account is
maintained for each plan participant. During employment, each individual pension
account is credited with an amount equal to an age-based percentage of that
individual's considered earnings plus interest at the one-year U.S Treasury Bill
rate. The pension account is portable, and vested balances may be paid out when
a participant leaves the Exchange. Alternatively, a participant may elect to
receive the balance in the account in the form of one of various monthly
annuities. The following is the schedule of the employer contributions based on
age:

                                                Employer Contribution
                         Age                                 Percentage
                     ------------               -----------------------
                     under age 30                        3%
                     age 30 - 34                         4%
                     age 35 - 39                         5%
                     age 40 - 44                         6%
                     age 45 - 49                         7%
                     age 50 - 54                         8%
                     over age 54                         9%

     The individuals named below have projected annual retirement benefits,
based on current accumulated balances, an annual interest credit rate of 6% and
future service to age 65 at current salary levels as follows: Mr. Kilcollin,
none; Mr. Gordon, none; Mr. Arditti, $10,600; Mr. Beyer, $51,500; Mr. Gill,
$92,600; and Mr. Jenks, $43,600.

     Non-Qualified Plans. The Exchange maintains the following non-qualified
plans which

                                       60
<PAGE>

are not subject to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 under
which participants may make assumed investment choices with respect to amounts
contributed on their behalf. Although not required to do so, the Exchange
invests the contributions in assets which mirror the assumed investment choices.
The balances in these plans are subject to the claims of general creditors of
the Exchange.

     .    Deferred Compensation Plan - The Exchange maintains a deferred
          compensation plan under which eligible officers and board members may
          contribute a percentage of their compensation and defer income taxes
          thereon until the time of distribution.

     .    Supplemental Plan - The Exchange maintains a non-qualified
          supplemental plan to provide benefits for officers who have been
          impacted by statutory limits under the provisions of the qualified
          401(k) and pension plans.

     .    Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan ("SERP") - The Exchange
          maintains a non-qualified, defined contribution plan for senior
          officers. Under the plan, the Exchange contributes an amount equal to
          8% of salary and bonus of eligible employees annually. Post 1996
          contributions are subject to a vesting schedule under which each
          annual contribution begins to vest after three years and is fully
          vested after five years.

Employment-Related Agreements

     Mr. McNulty

     The Exchange has entered into an employment agreement with James J. McNulty
to serve as its President and Chief Executive Officer through December 31, 2003,
subject to renewal by mutual agreement of the parties. Under the agreement, Mr.
McNulty will receive an annual base salary of $1 million. He is also entitled to
an annual incentive bonus based upon the achievement of goals set by the board
of directors, which bonus may not exceed the lesser of $1.5 million or, after
demutualization, 10 percent of New CME's net income. The agreement provides for
reimbursement of business expenses, perquisites, and legal fees associated with
the negotiation of the employment agreement. Mr. McNulty will be eligible to
participate in other benefit plans available generally to senior officers of the
CME. As partial compensation for actual compensation, benefits and programs that
Mr. McNulty was, or was reasonably expected to become, entitled to receive from
his previous employer, he received a lump-sum payment of $2 million.

     Mr. McNulty has also been granted a non-transferable non-qualified stock
option, which is designed to reward him for increasing the value of New CME. If
the total value of the Exchange increases, exercise of the option would entitle
him to receive essentially 2.5% of the increase above the starting valuation and
2.5% of the increase, if any, in excess of 150% of the starting valuation. If
the demutualization is completed, the option would entitle him to purchase from
New CME two "baskets" of New CME stock. Each basket is composed of up to 2.5% of
the outstanding shares of New CME, although New CME may elect to issue solely
shares of Class A common stock or cash upon any exercise. The baskets have
aggregate exercise prices of 2.5% and 3.75%, respectively, of the value of the
Exchange on the date of commencement of Mr. McNulty's employment. The option
will expire in ten years. It may be exercised only if the

                                       61
<PAGE>


demutualization transaction is completed, and then only as to the portion of the
option that has vested. The option vests 40 percent after the first year and 20
percent in each of the succeeding three years, subject to acceleration in the
event of Mr. McNulty's termination without cause or forfeiture in the event of
his termination for cause. The option remains exercisable in full for its
remaining term following (i) a termination by the Exchange of the employment
agreement without cause or due to Mr. McNulty's disability, (ii) a termination
of the employment agreement by Mr. McNulty where the Exchange has in effect
terminated his employment by moving the Exchange outside metropolitan Chicago,
demoting him, significantly reducing his responsibilities or failing to pay him
the agreed compensation and benefits under the agreement or (iii) upon the
expiration of the original term of the employment agreement. Any vested portion
of the option is exercisable for a period of 180 days following a termination by
Mr. McNulty of the employment agreement. The Exchange will follow variable
accounting for the option up to the date of closing of the demutualization
transactions. This accounting method will require quarterly charges or credits
to income to recognize a portion of any change in the value of the option due to
changes in the value of Exchange memberships. As a result, the Exchange's
reported earnings until the demutualization is completed will be more volatile
as a result of fluctuations in the value of those memberships. For example, due
to the recent significant increase in membership values, we expect that an
expense charge of $1.5 million will be recorded for the option for the first
quarter of 2000.

     The agreement provides that it may be terminated by the Exchange due to Mr.
McNulty's death or disability, or for cause on thirty days written notice or
without cause on ninety days written notice. In addition, Mr. McNulty may
terminate the agreement at anytime after one year upon ninety days written
notice. He may also terminate the agreement for "good reason" if the Exchange's
principal place of business is relocated outside of the Chicago metropolitan
area, the Exchange fails, after notice, to pay the agreed-upon compensation or
benefits or the Exchange fails, after notice, to rectify a situation in which he
is, in effect, terminated due to a demotion or a significant reduction of his
responsibilities. The agreement provides that, in the event of a termination
without cause by the Exchange, Mr. McNulty shall be entitled to receive his base
salary for the remainder of the original term plus one-third of the maximum
annual incentive bonus. The agreement also provides that, in the event that Mr.
McNulty terminates his employment after its first year on less than ninety days
written notice, other than following one of the matters previously described as
"good reason," the Exchange may recover from him a sum equal to his annual base
salary, computed daily, for each day his notice of termination is less than
ninety days. If Mr. McNulty's employment is terminated because of his death or
disability, he or his beneficiary will continue to receive the base salary for
six months following that termination. In the event of his death, his option
will vest and be paid in cash. The Exchange intends to purchase key man life
insurance to assist in funding payments that would be required in the event of
Mr. McNulty's death.

     In the event the demutualization is not completed by December 31, 2000,
either the Exchange or Mr. McNulty may terminate the agreement, subject to
conditions, prior to January 31, 2001. In that case, Mr. McNulty shall continue
to receive his annual base salary plus one-third of the maximum annual incentive
bonus for the remainder of the original term of the agreement unless he becomes
employed by a competitor to the Exchange. In addition, his option shall be
forfeited.

     The agreement also provides that, if within two years of a "change in
control" of the Exchange, Mr. McNulty is terminated by the Exchange or he
terminates the agreement as a result

                                       62
<PAGE>

of the occurrence of one of the matters described previously as "good reason,"
he shall be entitled to two times his base salary plus one and one-third times
the maximum incentive bonus for which he would have been eligible, provided that
the severance payments do not exceed $8 million. The payment would be subject to
reduction to the extent that it would otherwise result in the payment of tax
under Section 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code. Any unvested portion of his
option would immediately vest and become exercisable for a one or three year
period, depending upon whether the option securities are registered under the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

     Messrs. Arditti, Beyer, Gill and Jenks

     The Exchange has employment agreements with each of Messrs. Arditti, Beyer,
Gill and Jenks regarding their employment as executives of the Exchange. Each
agreement is for an initial period of approximately two years, with the
agreement of Mr. Jenks ending June 30, 2000, the agreement with Mr. Gill ending
August 31, 2001, the agreement with Mr. Beyer ending April 12, 2001 and the
agreement with Mr. Arditti ending June 30, 2001. Unless an agreement is renewed
by the parties, it ceases to apply following its expiration even if the covered
individual remains employed by the Exchange.

     The agreements provide that annual increases to an Executive's base salary
are to be determined by the Exchange in accordance with its compensation
policies and practices. The executives are also entitled to participate in a
discretionary bonus program and in other benefit plans available generally to
Exchange employees and officers.

     The Exchange may terminate an agreement in the event of the executive's
death or disability and also may terminate it for cause. The executive may
terminate the agreement at any time and for any reason on at least sixty days
written notice. In the event of a merger, sale, reorganization or other change
in control of the Exchange, the agreements would be binding upon and inure to
the benefit of any successor of the Exchange. In the event of a termination of
an executive's employment for cause, the executive is entitled to any accrued,
but unused, vacation pay.

     An executive's obligations under his employment agreement are suspended in
the event that he becomes disabled and receives benefits under the Exchange's
long-term disability insurance program, subject to reinstatement if he returns
to his original position. If the executive returns to work in a different
position or does not return to work at all upon the conclusion of his
disability, the employment agreement will be terminated. If employment is
terminated due to death or disability, an executive's legal representatives or
the executive will receive his base salary for a period of six months following
the termination.

     Mr. Arditti resigned his position effective April 1, 2000. Pursuant to an
amendment to his employment agreement, he received $640,385 from the Exchange,
representing one-year's base salary and his accrued but unused vacation pay as
of his resignation date. He will also receive a lump sum amount equal to his
non-vested amounts in the Exchange's Tax Efficient Savings Plan, the Pension
Plan for Employees of the Chicago Mercantile Exchange, the Senior Management
Supplemental Deferred Savings Plan and the Supplemental Executive Retirement
Plan. Mr. Arditti and his dependents will remain covered under the Exchange's
current health, dental and vision insurance plans until the first anniversary of
his resignation. After that date,

                                       63
<PAGE>


these benefits will be provided as required under the Consolidated Omnibus
Budget Reconciliation Act ("COBRA"). These insurance benefits terminate if Mr.
Arditti obtains other employment offering comparable coverage and at the time he
first becomes eligible for the coverage. The Exchange also has the right to pay
Mr. Arditti to convert his life and accidental death and dismemberment insurance
to individual coverage, to obtain equivalent individual coverage or to continue
the coverage already in place.

     Messr. Jenks and Beyer resigned their positions effective March 24, 2000
and April 12, 2000, respectively. Pursuant to their separation agreements, the
Exchange paid to Messr. Jenks and Beyer severance payments of $108,750 and $1
million, respectively. These sums, in part, satisfied the Exchange's obligations
for accrued and unused vacation pay due Messr. Jenks and Beyer as of the
effective dates of their resignations. The Exchange also reimbursed them for all
business and transportation expenses they had incurred through the dates of
their resignations. Mr. Jenks is and, on May 1, 2000, Mr. Beyer will become
eligible, at their own cost, for the Exchange's health, dental, and vision
insurance plans offered pursuant to the terms of COBRA. This coverage terminates
for a former employee once he obtains other employment offering comparable
coverage and first becomes eligible for the coverage.

     Mr. Kilcollin

     The Exchange had an employment agreement with T. Eric Kilcollin to serve as
its President and Chief Executive Officer from February 1, 1997 through March
31, 2000; however, Mr. Kilcollin resigned effective March 19, 1999. The
agreement provided for an initial base salary of $550,000, with increases at the
Exchange's sole discretion. Under the agreement, he was eligible for a
performance bonus and to participate in the Exchange's staff bonus program. He
was also entitled to an annual enhanced pension benefit in an amount equal to
ten percent of his base salary for the calendar year plus a gross-up payment to
negate the effect of the additional taxes incurred because of the benefit. Under
the agreement, he was entitled to reimbursement for various perquisites, an
annual lump sum payment of $12,500 for professional services and participation
in other benefit plans available generally to Exchange employees and officers.

     Under Mr. Kilcollin's separation agreement, the Exchange paid to Mr.
Kilcollin $591,982.96, representing his annual base salary and vacation benefits
through the original term of his employment agreement. He also received
$155,555, representing reimbursement of costs of perquisites and of professional
services he was expected to incur through March 31, 2000 and of amounts owed to
him as the enhanced pension benefit, plus an additional bonus of $200,000. The
Exchange also agreed to reimburse him, through March 31, 2000, for costs
incurred to obtain health, dental, vision, life and accidental death and
dismemberment insurance.

     Mr. Kilcollin's interests under the retirement and deferred compensation
plans in which he participated became fully vested as of his resignation date.
In all other respects, his rights and the Exchange's obligations pursuant to the
plans are determined by the terms of those plans. Mr. Kilcollin was paid a
single lump sum for amounts payable to him under the Exchange's Senior
Management Supplemental Deferred Savings Plan and the Supplemental Executive
Retirement Plan. In addition, he was paid $96,189.10, which represents the
present value, after a gross-up for income taxes, of the benefits he would have
received pursuant to the Pension Plan for Employees of the Chicago Mercantile
Exchange, the Exchange's Tax Efficient Savings Plan

                                       64
<PAGE>

and the Exchange's Supplemental Deferred Savings Plan had he remained employed
with the Exchange through the term of his agreement.

Beneficial Ownership of Management

     The following table lists the shares of capital stock of New CME that will
be beneficially owned following the demutualization by each of the directors,
each of the executive officers named in the Summary Compensation Table on page
58 and the Exchange's directors and executive officers as a group. This
information is based on the beneficial ownership by those persons of Exchange
membership interests as of December 31, 1999. There was no person known to the
Exchange to be the beneficial owner of more than five percent of the membership
interests of the Exchange as of December 31, 1999.

                                       65
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                       Total Equity
                                                                                       Expressed in
 Name of Beneficial       Class A    Percent of     Class B Shares     Percent of    Equivalent Class    Percent of
      Owner (1)            Shares      Class      Number     Series       Class        A shares (2)     Total Equity
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                       <C>        <C>          <C>        <C>       <C>           <C>                <C>
M. Scott Gordon            10,800         *           1      B-2 (3)         *              12,000            *
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Terrence A. Duffy          16,200         *           1        B-1           *              18,100            *
                                                      1        B-4
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
James E. Oliff             10,800         *           1        B-2           *              12,000            *
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Thomas A. Kloet            21,600         *           2      B-2 (4)         *              24,000            *
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Martin J. Gepsman           5,400         *           1        B-3           *               6,060            *
                                                      6        B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Leo Melamed                37,800         *           1      B-1 (5)         *              42,060            *
                                                      1        B-2
                                                      2        B-3
                                                      6        B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
John F. Sandner           102,600         *           3        B-1           *             113,010            *
                                                      2        B-2
                                                      6      B-3 (6)
                                                     14        B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
H. Jack Bouroudjian         5,400         *           1        B-3           *               6,000            *
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Timothy R. Brennan         21,600         *           1        B-1           *              24,020            *
                                                      1        B-3
                                                      2        B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Jeffrey R. Carter          21,600         *           1        B-1           *              24,000            *
                                                      1        B-3
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
E. Gerald Corrigan              0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Rahm Emanuel                    0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Yra G. Harris              27,000         *           3      B-2 (7)         *              30,000            *
                                                      1        B-3
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Robert L. Haworth          16,200         *           1        B-1           *              18,100            *
                                                      1        B-4
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Leslie Henner Burns        21,600         *           2        B-1           *              24,020            *
                                                      2        B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

________________________
*    Less than one percent.
1    The address for all persons listed in the table is Chicago Mercantile
     Exchange, 30 South Wacker Drive, Chicago, Illinois 60606.
2    Class A equivalent shares are based on the number of Class A shares and the
     number of Class A shares that each series of Class B shares owned is
     considered to represent.  See "Description of Common Stock" under
     "Description of Capital Stock of New CME."
3    Share will be held in a trust over which Mr. Gordon will have investment
     and voting power.
4    Includes one series B-2 share held by ABN AMRO Bank, N.V., over which Mr.
     Kloet will have voting power.
5    Mr. Melamed will have voting and investment power over the indicated
     shares, which are owned by Sakura Dellsher, Inc.
*    Less than one percent.
6    Mr. Sandner will have voting and investment power over two series B-3
     shares held by RB&H Financial Services L.P.
7    Mr. Harris will have sole voting power over one series B-2 share.

                                       66
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                       Total Equity
                                                                                       Expressed in
 Name of Beneficial       Class A    Percent of     Class B Shares     Percent of    Equivalent Class    Percent of
      Owner (1)            Shares      Class      Number     Series       Class        A shares (2)     Total Equity
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                       <C>        <C>          <C>        <C>       <C>           <C>                <C>
Bruce F. Johnson           16,200         *           1        B-1           *              18,100              *
                                                      1        B-4
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Gary M. Katler              5,400         *           1      B-3 (8)         *               6,100
                                                      1        B-4
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Paul Kimball                    0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
John Lacey                      0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Merton Miller                   0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
William Miller                  0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Laurence E. Mollner             0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Patrick J. Mulchrone       32,400         *           1        B-1           *              36,100              *
                                                      1        B-2
                                                      1        B-3
                                                      1        B-4
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
John D. Newhouse           37,800         *           3        B-2           *              42,040              *
                                                      1        B-3
                                                      4        B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Mark G. Papadopoulos            0                     2        B-4           *                 200              *
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ward Parkinson                  0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Robert J. Prosi            27,000         *           1        B-1           *              30,000              *
                                                      2      B-3 (9)
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
David M. Pryde             97,200         *           1      B-1 (10)        *             108,000
                                                      3        B-2
                                                      9        B-3
                                                     17        B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Irwin Rosen                21,600         *           1        B-1           *              24,010              *
                                                      1        B-3
                                                      1        B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
William G. Salatich, Jr.   16,200         *           1        B-1           *              18,020              *
                                                      2        B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Verne Sedlacek                  0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Leon C. Shender             5,400         *           1        B-3           *               6,000              *
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
William R. Shepard         32,400         *           1        B-1           *              36,050              *
                                                      1        B-2
                                                      1        B-3
                                                      5        B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Howard J. Siegel           21,600         *           1        B-1           *              24,030              *
                                                      1        B-3
                                                      3        B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
David I. Silverman         10,800         *           1        B-2           *              12,000              *
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

_____________________
*    Less than one percent.

1    The address for all persons listed in the table is Chicago Mercantile
     Exchange, 30 South Wacker Drive, Chicago, Illinois 60606.

2    Class A equivalent shares are based on the number of Class A shares and the
     number of Class A shares that each series of Class B shares owned is
     considered to represent. See "Description of Common Stock" under
     "Description of Capital Stock of New CME."
8    Mr. Katler will have voting power over one series B-3 share.
9    Mr. Prosi will have voting power over one series B-3 share.
10   Mr. Pryde will have voting power over each of the series B-1, B-2, B-3 and
     B-5 shares, which will be owned by several employees of his employer, J. P.
     Morgan Futures, Inc.

                                       67
<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                       Total Equity
                                                                                       Expressed in
 Name of Beneficial       Class A    Percent of     Class B Shares     Percent of    Equivalent Class    Percent of
      Owner (1)            Shares      Class      Number     Series       Class        A shares (2)     Total Equity
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                       <C>        <C>          <C>        <C>       <C>           <C>                <C>
Jeffrey L. Silverman       16,200         *           1       B-1            *              18,020            *
                                                      2       B-5
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Paul Simon                      0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Fred D. Arditti                 0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Gerald D. Beyer                 0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Craig S. Donohue                0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Phupinder Gill                  0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
David G. Gomach                 0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
William W. Jenks                0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Donald D. Serpico               0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Carol B. Sexton                 0                                                                0
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Directors and Executive
  Officers as a group     507,600                                                          564,980          1.96
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

*    Less than one percent.

1    The address for all persons listed in the table is Chicago Mercantile
     Exchange, 30 South Wacker Drive, Chicago, Illinois 60606.

2    Class A equivalent shares are based on the number of Class A shares and the
     number of Class A shares that each series of Class B shares owned is
     considered to represent. See "Description of Common Stock" under
     "Description of Capital Stock of New CME."


                                   BUSINESS

     Founded in 1898, the Exchange is one of the world's leading exchanges for
the trading of futures and options on futures contracts, with total volume in
1999 of approximately 201 million contracts. The underlying value of the
commodities involved in transactions (often referred to as the "notional
value"), a comprehensive measure of economic activity, was approximately $138
trillion in 1999--exceeding that of any other derivatives exchange in the world.
According to industry data, we ranked third worldwide among major futures
exchanges in volume of contracts traded in 1999. That data also showed that we
ranked second in terms of open interest -- representing the number of futures
contracts and options positions outstanding at the close of trading. From our
origins as a small agricultural market, we have evolved into a major financial
center offering a diverse range of contracts based on interest rates, equity
indices, foreign currencies, agricultural commodities and other underlying
instruments and risk-based activities.

     We operate markets for the trading of commodity and financial futures
contracts, as well as options on futures contracts. These contracts have been
developed through our extensive research and development efforts and through
relationships that we have developed with market participants and other
financial institutions. We operate traditional open outcry auction markets where
members trade among themselves for their own account and the account of their
customers in a room known as a pit. We also operate an electronic trading
system--now known as our GLOBEX2 system-and were one of the first major futures
exchanges in the world to develop an electronic system. We also match, clear,
settle and guarantee all transactions executed on the Exchange through the CME
Clearing House, and we engage in extensive regulatory, compliance, market
surveillance and financial supervision activities designed to ensure market
integrity and provide financial safeguards for users of our markets. Our
traditional open outcry and electronic trade execution services provide "price
discovery" and trade matching services that offer market participants complete
price transparency, anonymity and immediacy. Our Clearing House provides market
participants with clearing, settlement, risk management and guarantee services
that provide near immediate transaction finality, resulting in the mitigation of
counterparty credit risk. We also market and distribute valuable real-time and
historical market data generated from trading activity in our markets to users
of our products and

                                       68
<PAGE>


related cash and derivative markets.

         Market participants include many of the world's largest banks and
investment firms. These participants use our products for hedging, risk
management, asset allocation, and speculation. Other market users include
financial institutions, such as public and private pension funds, mutual funds,
hedge funds and other managed funds, insurance companies, corporations,
commercial banks, professional independent traders, and retail customers. Our
users can be broadly categorized as hedgers or speculators--depending on whether
they transfer risk or accept risk. Hedgers are market participants who want to
transfer price risk in an underlying commodity (e.g., cattle) or financial
instrument (e.g., cash foreign currency or an interest rate swap agreement).
Speculators, on the other hand, accept price risk and attempt to make profits
through buying and selling futures contracts by anticipating price changes. A
speculator has no interest in making or taking delivery of the underlying
commodity. Our members serve as liquidity providers for our markets and as
financial intermediaries for customers who use our products.

         We have developed innovative and cost-effective products, execution and
order routing systems, and clearing systems that have led to substantial volume
and to the benefit of our members and customers. As indicated in the chart
below, volume in our products remains strong and substantially greater today
than volume prior to 1994, despite recent fluctuations in volume. Fluctuations
in interest rate volatility, declines in currency volatility, growth in equity
trading, and the business cycle of the U.S. economy have led to the fluctuations
in our volume.

         [Graphic: Bar graph entitled and showing "CME ANNUAL VOLUME OF
CONTRACTS TRADED 1990 - 1999". Below the horizontal axis each year for which
trading volume is measured is written in chronological order from left to right.
The vertical axis indicates the number of contracts traded, in millions,
beginning with zero and increasing, in intervals of 50, up to 250. The lower
portion of each bar is darkly shaded to the extent of the futures contracts
traded and the upper portion is lightly shaded to the extent of the options
contracts traded. Inset in a small square to the right of the graph is a legend
containing a lightly shaded box to the immediate left of the word "Options" and
immediately below which is a darkly shaded box to the immediate left of the word
"Futures". Futures contracts were traded at a rate of approximately 84 million
in 1990, 87 million in 1991, 107 million in 1992, 116 million in 1993, 176
million in 1994, 160 million in 1995, 141 million in 1996, 160 million in 1997,
184 million in 1998 and 168 million in 1999. Options contracts were traded at
the rate of approximately 18 million in 1990, 21 million in 1991, 27 million in
1992, 30 million in 1993, 50 million in 1994, 43 million in 1995, 35 million in
1996, 41 million in 1997, 43 million in 1998 and 33 million in 1999.]

         Presently, derivatives markets are experiencing significant and rapid
changes due to relaxation of regulatory barriers and advances in technology.
Foreign exchanges and exchange-like enterprises operated by or for banks and
broker-dealers have gained increased access to U.S. markets through regulatory
concessions. Computer and telecommunications systems today can efficiently and
economically bring buyers and sellers together, presenting new challenges to
centralized open outcry auction markets. These changes are lowering barriers to
entry and creating a lower cost business model, forcing traditional exchanges to
streamline their operations and reduce costs. Large market users, and the threat
of competition, will force exchanges to seek more efficient trading, processing
and clearing facilities. We have responded to these

                                       69
<PAGE>


challenges, and positioned the Exchange to preserve and enhance our current
business, by implementing technology to streamline our trade execution and
clearing facilities, by refining our existing products and developing innovative
new products to satisfy customer demands, and by continually enhancing the
ability of our independent traders to provide liquidity in our markets.

         In order to continue to enhance our ability to compete in this dynamic
marketplace, our organizational strategy is to convert the Exchange to a
demutualized for-profit corporation. We intend to improve our governance and
managerial structure by reducing our board size and focusing the role of the
board on traditional oversight activities. We will reduce significantly the
number and responsibility of existing committees and will enhance and expand the
responsibility and authority of our management and professional staff. The
demutualization will also reduce members' petition and referenda rights, except
for the approval rights reserved to Class B stockholders with respect to Core
Rights. We believe that demutualization will better enable us to strengthen,
expand and defend our core business.

         Our core business consists of four main areas: development of risk
management products; operating execution facilities for those products;
providing clearing and settlement services; and collecting and selling market
data. Revenues from the first three business areas referred to in the preceding
sentence are derived from bundled clearing and transaction fees, which
represented 66% of total 1999 revenues. Revenue from the dissemination of market
quote data represented 21% of total 1999 revenue.

Products

         The range and diversity of the products that may be traded on the
Exchange's facilities contributes significantly to our success. These products
include futures contracts and options on futures contracts based upon interest
rates, stock indices, foreign currencies, agricultural commodities and other
underlying instruments and risk-based activities. We also offer
exchange-for-physical transaction ("EFP") markets. These transactions involve
simultaneous transactions in the futures and cash commodity markets in which one
party establishes or liquidates a futures position in one of our products and
the other party sells or purchases the underlying cash commodity. We have a
research division and a marketing division to support market participants and
foster the trading and development of current and future products. Our research
and marketing staffs meet regularly with market users, members and clearing
members to determine whether our current products, facilities and services meet
these participants' needs and whether modifications or enhancements are
necessary. Our research and marketing staffs also develop new product ideas in
consultation with market users and other financial institutions. The charts
below depict the distribution of trading volumes and clearing fee revenues
across our four major product sectors.

         [Graphic: Pie chart entitled "1999 CME TRADE VOLUME SUMMARY" and
representing the trading volume in each of the CME's four major product sectors
as a percentage of the total trading volume. The entire chart represents and is
subtitled "(100% = 201 million contracts". Trading volume percentages are:
Interest Rate Products - 60%, Equity Index Products - 24%, Currency Products -
12% and Agricultural Products - 4%.]

                                       70
<PAGE>

         [Graphic: Pie chart entitled "1999 CLEARING FEE REVENUE" and
representing the sources of clearing fee revenue as a percentage of total
clearing fee revenue. The chart represents and is subtitled "(100% = $138.5
MILLION)", with revenue distributed as follows: Interest Rate Products - 36%,
Currency Products - 32%, Equity Index Products - 27% and Agricultural Products -
5%.]

         Interest Rate Products. Our interest rate product line includes our
Eurodollar futures and options contracts. Eurodollar futures and option
contracts are a short term interest rate product and constitute one of the most
successful products in our industry. The notional value of outstanding
Eurodollar futures contracts typically exceeds $2.5 trillion on any given day.
We also trade contracts based upon other short-term U.S. and foreign interest
rates, such as one-month LIBOR, which stands for London Interbank Offered Rate,
contracts and Euroyen. Eurodollars are U.S. dollars on deposit in commercial
banks outside of the United States. The Eurodollar market has burgeoned over the
past thirty years into a major international capital market as the dollar has
become a world reserve currency. Eurodollar deposits play a major role in the
international capital markets. The interbank market for immediate (spot) and
forward delivery of offshore dollars is deep and liquid, giving banks the
ability to fund dollar loans to foreign importers without incurring currency
exchange risks. Our market users are generally banks and other financial
institutions that face interest rate risks from their lending and borrowing
activities or their activities as dealers in OTC interest rate swaps and
structured derivative products. Many swap dealers use our Eurodollar and other
interest rate contracts to hedge and/or arbitrage their money market swaps and
to convert a floating interest rate exposure to a fixed rate exposure. A
significant number of our clearing member firms are affiliates of major domestic
and international banks who utilize our interest rate markets for their
proprietary trading activities. Asset managers also use our interest rate
products to lengthen the effective maturity of short-term investment assets by
buying futures contracts, or shorten the effective maturity by selling futures.
Our contracts are an attractive alternative when physical restructuring of a
portfolio is not possible or when futures transaction costs are less than the
cash market transaction costs.

         Market users take advantage of the flexibility and liquidity of the
Eurodollar products we trade, which span forty-four contract months covering ten
years of short-term interest rate risk. Further, by trading multiple contract
months, market users can hedge and speculate on long-term interest rate
movements. We have introduced innovative product extensions--Eurodollar Bundles
and Packs--in order to facilitate these trading strategies. Eurodollar Bundles
allow traders to simultaneously buy or sell a pre-packaged 1-, 2-, 3-, 4-, 5-,
7- or 10-year "strip" of individual contracts in a single transaction, rather
than constructing the same positions with individual contracts. Similarly,
Eurodollar Packs allow traders to simultaneously purchase or sell a consecutive
series of four Eurodollar futures. To benefit further market users, we have
implemented a series of product enhancements in recent years. We introduced
quarter-tick (smaller price increment) trading for "front-month expiring"
(contracts closest to expiration) Eurodollar and LIBOR futures and options
contracts and we expanded half-tick trading through the twentieth quarterly
Eurodollar expiration. We also implemented all-or-none trading in the quarterly
expirations of Eurodollar futures, and in Eurodollar options contracts,
permitting transactions to be executed in full, at the size and price specified.
All of these changes have reduced costs and enhanced efficiency for market
participants.

                                       71
<PAGE>


         As depicted in the chart below, our interest rate product trading
volumes have fluctuated over the last five years. These fluctuations reflect
primarily changes in central bank monetary policies and changing levels of
interest rate volatility during these periods, rather than reflecting successful
competition from other exchanges or increased use of alternative products or
markets by market users. Presently, many banks that use Eurodollar futures have
adopted internal systems that allow separate divisions within the bank to offset
their positions as an alternative to using our markets. Despite these
activities, volume in these products continues to remain strong, and they
constitute a significant part of our business.

         [Graphic: Bar graph representing and entitled "VOLUME OF INTEREST RATE
CONTRACTS TRADED 1994 - 1999". Below the horizontal axis each year for which
interest rate trading volume is measured is listed in chronological order from
left to right. The vertical axis indicates the number of interest rate contracts
traded, in millions, beginning with zero and increasing, in intervals of 50, to
150. The lower portion of each bar is darkly shaded to the extent of the futures
contracts traded and the top portion of each bar is lightly shaded to the extent
of options contracts traded. Inset in a small square to the right of the graph
is a legend containing a lightly shaded box to the immediate left of the word
"Options" and immediately below which is a darkly shaded box to the immediate
left of the word "Futures". Futures contracts were traded at the rate of
approximately 119 million in 1994, 110 million in 1995, 91 million in 1996, 103
million in 1997, 112 million in 1998 and 95 million in 1999. Options contracts
were traded at the rate of approximately 20 million in 1994, 21 million in 1995,
22 million in 1996, 25 million in 1997, 33 million in 1998 and 25 million in
1999.]

         Stock Index Products. We offer trading in futures and options contracts
based upon the S&P 500(R) and Nasdaq 100(R) stock indices, as well as other
domestic and foreign small, medium and large cap indices. Over 90% of our volume
in stock index products is in products based on the S&P 500 Index, to which we
have an exclusive contract. Standard & Poor's Corporation designed and maintains
the S&P 500 Index to be an accurate proxy for a diversified equity portfolio
representing a broad cross-section of the U.S. equity market. The index is based
upon the stock prices of five hundred large-capitalization companies. In 1999,
the total notional value of S&P 500 futures contracts traded was $9.7 trillion
compared to the $8.9 trillion value of stocks traded on the New York Stock
Exchange. The Nasdaq 100 Index, also known as the "technology index," is based
on the one-hundred largest non-financial stocks listed on the Nasdaq stock
market. These products give market users the ability to hedge their equity
portfolios, to gain exposure efficiently to U.S. and foreign equity markets
without the execution and capital costs of implementing their trading strategy
in the underlying cash markets, to take advantage of spread opportunities
between different sectors of the market, to enhance the return or yield on an
underlying portfolio of stocks or commodities, and to diversify a portfolio.
Market users include public and private pension funds, investment companies,
mutual funds, insurance companies and other financial services companies that
benchmark their investment performance to different segments of the equity
markets.

         As depicted in the chart below, our equity index product trading
volumes have increased substantially in the last two years. In addition, we
currently have about a 90% market share in all U.S. listed stock index futures
and options on futures. Our dominance in this market reflects the liquidity that
our members provide, as well as the fact that the S&P 500 Index is the U.S.
financial standard for benchmarking stock market returns. In addition to the
overall strength of

                                       72
<PAGE>

the U.S. equity markets, our equity index volume growth in 1998 and 1999 is
attributable to a one-half reduction in the size of our S&P 500 futures contract
in November 1997, making the contract more attractive to smaller institutions.
To benefit market users of our equity index products, we have introduced
flexible term options on our equity index futures. These options allow users to
more precisely tailor expiration dates, strike prices, the exercise style, and
various other features of our standardized options contracts, in order to meet
their needs and complement their trading strategies.

         [Graphic: Bar graph entitled "VOLUME OF EQUITY INDEX CONTRACTS TRADED
1994 - 1999" and representing the number of futures and options contracts on
various stock indices traded on the CME. Below the horizontal axis each year
measured is listed in chronological order from left to right. The vertical axis
indicates the number of contracts traded, in millions, beginning with zero and
increasing, in intervals of 10, to 50. The lower portion of each bar is darkly
shaded to the extent of the futures contracts traded and the top portion is
lightly shaded to the extent of the options contracts traded. Inset in a small
square to the right of the graph is a legend containing a lightly shaded box to
the immediate left of the word "Options" and immediately below which is a darkly
shaded box to the immediate left of the word "Futures". Futures equity index
contracts were traded at the rate of approximately 20 million in 1994, 21
million in 1995, 22 million in 1996, 25 million in 1997, 39 million in 1998 and
43 million in 1999. Options equity index contracts were traded at the rate of
approximately 5 million in 1994, 6 million in 1995, 5 million in 1996, 5 million
in 1997, 5 million in 1998 and 5 million in 1999.]

         We have had a licensing arrangement with Standard & Poor's Corporation
since 1980 that gives us the exclusive right to trade futures and options on
futures contracts on specified S&P stock indices, including the S&P 500. In
1997, we extended this arrangement until 2008, ensuring the continued success
and expansion of this market. Our Nasdaq 100 license agreement will also
continue until 2005.

         In 1997, we launched our highly successful E-Mini S&P 500 futures and
options contracts and, in 1999, we launched our E-Mini Nasdaq 100 futures
contracts. These contracts, which are traded both by electronic trading on
GLOBEX2 and open outcry pit trading, are one-fifth the size of our principal S&P
500 and Nasdaq 100 futures contracts, and are designed to appeal to our growing
retail and small institutional customer segment. The method of execution for
these E-Mini products is determined by the size of the order. Smaller orders
utilize complete electronic order entry, routing and trade matching via GLOBEX2.
Larger orders are executed by open outcry on the trading floor via our
innovative all-or-none facility. This facility allows pit transactions to be
executed in full, at the size and price specified. Since their introduction,
trading volumes in these products have grown rapidly. As the chart below
indicates, quarterly volume in our E-Mini S&P 500 futures and options contracts
recently exceeded three million contracts. The strong growth pattern is
indicative of the strength of the U.S. equity markets, as well as the increasing
prevalence of sophisticated retail customers interested in Internet access and
day trading. We expect continued growth in our existing E-Mini markets and to
develop E-Mini versions of some of our other products that will attract retail
customers and small institutions.

         [Graphic: Bar graph entitled "E-MINI S&P QUARTERLY VOLUME Q4 1997 - Q4
1999" and representing the quarterly trading volume of E-Mini S&P 500 futures
and options

                                       73
<PAGE>

contracts from the fourth quarter of 1997 through the fourth quarter of 1999.
Below the horizontal axis each quarter measured is listed in chronological order
from left to right. The vertical axis indicates the number of contracts traded,
in millions, beginning with zero and increasing, in intervals of 0.5, to 3.5. E-
Mini contracts were traded at the rate of approximately 0.6 million in the
fourth quarter of 1997, 0.7 million in the first quarter of 1998, 0.8 million in
the second quarter of 1998, 1.3 million in the third quarter of 1998, 1.4
million in the fourth quarter of 1998, 2.0 million in the first quarter of 1999,
2.5 million in the second quarter of 1999, 3.0 million in the third quarter of
1999 and 3.2 million in the fourth quarter of 1999.]

         Currency Products. Since developing financial futures for currencies in
1972, we have built a strong presence in foreign currency trading, providing
traders, investors and risk managers with tools to hedge their risk from foreign
exchange market movements. Average daily turnover in the interbank foreign
exchange market exceeds $1 trillion, making this market the world's largest. The
interbank foreign currency market is dominated by large banks and multinational
corporations. The Exchange provides an attractive alternative to this market by
offering foreign currency futures and futures options contracts so that large
and small investors alike can have equal access to the world of foreign
exchange. We offer futures and options on futures contracts on the world's major
currencies, including, among others, the Euro, Deutsche mark, Japanese yen,
British pound, Canadian dollar, French franc, Swiss franc, Mexican peso, and
Australian dollar. Users of these markets are institutions such as banks, hedge
funds, commodity trading advisors and corporations with foreign currency
exposures, and retail customers who speculate for profit on foreign currency
price movements. To benefit market users and compete effectively with the
interbank foreign currency market, we have introduced all-or-none trading
whereby larger currency futures orders are filled in their entirety at a single
price, without the possibility of partial fills. Additionally, foreign currency
all-or-none transactions can occur outside the bid/ask or daily high/low for
regular futures contracts, and market participants can receive competitive
quotes from multiple market makers.

         As indicated in the charts below, our foreign currency futures and
options product trading volumes have declined significantly in the last five
years, while our foreign currency EFP transaction volumes have increased. The
decline in our futures and options trading volumes reflect several different
trends: bank consolidations and increased use of internal netting mechanisms by
our bank customers, reduced volatility in cash foreign currency markets, and the
introduction of the Euro and subsequent phasing out of major European
currencies. We also face significant competition in this product sector from the
interbank foreign currency market, which offers comparable and highly liquid
cash and forward rate agreement trading facilities in these foreign currencies.
Despite declines in our foreign currency futures and options trading volumes,
however, the growth in foreign currency EFP transactions and EFP fees have
stabilized revenues from our currency products.

         [Graphic: Bar graph entitled "VOLUME OF CURRENCY CONTRACTS TRADED 1994
- - 1999" and representing the trading volume of foreign currency options and
futures contracts. Below the horizontal axis each year measured is listed in
chronological order from left to right. The vertical axis indicates the number
of contracts traded, in millions, beginning with zero and increasing, in
intervals of 10, to 50. The lower portion of each bar is darkly shaded to the
extent of the futures contracts traded and the top portion is lightly shaded to
the extent of the options contracts traded. Inset in a small square to the right
of the graph is a legend containing a lightly shaded box to the immediate left
of the word "Options" and immediately below which is

                                       74
<PAGE>

a darkly shaded box to the immediate left of the word "Futures". Futures
contracts were traded at the rate of approximately 30 million in 1994, 23
million in 1995, 21 million in 1996, 25 million in 1997, 25 million in 1998 and
22 million in 1999. Options contracts were traded at the rate of approximately
12 million in 1994, 10 million in 1995, 7 million in 1996, 5 million in 1997, 4
million in 1998 and 2 million in 1999.]

         [Graphic: Bar graph entitled "CURRENCY EFP AND FUTURES/OPTIONS PIT
TRADING VOLUME 1994 - 1999" and representing trading volume in foreign currency
transactions via pit trading and over the Exchange-for-Physicals (EFP) market.
Below the horizontal axis each year measured is listed in chronological order
from left to right. The vertical axis indicates the number of contracts traded,
in millions, beginning with zero and increasing, in intervals of 10, to 50. The
lower portion of each bar is darkly shaded to the extent of the pit trading
volume and the top portion is lightly shaded to the extent of the EFP trading
volume. Inset in a small square to the right of the graph is a legend containing
a lightly shaded box to the immediate left of the initials "EFP" and immediately
below which is a small darkly shaded box to the immediate left of the word
"Pit". Pit trading volume was approximately 37 million in 1994, 29 million in
1995, 25 million in 1996, 24 million in 1997, 27 million in 1998 and 23 million
in 1999. EFP trading volume was approximately 4 million in 1994, 3 million in
1995, 4 million in 1996, 6 million in 1997, 7 million in 1998 and 7 million in
1999.]

         Additionally, we have launched new E-Mini currency products based on
the Euro and the Japanese Yen that we are targeting toward the developing
electronic retail customer base opened up by the prevalence of on-line Internet
trading of equities, and by our developing franchise in E-Mini equity products.

         Agricultural Products. Agricultural products were the core from which
we started at the turn of the last century. The Exchange has maintained a strong
franchise in our agricultural products, including contracts based on cattle,
hogs, pork bellies, dairy products, and other agricultural commodities. Our
market users include agricultural producers of commodities, food processors, and
retail customers. Extensive revisions to existing contracts and the development
of new products have led to stable volume and modest growth in this product
sector in recent years. Our agricultural product trading volumes are depicted in
the chart below. We believe that continuing consolidation and restructuring in
the agricultural sector, and the reduction or elimination of government
subsidies, could provide growth in our agricultural markets as large producers
and processors adopt formal hedging and risk management programs.

         [Graphic: Bar graph representing and entitled "VOLUME OF AGRICULTURAL
CONTRACTS TRADED 1994 - 1999". Below the horizontal axis each year measured is
listed in chronological order from left to right. The vertical axis indicates
the number of contracts traded, in millions, beginning with zero and increasing,
in intervals of 2, to 10. The lower portion of each bar is darkly shaded to the
extent of the futures contracts traded and the top portion is lightly shaded to
the extent of the options contracts traded. Inset in a small square to the right
of the graph is a legend containing a lightly shaded box to the immediate left
of the word "Options" and immediately below which is a darkly shaded box to the
immediate left of the word "Futures". Futures contracts were traded at the rate
of approximately 6.4 million in 1994, 6.3 million in 1995, 7.7 million in 1996,
7.7 million in 1997, 7.9 million in 1998 and 7.5 million in 1999. Options
contracts were traded at the rate of approximately 1.0 million in 1994, 0.9
million in 1995, 1.0 million in 1996, 1.0 million in 1997, 1.1 million in 1998
and 1.0 million in

                                       75
<PAGE>

1999.]

         Other Products. We offer several interest rate, currency and index
contracts based upon the emerging markets of the world, providing tools for
managing the risk associated with emerging market financial flows, investments
and foreign exchange transactions. We also developed the first exchange-traded
credit and temperature-related weather derivatives contracts. We believe these
contracts will create new risk management opportunities for credit institutions
and insurance companies that face risks in their lending and insurance
activities. The CME Quarterly Bankruptcy Index, the world's first
exchange-listed consumer credit derivatives contract, is designed to allow
credit card companies and other lenders in the $1.4 trillion consumer credit
market to hedge risk associated with the escalating number of U.S. bankruptcy
filings in recent years. Our Heating Degree Day and Cooling Degree Day futures
and options on futures are designed to help businesses protect their revenues
during times of depressed demand or excessive costs because of unexpected or
unfavorable weather conditions. Weather affects an estimated 20 percent of the
$9 trillion U.S. economy, and the over-the-counter market in managing
weather-related risk has grown significantly over the past few years.

Execution Facilities

         We operate two trade execution facilities--open outcry trading pits and
GLOBEX2. Both offer our users secure and reliable facilities, immediacy of trade
execution, anonymity, and price transparency. Both the trading pits and GLOBEX2
are state-of-the-art trading environments supported by substantial
infrastructure and technology for order routing, trade reporting, market data
dissemination, and market surveillance and regulation.

         Open Outcry Trading. Open outcry trading occurs in individual pits on
our two trading floors and represent ninety-two percent of our total volume in
1999. The pits are the centralized meeting place for floor brokers and
independent traders to trade contracts. Orders for market participants not on
the floor are relayed to brokers for execution in the pits. The trading floors,
covering 70,000 square feet, have tiered booths surrounding the pits from which
clearing member firm personnel can communicate with customers regarding current
market activity and prices and receive orders either electronically or by
telephone. In addition, our trading floors display current market information
and news on wallboards hung above the pits.

         GLOBEX2 Electronic Trading. Our original GLOBEX System, which we
jointly developed in partnership with Reuters, was introduced in 1992. GLOBEX2,
the second generation system we introduced in 1998, is based on the Nouveau
Systeme de Cotation developed and licensed to us by our GLOBEX2 partner,
ParisBourse. GLOBEX2 maintains an electronic, centralized order book and trade
execution algorithm for futures and futures options contracts and allows users
to directly enter orders into the order book. Initially, these systems were used
to offer our products to market users after the close of our regular daytime
trading sessions. Today, however, we trade some of our most successful products
virtually around the clock on our GLOBEX2 system, including our E-Mini S&P 500
futures and options contracts, E-Mini Nasdaq 100 futures, E-Mini Euro FX futures
and E-Mini Japanese Yen futures. In 1999, in response to customer interest, we
initiated simultaneous "side-by-side" electronic and open outcry trading in our
most successful contracts--Eurodollar futures and options--expanding market
users' alternatives for trade execution facilities. Most recently, we have
initiated trading exclusively on our GLOBEX2 system, in some foreign currency
cross-rate contracts, and in

                                       76
<PAGE>

innovative new credit and weather derivatives products. Eight percent of our
1999 volume was traded on GLOBEX2 and, as indicated in the table below, our
yearly GLOBEX2 volume has grown rapidly. GLOBEX2 trading volume has increased
from 210,000 contracts in 1992, when the original system was launched, to more
than sixteen million contracts in 1999. Through 1998, GLOBEX2 volume doubled
every year since 1996.

         [Graphic: Bar graph entitled "GLOBEX VOLUME 1992 - 1999" and
representing the number of contracts traded over the GLOBEX System and its 1998
replacement the GLOBEX2 System. Below the horizontal axis each year measured is
listed in chronological order from left to right. The vertical axis indicates
the number of contracts traded over these Systems, in millions, beginning with 0
and increasing, in intervals of 5, to 20. System volume was approximately 0.2
million in 1992, 1.0 million in 1993, 1.0 million in 1994, 1.3 million in 1995,
2.0 million in 1996, 4.4 million in 1997, 9.7 million in 1998 and 16.1 million
in 1999.]

         GLOBEX2 users include clearing member firms, locals, market makers,
commodity trading advisors and individuals that have been issued electronic
trading hours permits. In response to the rapid growth in electronic trading of
financial instruments, we are significantly expanding the functionality,
capacity and distribution of GLOBEX2. The flexibility of the open architecture
design of GLOBEX2 allows us to add new products to the system and to easily and
quickly increase processing throughput.

         Technology Supporting our Execution Facilities. We have enhanced our
open outcry and electronic markets with automation and cost efficiencies that
will help us to retain our competitive advantage of instant liquidity for market
users. In order to streamline the trading operations of our members and link our
existing order routing technology, we have developed an application programming
interface, CME FIX API(TM), designed to route orders efficiently from
independent software vendors' and clearing member firms' order management
systems to our trading floors and to GLOBEX2.

         As indicated in the diagram below, orders are sent from the end user or
member's trading application, through our secure network, and then delivered to
CUBS(TM), TOPS Route(TM) or GLOBEX2. These systems then execute in the case of
GLOBEX2 or, in the case of CUBS and TOPS Route, route the order to the trading
floor for execution and return the fill information back to the member or end
user. CUBS enables our floor brokers standing in the pits to electronically
receive orders and report fills to the order originator by providing an
electronic direct link between a clearing member firm's order desk and a filling
broker. TOPS Route, our electronic order entry, routing, and fill reporting
system, expedites the flow of orders permitting clearing member firms and their
customers to electronically route orders directly to our trading floors. TOPS
Route also generates fill reports and transmits trade records to member firms'
back office systems. TOPS Route can be accessed from a dedicated TOPS Route
terminal or through a firm's proprietary system connected via the CME FIX API.
GalaxC(TM), introduced in 1999, is our proprietary wireless handheld unit that
offers our local floor traders the ability to enter limit orders and execute
against orders resting on GLOBEX2, and to execute trades in the cash foreign
currency markets. Our development of links between open outcry, electronic
trading and electronic order routing will provide market users with greater
access to the liquidity and execution facilities we provide.

                                       77
<PAGE>

         [Graphic: Flow-chart representing and entitled "CME's Trading and Order
Routing Systems". Each symbol in the chart is shaded and a symbol's label is
inscribed in that symbol. Atop the chart, a two-headed arrow runs between a
rectangle labeled "Internet Access" and a rectangle below it labeled
"Retail-Ordering Clearing Firms". From the bottom left of the latter rectangle,
a two-headed arrow runs to the top left of an oval labeled "FIX API Access".
From the top right of that oval a two-headed arrow in the shape of two stair
steps leads to a rectangle labeled "Clearing Firm". From the top of that
rectangle, a two-headed arrow connects it to a rectangle labeled "Public
Customer" and from its right face a two-headed arrow connects it to a rectangle
labeled "Proprietary Trading Desk". From the bottom right of the "FIX API
Access" oval, a two-headed arrow in the shape of a backward "L" leads to the
right face of a square labeled "GLOBEX2". A two-headed arrow connects the top
center of the "GLOBEX2" square to the bottom center of a rectangle labeled
"GLOBEX Terminal". From the upper right face of the "GLOBEX2" square, a
two-headed arrow runs diagonally upward to a rectangle labeled "TOPS ROUTE Order
Routing System". An arrow runs from the right face of that rectangle to the
words "Other Exchanges", a two-headed arrow runs from its top face to a
rectangle labeled "TOPS Terminal" and a two-headed arrow runs from its left face
to the "FIX API Access" oval. From the bottom of the "FIX API Access" oval a
two-headed arrow in the shape of an "L" runs to the left angle point of a
hexagon labeled "CUBS II Amker Station". This hexagon is connected by two
chevrons, pointing left and running from its bottom face, to the top face of a
hexagon labeled "GalaxC Wireless Handheld". A two-headed arrow in the shape of
an "L" runs from the bottom face of the "GLOBEX2" square to left angle point of
the "GalaxC" hexagon. That hexagon is connected by two parallel lines running
from its right angle point and lower right face to a hexagon labeled "Telephone
Lines". Two chevrons, pointing to the right run from the latter hexagon's top
face to the bottom face of a fourth hexagon labeled "Ticket Printing & Trade".
Two parallel lines connect this fourth hexagon at its left angle point and lower
left face to the "CUBS II" hexagon. Each hexagon is the same size. Written
beneath the bottom two hexagons is "Open Outcry Trading". A two-headed arrow in
the shape of a single stair step runs upward and to the right from the top of
the "Ticket Printing & Trade" hexagon to the "TOPS ROUTE" rectangle.]

         We are also expanding global access, virtually twenty-four hours a day,
to our trading, clearing and risk management facilities. Recognizing the growth
in electronic trading and our ability to expand our product reach around the
globe, we have nearly doubled the number of dedicated GLOBEX2 terminals in use.
In addition to the thousands of order routing terminals that interface with our
GLOBEX2 trading environment, we have over 1,200 GLOBEX2 execution terminals in
the United States and throughout the world: 855 in the U.S. (not including over
300 on our two trading floors) and 54 terminals internationally (Europe, Asia,
Bermuda). In addition, many firms and customers route orders to GLOBEX2 via the
Internet, further extending electronic access to our markets. Our ten largest
retail-oriented clearing members have full Internet order routing capabilities,
including the ability to execute trades, check account balances, and gain
on-line access to quotes and charts.

         In addition to technology, we offer market users other trade execution
efficiencies. For example, in 1992, we introduced the Average Price System(TM)
(APS), which enables clearing member firms to compute and confirm average prices
when multiple prices are received on the execution of an order or series of
orders during a single trading day. APS was developed to address the difficulty
account managers have when an order representing multiple accounts is

                                       78
<PAGE>

executed at different prices. These account managers sometimes prefer to use
alternative dealer markets where a single price execution is available--although
sometimes at less favorable prices. APS provides our market users with the
operational flexibility they need, while also providing the transparent,
competitive and efficient pricing that we provide in our markets.

Clearing

     The CME Clearing House clears, settles, nets and guarantees performance of
all matched transactions in our contracts. Unlike most other exchanges, the
Exchange owns and operates the Clearing House, enabling the Exchange to achieve
the closest possible coordination between its clearing functions and its other
main business areas of risk management, new product initiatives, customer
service and competitive issues. At each settlement cycle, the Clearing House
"marks-to-market" all open positions by calling for payments from clearing
members whose positions have lost value, and by paying clearing members whose
positions have gained value. The Clearing House marks all open positions to
market at least twice a day - more often if market volatility warrants. The
diagram below illustrates the daily mark-to-market and settlement activities of
Clearing House.

     [Graphic: Flow-chart titled and representing "CME Clearing House
Activities". Each symbol in the chart is shaded and a symbol's label is
inscribed in that symbol. Atop the chart, two octagons are aligned horizontally,
with a horizontal arrow pointing from the right face of the octagon labeled
"LONG POSITION" to the left face of the octagon labeled "SHORT POSITION". A
single arrow points from the bottom face of each octagon to one of two ovals,
each oval being aligned horizontally and centered beneath each octagon. Each
oval is labeled "CLEARING FIRM MEMBER". An arrow bent as if signifying the time
five o'clock, points from the bottom right portion of the left oval to the top
of a large circle labeled "CLEARING HOUSE Match Trade Guarantee Trade Collect
margins and settlement variations". Inserted into the vertical portion of the
arrow line is an unshaded circle containing the number "2". Immediately above
the arrowhead and sloping downward to the right is written "TRADE DATA". Halfway
embedded in the top center of the large circle is a much smaller unshaded circle
containing the number "3". A two-headed arrow bent as if signifying the time
five o'clock, leads from the bottom center of the left oval to the top of the
large circle. Inserted after the bend into the arrow line and just above the
arrowhead is an unshaded circle containing the number "4". An arrow leads from
the lower left face of the left oval and turns vertically downward to abut the
top of a rectangle labeled "SETTLEMENT BANK Makes payment from clearing firm to
clearing house and safekeeps margin assets". An arrow leads upward from the top
left of the rectangle and turning horizontally to the right where its arrowhead
abuts the upper left face of the left oval. An arrow in the shape of an "L"
leads from the left face of the large circle to the rectangle. An unshaded
circle containing the number "4" is inserted into the horizontal segment of the
arrow line. An arrow in the shape of an "L" runs from the bottom of the
rectangle to the large circle. An unshaded circle containing the number "5" is
inserted into the perpendicular portion of the arrow line. Written below the
horizontal portion of the arrow line is "CONFIRMS PAYMENT". An arrow bent as if
signifying the time seven o'clock, points from the bottom left face of the right
oval to the top of the large circle. Inserted into the vertical segment of the
arrow line is an unshaded circle containing the number "2". Above the arrowhead
and sloping downward and to the left is written "TRADE DATA". A two-headed arrow
bent as if signifying the time seven o'clock, leads from the bottom center of
the left oval to the top of the large circle. Inserted after the bend in the
arrow line and just above the arrowhead is an unshaded circle

                                       79
<PAGE>


containing the number "4". A horizontal line leaves from the lower right face of
the right oval, turns vertically downward where its arrowhead touches the top of
a second rectangle labeled "SETTLEMENT BANK Makes payment from clearing firm to
clearing house and safekeeps margin assets". An arrow in the shape of a backward
"L" leads from the right face of the large circle to the rectangle. An unshaded
circle containing the number "4" is inserted into the horizontal segment of the
arrow line. An arrow in the shape of a backward "L" runs from the bottom of the
box to the large circle. An unshaded circle containing the number "5" is
inserted into the vertical segment of the arrowline. Written below the
horizontal segment of the arrow line is "CONFIRMS PAYMENT". An arrow leads
upward from the top right face of the box, turns horizontally to the left and
abuts the upper right face of the right oval. An arrow leads from the lower
right face of the oval, turns vertically downward and abuts the rectangle.]

     Our ability to conduct a minimum of two daily settlement cycles helps to
protect the financial integrity of the Clearing House, our clearing member
firms, and market participants. This ability enables the Clearing House to
identify more quickly any clearing firms that may not be able to satisfy the
financial obligations resulting from changes in the prices of their open
contracts before those financial obligations become exceptionally large and
jeopardize the ability of the Clearing House to insure performance on their open
positions. The CME Clearing House has a perfect record for performance on its
obligations, and no clearing member firm has ever failed to perform on its
obligations to the CME Clearing House. On an average day, we act as custodian
for approximately $20 billion in performance bond assets, and we move an average
of $990 million of settlement variation funds through our clearing system. As
indicated below, our Clearing House guarantees the performance of our contracts
with approximately $64 billion in available assets.

                                       80
<PAGE>


          CME Clearing House Available Assets as of December 31, 1999
                                 (in millions)

<TABLE>
   <S>                                                                    <C>
   Aggregate Performance Bond Deposits by Clearing Member Firms           $17,686
   Market Value of Pledged Memberships                                        137
   CME Surplus Funds                                                           36
   Security Deposits of Clearing Members                                      308
   Common Bond of Clearing Members                                         46,353
                                                                          -------
                                         Total                            $64,520
</TABLE>

     The CME Clearing House guarantee of performance is a significant
attraction of our markets: our market users do not need to evaluate the credit
of each potential counterparty or limit themselves only to a selected set of
counterparties. This increases the potential liquidity available for each trade
and reduces the costs of using our markets. Additionally, the substitution of
the CME Clearing House as the counterparty to every transaction allows our
market users to establish a position with one party, and then to offset the
position with another party. This contract netting process provides our market
users with significant flexibility in establishing and adjusting positions.

     In order to ensure performance, we establish and monitor financial
requirements for our clearing members and set minimum performance bond levels
for our traded products. The CME Clearing House holds performance bond
collateral to cover the largest reasonable losses between marks-to-market. It
typically seeks to cover at least ninety-five percent of all daily price changes
in each product. The Clearing House uses its proprietary SPAN(R) system, which
targets performance bonds to risks, to simulate the gains and losses of complex
portfolios. We utilize risk management and financial surveillance programs.
These programs are designed to prevent the accumulation of losses, ensure the
availability of sufficient resources to cover future obligations, promptly
detect financial and operational weaknesses, and allow swift and appropriate
action to be taken to rectify any financial problems.

     In the unlikely event of a clearing member payment default, we would
apply the following assets of the clearing member to cover the member's payment
obligation:

     .   security deposit,
     .   performance bonds, and
     .   any other available assets, which could include proceeds from the sale
         of any memberships owned by or assigned to the clearing member.

If the payment default remains unsatisfied, then the following assets would be
applied to address the deficit:

     .   surplus funds of the Exchange
     .   security deposits of other clearing members, and
     .   funds collected through the assessment of a common bond against all
         other clearing member firms.

                                       81
<PAGE>

The Exchange also maintains an unsecured, confirmed $350 million line of credit
agreement with a consortium of banks in order to ensure adequate liquidity to
deal with a clearing member payment default. This line of credit may also be
utilized if there is a temporary problem with the domestic payments system that
would delay payments of settlement variation between the Clearing House and
clearing members.

     The Clearing House also manages final settlement on all CME contracts,
including cash settlement, physical delivery of selected commodities, and option
exercise and assignment. Although more than ninety-five percent of all futures
contracts are liquidated before the expiration of a contract, the remainder must
be delivered according to detailed specifications. The Clearing House acts as
the delivery agent for all contracts. This ensures that timely delivery of the
exact quality and quantity specified in a contract is made by the seller, and
that full and timely payment is made by the buyer.

     Our objective is to offer the highest possible risk management services
and financial safeguards to our clearing member firms while providing maximum
capital efficiencies to users of our markets. In 1999, we enhanced our financial
safeguards by increasing our security deposit pool from $125 million to $305
million. We also introduced net margining in proprietary accounts, thereby
reducing capital costs for our clearing member firms by an estimated $900
million a day. We implemented risk-based capital requirements to match more
closely the capital requirements of our clearing member firms to the actual
risks borne by those firms.

     In order to achieve further capital efficiencies for our clearing member
firms, we have also established our Interest Earning Facility(TM), two money
market funds managed by a third party investment manager, to allow clearing
member firms to enhance the yields that they receive on their performance bond
collateral deposits with the Clearing House. We currently have approximately $1
billion in balances in these funds, which are benchmarked against the ninety-day
U.S. Treasury Bill average yield. Because initial and maintenance performance
bonds, as well as profits in some of our contracts, are denominated in various
foreign currencies, the Clearing House offers the Moneychanger(TM) Service to
its clearing member firms. This service provides traders with access to
overnight funds in various foreign currencies at competitive bid/ask spreads
free of charge for the transfer of funds to satisfy the terms of a futures
contract.

     To support our objective to provide firms with high quality clearing
services, we have developed in conjunction with the New York Mercantile Exchange
a state-of-the-art clearing system, Clearing 21(R), which processes reported
trades and positions on a real-time basis, providing users with instantaneous
information on trades, positions, money and risk exposure. Clearing 21 supports
futures and options products, securities, and cash instruments, as well as
complex new product types including combinations, options on combinations,
options on options, swaps, repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements, and
other instruments. Through Clearing 21 workstations, our clearing member firms
can electronically manage their positions, exercise options, enter transactions
related to foreign currency deliveries, manage collateral posted to meet
performance bond requirements, and access all of our other on-line applications.
Together with the GLOBEX2, we offer straight through electronic processing of
transactions in which an order is electronically routed, matched, cleared, and
made available to the clearing firm's back office systems for further
processing.

                                       82
<PAGE>

     The Clearing House's highly sophisticated SPAN system has now been adopted
by over thirty other exchanges and clearing organizations worldwide. SPAN
simulates the effects of changing market conditions on a complex portfolio and
uses standard options pricing models to determine a portfolio's overall risk.
SPAN then generates a performance bond requirement that covers the largest
reasonable overnight loss.

     We have led the derivatives industry in establishing cross-margining
agreements with other leading clearing houses that reduce capital costs for
clearing member firms and users of our markets. The cross-margining agreements
permits an individual clearing house to recognize a clearing firm's open
positions at other clearing houses that produce risk offsets and to lower
capital requirements.. We have implemented, or are in the process of
implementing, cross-margining arrangements with The Options Clearing
Corporation, Commodity Clearing Corporation, the Board of Trade Clearing
Corporation, the London Clearing House, the Singapore Exchange Derivatives
Clearing and Clearnet.

     The CME Clearing House has the operational capacity and organizational
expertise to extend its services flexibly and efficiently to a range of
potential new products and also to other exchanges and trading platforms.

Market Data

     Our markets generate valuable information regarding prices and trading
activity in our products. We sell our "market data," which includes bids,
offers, trades, and trade size to banks, broker-dealers, public and private
pension funds, investment companies, mutual funds, insurance companies,
individual investors, and other financial services companies or organizations
that use our markets or monitor general economic conditions. Revenue from market
data represented approximately 21% of our revenue during 1999, and has grown at
an annual rate of 5.6% over the last five years. In general, the price
information is sent via dedicated networks to 115 worldwide quote vendors who
consolidate our market data and information with that from other exchanges and
third party data and news services and resell the consolidated data and
information to their subscribers. These quote vendors distribute our market data
through dedicated networks, the Internet, and wireless handheld devices. We
currently have over 36,000 subscribers of our real time market data who display
the data on over 175,000 screens. The market data supplied by the Exchange is
central to trading activity in our products and to trading activity in related
cash and derivatives markets. The dissemination of real time data generates
revenue and supports our customer bases with timely market information.

     We believe that the evolution of technology and the financial services
industry will change the existing distribution channels, sales methods and
pricing structure for market data. These changes might adversely impact our sale
of market data. Increases in the volume of electronic trading, the use of the
Internet as a distribution mechanism, and increases in the use of our products
by individual retail investors will all impact the sale of our market data. We
have created marketing programs to stimulate usage of our market data, and we
have begun to enter into new business relationships with companies that develop
value-added computer-based applications that use our market data to provide
specific insights into the dynamics of trading activity in our listed contracts.

                                       83
<PAGE>

International Alliances

     We are expanding our network of international alliances and partnerships
with other exchanges in order to offer our products to customers on a global
basis and to access the existing distribution capabilities of some of our
partners' electronic trading systems. We have established the GLOBEX Alliance
with the derivatives markets operated by ParisBourse in France, The Singapore
Exchange Derivatives Trading Limited, the Bolsa de Mercadorias y Futuros in
Brazil, and the Montreal Exchange. We have also entered into a partnership with
the London International Financial Futures & Options Exchange and its clearing
partner, the London Clearing House. Through these alliances, partnerships and
relationships, we intend to offer our customers capital efficiencies by cross-
margining mutually agreed upon highly correlated products and trading
efficiencies by interconnecting our trading platforms and networks of each
exchange and by harmonizing trading rules and interfaces. Additionally, when
mutually beneficial, we will share in the cost of developing technology. We seek
to expand these alliances to include other foreign and domestic markets.

Marketing Programs and Advertising

     Our marketing programs target both institutional and retail customers. Our
marketing programs for institutional customers aim to inform highly
sophisticated traders, portfolio managers, corporate treasurers and other market
professionals about novel uses of our products, such as new hedging and risk
management strategies. We also strive to educate these users about changes in
product design, margin requirements and new clearing services. Our marketing
typically involves the development of personal relationships with professional
traders who actively use our markets. We participate in all major domestic and
international trade shows and seminars regarding futures and options and other
derivatives products. In addition, we sponsor educational workshops and
marketing events designed to educate market users about our new products.
Through these relationships and programs, we ascertain the needs of our customer
base and we use information from them to drive our product development and
product maintenance efforts.

     We advertise our products and our brand name to increase our trading
volumes. Our advertising strategy is twofold: to maintain awareness and
familiarity among our institutional target customers and to generate awareness
among our growing retail audience. Our primary method of communication is with
print media, using both monthly trade magazines and daily business publications.
We are also committing media dollars to Internet advertising given the growth of
the medium and the synergies with our electronically traded products.

Competition

     We face a variety of competitors and competing marketplaces and products.
We compete by offering market participants efficient, cost-effective and liquid
marketplaces for trade execution through both open outcry and electronic trading
platforms, broadly disseminated and transparent market and quotation data, a
financially secure clearing system, access to market making, superior product
design, and state-of-the-art technology. Additionally, we are continually
enhancing our products and providing additional efficiencies to our customers.
For example, to address competitive threats to our Eurodollar market, we have
implemented trading in half-tick and quarter-tick increments; we have introduced
mid-curve options and Eurodollar

                                       84
<PAGE>

packs and bundles, and we have changed the final settlement procedures for these
contracts to meet the needs of our customers. Additionally, we offer Eurodollar
participants both open outcry and electronic trading platforms to choose from
for trade execution. We believe we are well prepared to meet potential
competition, and we are committed to maintaining the technology, services,
market integrity and liquidity that make us an industry leader.

     Over-the-counter markets for interest rate and currency swaps, for cash
currencies, and for other bilaterally negotiated derivative products compete
with our products. However many of the participants in the over-the-counter
markets use our products to hedge the risk they acquire in the over-the-counter
markets. These over-the-counter markets depend heavily upon bilateral credit
support; therefore, they tend to be dominated by large financial institutions
with very high credit ratings. As a result, participation in these markets by
some market participants and financial institutions with lesser credit ratings
is sometimes limited or more expensive. The mutualization of risk offered by our
Clearing House guarantee, and the mitigation of counterparty credit risk, allows
us to service a broader segment of customers in these financial markets.

     In addition to competition from other exchanges that offer comparable
derivative products, we also face competition from other financial exchanges,
from electronic trading systems, from consortia of end users and futures
commission merchants, and from technology firms. Other financial exchanges have
trading platforms and financial market expertise that may lead them to consider
listing copies of our non-equity products. These potential competitors would
still need to obtain the regulatory approval, establish market liquidity, and
develop derivative product clearing services.

     Electronic trading firms that currently specialize in the trading of equity
securities have electronic trade execution and routing systems that can be used
to trade products that compete with our products. Typically, while these firms
have advanced electronic and Internet technology, significant capitalization,
and competitive pricing, they lack the overall market liquidity, distribution,
neutrality and market integrity offered by our electronic and open outcry
trading platforms. They also lack the financial security and guarantees offered
by our Clearing House. In many cases these electronic trading systems do not
have the regulatory systems and approvals to trade products that compete
directly with ours.

     Consortia owned by member firms and large market participants also may
become our competitors, particularly with respect to our Eurodollar futures and
options contracts. For instance, BrokerTec Global LLC, a proposed electronic
inter-dealer fixed income broker, has announced its intention to develop or
acquire a facility for electronic trading of U.S Treasury securities, Euro-
denominated sovereign debt and other fixed income securities and futures related
products. All of the members of BrokerTec Global LLC are either clearing member
firms of the Exchange or affiliates of our clearing member firms, and are
significant participants in the Eurodollar market. Similarly, Electronic
Brokerage System, a partnership of major market-making banks, has an electronic
trading system for currencies and short-term forward rate agreements that are
very similar to our Eurodollar futures contract.

     Technology companies, market data and information vendors, and front end
software vendors also represent potential competitors because, as purveyors of
market data, these firms typically have substantial distribution. As technology
firms, they also have access to trading

                                       85
<PAGE>

engines that can be connected to their data and information networks.
Additionally, technology and software firms that develop trading systems,
hardware and networks but who are otherwise outside of the financial services
industry may be attracted to enter our markets.

Our Members

     We are presently owned by our members who have purchased seats on the
Exchange. Members and individuals who have leased seats from members can execute
trades for their own accounts or for the accounts of customers of clearing
member firms. The trades of members and lessees of memberships for their own
accounts qualify for lower fees in recognition of the market liquidity that
their trading activity provides. Members and lessees also benefit from market
information advantages that may accrue from their proximity to trading activity
on the trading floors and from access to the GLOBEX2 order book. Memberships are
purchased from existing members at prevailing market prices. There are four
types of memberships: CME, IMM, IOM and GEM, each with different trading
privileges and voting rights. All membership applicants are subjected to a
thorough review process and must be approved.

     Members can buy or sell memberships through mechanisms maintained by the
Exchange.

                      High/Low Sale Prices of Memberships
                                (in thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                             GEM
                           CME                   IMM                  IOM                  GEM             Fraction
                  -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Year       Qtr.     High        Low       High        Low       High        Low      High       Low     High      Low
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>        <C>      <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>       <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>
1998       1        $480.0     $459.0     $400.0     $390.0     $275.0     $255.0    $45.0    $38.0    $4.3     $3.5
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
           2         410.0      390.0      335.0      210.0      245.0      135.0     30.0     21.5     3.6      1.5
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
           3         333.0      251.0      242.5      180.0      151.0      110.0     28.0     15.0     2.3      1.5
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
           4         325.0      276.5      208.0      181.5      140.0      115.0     18.0     15.0     2.0      1.5
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1999       1         340.0      310.0      275.0      217.5      205.0      127.0     18.0     18.0     1.9      1.6
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
           2         345.0      320.0      250.0      222.0      190.0      173.0     18.5     15.0     1.9      1.6
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
           3         480.0      345.0      330.0      240.0      225.0      191.0     16.0     12.5     1.7      1.4
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
           4         550.0      450.0      400.0      320.0      248.0      220.0     22.0     17.0     2.7      1.6
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>
     Source:  Exchange records.

     Individual Members

     Our Membership Committee reviews applicants and conducts proceedings to
determine whether candidates meet our membership criteria. Additionally,
registration or a temporary license to act as either a floor broker or a floor
trader must be granted by the National Futures Association before an individual
can begin trading on the Exchange's trading floors. All members must be
guaranteed or qualified to trade by a clearing member before they may personally
execute a transaction on the Exchange. With respect to GLOBEX2, qualified
members may obtain a terminal to trade for their own accounts and participate in
the P-M-T Limited Partnership, the owner of the GLOBEX2 system, as Class A
Limited Partners.

     CME Division. The Chicago Mercantile Exchange division membership entitles
the holder to execute trades in all futures and options contracts listed on the
Exchange. There are

                                       86
<PAGE>

625 CME division memberships.

     IMM Division. The International Monetary Market ("IMM") division membership
entitles the holder to execute trades in all currency and interest rate futures
and options contracts, as well as the contracts assigned to the IOM and GEM
divisions (defined below). There are 813 IMM division memberships.

     IOM Division.  Membership in the Index and Option Market ("IOM") division
entitles the holder to execute trades in all stock index futures contracts,
random length lumber futures contracts, all options contracts, and all contracts
assigned to the GEM division. There are 1,287 IOM division memberships.

     GEM Division.  The Growth and Emerging Markets ("GEM") division membership
entitles holders to execute trades in all growth and emerging market currency,
stock index and interest rate products that are assigned to that division by the
board. When the GEM division was created in 1995, each member of the Exchange's
other three divisions received a fractional GEM membership, and 50 memberships
were sold to eligible third parties. GEM fractions may be sold and combined to
create, together with the 50 full memberships that were sold to third parties, a
total of 467 full memberships.

     Clearing Members

     An Exchange clearing member firm must satisfy our legal and financial
requirements, as well as the requirements imposed by the CFTC. Nearly all of our
clearing members are registered futures commission merchants. Clearing
membership entitles the firm to execute orders on the Exchange and to clear
resulting positions through the Exchange Clearing House. We have seventy
clearing members.

     The right to be a clearing member in New CME will require an ownership
interest equivalent to current requirements. Exchange rules require that each
Exchange clearing member must own or have assigned to it at least two CME
memberships, at least two IMM memberships and at least two IOM memberships.
Additionally, due to a rule change that occurred in May 1987, a clearing member
which was an IMM Class A clearing member on or prior to May 6, 1987, was allowed
to own or have assigned to it at least one CME membership, three IMM
memberships, and two IOM memberships. Twenty-two clearing firms were
grandfathered under this rule, which was amended so that clearing members would
no longer be divided into two different classes. The goal of the change was to
consolidate clearing members into one group for uniformity and simplicity.
Finally, after November 3, 2000, each clearing member must have at least one GEM
membership assigned to it. The rules also require that at least one CME, one
IMM, one IOM and one GEM membership assigned to the clearing member must be
owned by the clearing member or an officer, principal or partner with an
acceptable proprietary interest.

     Upon completion of the demutualization transaction, each clearing member
will be required to satisfy the above-described criteria by owning Class A
shares and Class B shares in an amount reflecting the total shares allocated to
the clearing member in respect to the memberships held by it for purposes of
meeting those requirements. New CME management may choose to alter these
ownership interest requirements.

                                       87
<PAGE>

Other Business Relationships And Subsidiaries

     P-M-T Limited Partnership. P-M-T Limited Partnership is an Illinois limited
partnership and a partially-owned subsidiary of the Exchange. It was formed in
1988 to initiate the development of the GLOBEX system. P-M-T owns all rights to
electronic trading of the Exchange's products. It has entered into contractual
arrangements with the Exchange for the provision of services in connection with
the operation of the system and the provision of related support services. The
Exchange charges P-M-T for these services. The Exchange is the sole general
partner of P-M-T. In addition, P-M-T has 1,695 owners of its Class A limited
partnership interest and 57 owners of its Class B limited partnership interests.
The following table indicates the number of units held by the Exchange and by
members:

       Limited                                Number of Units Held By
                               -----------------------------------------------
       Partner     Number of         Exchange                Members
                               -----------------------------------------------
       Class       Units         Number    Percentage    Number    Percentage
      ------------------------------------------------------------------------
          A           4,786        321        6.7%        4,465       93.3%
          B             90          34       37.7            56       62.3

Class A limited partnership interests are held by CME, IOM and IMM members.
Class B limited partnership interests are held by clearing member firms.

     GFX Corporation. GFX Corporation is a wholly-owned subsidiary of the
Exchange. It was established by the Exchange for the purpose of maintaining and
creating liquidity in our foreign currency futures contracts. Experienced
foreign currency traders employed by GFX buy and sell our foreign currency
futures contracts using our GLOBEX2 system. Offsetting arbitrage transactions
using futures contracts or spot foreign currency transactions with approved
counterparties in the interbank market are used to limit risk. GFX does not seek
to profit from its trading and seeks to minimize risk. GFX's net trading gains
amounted to $2.4 million in 1999, $4.8 million in 1998 and $2.2 million in 1997.

     CME Trust. The Chicago Mercantile Exchange Trust was established in 1969 to
provide financial assistance, on a discretionary basis, to customers of any
clearing member that becomes insolvent. The Exchange funded the Trust through
contributions, which were tax deductible until a June 1996 closing agreement
with the Internal Revenue Services largely discontinued the availability of the
deduction. The Trust presently contains $42.7 million in assets as the result of
the contributions, investment income on the trust assets, and the absence of
payments from the Trust. The trustees of the fund, who are also members of the
Exchange's board of directors, have discretion to use the fund to satisfy
customer losses in the event a clearing member fails or is in such severe
financial condition that it cannot meet a customer's obligations provided that
those customers' losses are related to transactions in Exchange contracts.
Neither the Exchange nor its members have any residual interest in the assets of
the Trust.

Intellectual Property

     We regard substantial elements of our brand name, marketing elements
and logos, products, market data, software, and technology as proprietary, and
we attempt to protect these elements by relying on trademark, servicemark,
copyright and trade secret laws, restrictions on

                                       88
<PAGE>


disclosure and other methods. For example, with respect to trademarks, we have
registered marks in more than twenty countries.

   We are undertaking a review of our intellectual property to identify property
and methods of doing business which should be protected, the extent of current
protection for that property and the availability of additional protection. We
believe that our various trade and service marks have been registered where
needed. Recent legal developments allowing patent protection for methods of
doing business hold the possibility of additional protection, which we are
examining.

Employees

     As of December 1, 1999, we had 1,054 full-time equivalent employees. We
consider our relations with our employees to be good. We have never had a work
stoppage, and none of our employees are represented by a collective bargaining
agreement. However, since 1982, we have had an understanding with the
International Union of Operating Engineers, Local 399, AFL-CIO, relating to
building engineers at the headquarters building. At present, there are seven
employees to whom this understanding applies.

Facilities

     The Exchange's principal executive offices are located at 30 South Wacker
Drive, Chicago, Illinois 60606. Our telephone number is (312) 930-1000. Our
trading floor operations are also located there. We occupy approximately 430,000
square feet of office space under a lease that expires in 2003 and 70,000 square
feet of trading floor space under a lease with the CME Trust. The trading arena
has state-of-the-art wallboard price display systems, order-routing and
communications systems. On November 1, 1998, we entered into a first extension
of our lease with the CME Trust, and we have an option on three additional
extensions which will secure the availability of our trading facility until
October 2026. We maintain backup facilities for electronic systems in separate
office towers at 10 and 30 South Wacker Drive, Chicago, Illinois. We also
maintain remote offices in leased office space in Washington D.C., London,
England and Tokyo, Japan. We believe that our facilities are adequate for our
current operations and that additional space can be obtained if needed.

Legal Proceedings

     From time to time, we are involved in legal proceedings and litigation
arising in the ordinary course of business. As of the date of this prospectus,
except as described below, we are not a party to any litigation or other legal
proceeding that, in our opinion, could have a material adverse effect on our
business, operating results or financial condition. While the ultimate results
of these proceedings against the Exchange cannot be predicted with certainty,
management of the Exchange believes that the resolution of these matters will
not have a material adverse effect on its consolidated financial position or
results of operations.

     In May 1999, Victor Niederhoffer, Niederhoffer Investments, Inc., and
several commodities pools controlled by Victor Niederhoffer filed a complaint
against the Exchange and a number of unidentified employees, officials and
members in federal district court in Chicago, under the Commodity Exchange Act.
(Niederhoffer Intermarket Fund, L.P., et al. v. Chicago Mercantile Exchange, No.
99 C 3223 (N.D. Ill.)) The complaint charges that the Exchange

                                       89
<PAGE>

failed to enforce its rules relating to the establishment of settlement prices
on specified dates and that as a consequence Niederhoffer, the pools, and their
futures commission merchant suffered damages of at least $105 million. Based on
extensive pre-complaint investigation, discovery conducted to date, and advice
from legal counsel, we believe that the lawsuit is without merit and that the
plaintiffs are unlikely to prevail.

     On May 5, 1999, the Exchange, the Chicago Board of Trade, the New York
Mercantile Exchange, and Cantor Fitzgerald, L.P., were sued by Electronic
Trading Systems, Inc. in the United States District Court for the Northern
District of Texas (Dallas Division) for alleged infringement of Wagner United
States patent 4,903,201, entitled "Automated Futures Trade Exchange." The patent
relates to a system and method for implementing an electronic, computer-
automated futures exchange. Defense of the Exchange has been undertaken by
attorneys for EuroNext, the licensor of our trading system and a subsidiary of
ParisBourse, pursuant to an indemnification agreement. EuroNext has reserved its
rights under that agreement in the event that any modifications to the licensed
system made by us result in liability. Counsel for EuroNext have advised us that
they do not believe that our licensed system infringes the patent. Regardless of
the outcome of the proceeding, we believe that the indemnification agreement and
the probability that a license will be available preclude any material effect on
the Exchange.

     Several GEM members have complained that the proposed demutualization
transaction does not allocate Class A shares to them. These members sought to
bring their complaint before an appropriate committee of the Exchange, as
required by Exchange rules. The board has determined, however, that their
complaint is premature until the demutualization transaction is approved by the
members and all preconditions to the effectiveness of the transaction are
satisfied. If, at that time, these members continue to have a complaint
regarding the allocation of Class A shares, it is expected that the matter will
be referred to, and handled in accordance with, the internal dispute resolution
provisions of the Exchange's rules. The Exchange's rules require that disputes
be settled by mandatory arbitration. These members could seek an injunction to
prevent the consummation of the demutualization transaction, although the
Exchange believes that there is an adequate remedy in the form of money damages
in the event that their claims are upheld and that, as a result, an injunction
should not be issued. The Exchange believes that the allocation proposed in the
demutualization transaction is fair and reasonable.

Regulation

     Regulation of the U.S. Futures Industry

     Futures and options contracts, which are traded on futures exchanges, are
subject to regulation by the CFTC under the CEA. Futures exchanges in the United
States and elsewhere are subject to extensive regulation. Clearinghouses
affiliated with futures exchanges are similarly regulated. Our business
activities fall within the scope of this law and these regulations. We are a
designated contract market licensed by the CFTC.

     As a matter of public policy, regulatory bodies in the United States and
the rest of the world are charged with safeguarding the integrity of futures
markets and with protecting the interests of investors participating in those
markets and in the cash markets underlying futures contracts. The Exchange
maintains broad powers to ensure that free and open markets exist for

                                       90
<PAGE>

the trading of futures and options contracts. In addition to its trading
regulations, the Exchange has the power to take immediate action in dealing with
an abrupt change in factors influencing futures markets in order to ensure
orderly trading. In the United States, the CFTC is the federal agency
responsible for the administration of the CEA.

         The CEA and CFTC rules govern most aspects of our operations and impose
many affirmative obligations that can be costly and burdensome. Our ability to
continue operating depends on continued compliance with the CEA and CFTC rules
and regulations. Our ability to list new contracts is dependent on that
compliance. If we fail to comply, the CFTC may conduct administrative
proceedings which can result in censure, fine, the issuance of cease-and-desist
orders or the suspension of our designation as a contract market.

         Changes in Existing Laws and Rules

         Additional legislation or regulation, or changes in existing laws and
rules or their interpretation, may directly affect our mode of operation and our
profitability. The CFTC has recently adopted regulations that will reduce the
cost and burdens of listing new contracts for trading. Proposals for changes to
the CEA that have been suggested by other regulators might be less favorable to
our business. The regulations under which we have operated since 1974 may be
changed in a manner that will permit unregulated competitors and competitors in
other regulated industries to duplicate our markets and trade our products.

         The CEA requires all futures contracts to be executed on an exchange
that has been approved by the CFTC. The exchange trading requirement has been
modified by CFTC regulations to permit privately negotiated swap contracts to be
transacted in the over-the-counter market. At the end of 1998, according to data
from the Bank for International Settlements, the total estimated notional amount
of outstanding over-the-counter derivative contracts was $80 trillion compared
to $13.5 trillion for exchange-traded futures and options contracts. The CFTC
exemption under which the over-the-counter derivative market operates precludes
the over-the-counter market from using exchange-like electronic transaction
systems and clearing. These limitations on the exemptions granted to the
over-the-counter market have been called into question by a recent report of the
President's Working Group on Financial Markets ("PWG"). The PWG is made up of
the Treasury Secretary, and the Chairmen of the SEC, the CFTC and the Board of
Governors of the Federal Reserve System.

         The PWG advocates a complete exemption from the CEA for some
principal-to-principal derivative exchanges that provide trade execution
services comparable to those performed by the Exchange. The customers who may
access those exchanges are also significant customers of regulated exchanges
like ours. The PWG does not recommend equivalent treatment for the existing
electronic markets operated by regulated exchanges. The PWG recommends
legislation that will permit CFTC-regulated clearing organizations to clear
futures, options on futures contracts, and OTC derivatives that are not
securities or securities options. In contrast, the PWG recommends permitting
banks and SEC-regulated clearing organizations to clear financial derivative
contracts, as well as equities, government securities, repurchase and reverse
repurchase agreements, and other instruments. Finally, the PWG recommends
permitting banks and broker-dealers, and their affiliates, to operate currency
futures markets for retail customers without being subject to regulation under
the CEA. All of the PWG proposals are likely to

                                       91
<PAGE>


increase the number and quality of competitors who provide execution and
clearing services for standardized derivative contracts.

         A February 2000 CFTC staff report suggests that the CFTC use its
exemptive power to create a regulatory environment that will permit the futures
industry to accommodate itself to real world conditions. Its goal is regulation
by oversight rather than prescription. The degree of regulation proposed is
directly related to the characteristics of the product and the type of customer
that has direct or indirect access to the market, with retail customer markets
being subject to greater regulation. The CFTC will not discriminate against open
out-cry markets in favor of electronic systems. The report's proposals, if
adopted, should reduce our costs and increase our efficiency.

         Various congressional committees are in the process of drafting
legislation to implement the suggestions of the PWG and the CFTC staff. Industry
groups and other regulators are lobbying for changes to the CEA. We cannot
predict the outcome of these efforts.


                      WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

         We have filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission a
registration statement on Form S-4 with respect to the common stock offered in
this document. This document, which constitutes a part of the registration
statement, does not contain all the information in the registration statement or
the exhibits and schedules that are part of the registration statement. For
further information with respect to New CME and its common stock, please see the
registration statement and the exhibits and schedules that are part of the
registration statement. You may read and copy this document and any subsequent
documents we file at the SEC's Public Reference Room at 450 Fifth Street, N.W.,
Washington, D.C. 20549. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further
information about the Public Reference Room. Our SEC filings are also available
to the public from the SEC's Web site at http://www.sec.gov.

         Because of the offering, we will become subject to the information
requirements of the Securities Exchange Act. We will fulfill our obligations
with respect to those requirements by filing periodic reports, proxy statements
and other information with the SEC. Those reports, proxy statements and
information may be inspected and copied at the Public Reference Room referred to
above. We intend to furnish holders of our common stock with annual reports that
include annual consolidated financial statements audited by an independent
certified public accounting firm and quarterly reports for the first three
quarters of each fiscal year containing unaudited interim financial information.

       MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
                             RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

         The following discussion should be read in conjunction with our
consolidated financial statements appearing elsewhere in this document.

Historical Overview

         We are currently a not-for-profit company and have operated in a manner
consistent with

                                       92
<PAGE>

that structure. During the 1980's, we held the position as the world's second
largest derivatives exchange with volume growing from 25 million contracts in
1981 to in excess of 100 million in 1989. Revenues increased steadily over that
period and, with a relatively fixed cost structure, profits added to a growing
working capital position. In addition, members' equity grew from $17.0 million
in 1980 to $89.0 million at the end of 1990. We continued to expand our open
outcry markets, and in 1994 volume exceeded 200 million contracts traded. In
1993, we internally financed the construction of a second 37,000 square foot
trading floor and began developing Clearing 21. During the 1990's, we continued
to reinvest profits in product development and promotion that gave customers new
hedging and trading instruments and expanded our product offering. In addition,
we positioned ourselves for the future by adding to our working capital
position, making ongoing investments in electronic trading and expanding
strategic alliances.

         The competitive landscape changed in the 1990's with increased
competition from the over-the-counter market and the emergence of new electronic
exchanges. Working capital at the end of 1998 was $92.6 million. During 1999, we
made significant investments in technology infrastructure, trading floor
technology and performance upgrades to GLOBEX2. We financed these strategic
initiatives, in part, through working capital, which declined to $66.8 million
at December 31, 1999.

         The chart below and related overview is based on financial results for
the year ended December 31, 1999. Management believes they present a fair
representation of our sources of revenue and expense categories.

         [Graphic: Pie chart entitled "1999 REVENUE SOURCES" and displaying each
revenue source as a percentage of gross revenue for the first nine months of
1999. The entire chart represents and is subtitled "(100% = $208.5 MILLION)".
Revenues are broken down as follows: Clearing Fees and Transaction Fees - 66% or
$138.5, Quotation Data - 21% or $43.0, Investment Income - 4% or $9.1,
Communications - 4% or $8.2 and Other - 5% or $9.7.]

         Clearing fees, transaction fees and quotation data fees account for 87%
percent of total revenues. Investment income, communications charges to our
members and clearing member firms and other operating revenue comprise the
remaining 13% of revenues.

         Clearing and transaction fees include GLOBEX2 fees and other volume
related fees, and account for 66% of our revenues. Revenue from clearing fees is
very sensitive to volume and changes in product mix which drives the average
rate per trade. During 1999, the average rate per trade was 69(cent) and is a
function of the following factors:

         .    Product mix (1999 volume: futures 80%, options 16%, EFPs 4%)
         .    Account ownership status (member, lessee, customer, etc.)
         .    Product (licensed, non-licensed, E-Mini, etc.)
         .    Trading venue (open outcry, GLOBEX2)

         [Graphic: Line graph entitled "Average rate per trade (round-turn)" and
representing clearing fee per trade cleared by the CME. Below the horizontal
axis each year measured is listed in chronological order from left to right,
beginning with 1994 and ending with 1999. The

                                       93
<PAGE>

vertical axis indicates the average fee per trade in cents, beginning with $0.50
and increasing, in intervals of $0.05, to $0.70. A continuous line graph
connects the average clearing fee per trade for each particular year. The
average rate per trade was $0.55 in 1994, $0.61 in 1995, $0.62 in 1996, $0.58 in
1997, $0.55 in 1998 and $0.69 in 1999.]

         The fluctuation in the rate per trade over the six year period is due
to several factors. Fee reduction programs and product promotion fee waivers put
downward pressure on the average rate per trade. Conversely, increases in the
EFP surcharge and the relative growth in GLOBEX2 volume have increased the
average rate per trade. Specifically, 8(cent) of the increase in the rate per
trade from 1998 to 1999 is related to the end of the fee reduction program that
was in place during 1998, while approximately 3(cent) is attributable to the
rapid growth in GLOBEX2 volume in 1999.

         Pricing decisions for clearing fees are based on two primary factors.
First, based on the competitive environment, we may raise or lower fees to
address the business threat. Second, and somewhat related to the first, during
times of excess profit, the board may take action to reduce fees to build
customer loyalty and increase pricing pressure on the competition. In 1998, we
implemented a fee reduction initiative which resulted in a $16.9 million
reduction in clearing fees and an additional $1.0 million waiver of lessee
brokerage fees. In addition to the 1998 fee reduction program, in 1997 we
reduced fees from August 1 through December 31. Fees were raised again in 1998,
but not back to the original rates that were in effect prior to August 1, 1997.
The graph below illustrates the effect of fee reduction programs on clearing
revenue.

         [Graphic: Bar graph entitled and representing "CLEARING FEES 1994
- -1999". Below the horizontal axis each year measured is listed in chronological
order from left to right. The vertical axis indicates the fees that were
received and that would have been received had not some discount or fee waiver
been in effect, in millions, beginning with zero and increasing, at intervals of
50, to 200. The lower portion of each bar is darkly shaded to the extent of the
actual fees received. To the extent any fee reductions or waivers apply, the
bars are shaded medium and lightly, respectively. Inset in a small square to the
right of the graph is a legend containing a lightly shaded box to the immediate
left of the word "Waiver", immediately below which is a slightly darker box to
the immediate left of the words "Reduction in Rate", and immediately below which
is a darkly shaded box to the immediate left of the word "Actual". Actual
clearing fees were approximately $114 million in 1994, $111 million in 1995,
$109 million in 1996, $117 million in 1997, $125 million in 1998 and $139
million in 1999. Fee waivers during the period amounted to approximately $12
million in 1994 and $18 million in 1998. Fee reductions during the period
amounted to approximately $11 million in 1997, $13 million in 1998 and $10
million for the nine months ended September 30, 1999.]

         The second largest source of revenue, amounting to 21% of total revenue
in 1999, is quotation data fees from the sale of market data. We have
contractual relations with over 100 vendors who act as value-added resellers.
The vendors disseminate the data to over 36,000 subscribers and remit the
exchange data fee to us. Revenue growth in this key area has increased at a
compounded annual rate of 6.5% over the past ten years. The number of
subscribers, the revenue driver, has increased at a similar pace.

         Other revenues, which make up 13% of total revenues, are derived from
telecommunications services provided to members, investment income and from
various services

                                       94
<PAGE>

provided to members.

         [Graphic: Pie chart entitled "1999 EXPENSES BY CATEGORY" and displaying
each expense category as a percentage of total expenses for the first nine
months of 1999. The entire chart represents and is subtitled "(100% = $201.8
MILLION)". Expenses are broken down as follows: Salaries & Benefits - 40%,
Professional Fees & Outside Services - 14%, Communications & Computer
Maintenance - 14%, Depreciation & Amortization - 13%, Occupancy - 8%, Public
Relations & Promotion - 4% and Other - 7%.]

         Our operating expenses have increased significantly since 1997
primarily due to increased staffing and expenditures for technology projects.
For 1999, salaries and benefits accounted for 40% of our expenses as both the
trading floor and the systems development and maintenance areas required large
investments in human capital. The next largest category, professional fees and
outside services, represents 14% of total expenses in 1999 and is primarily
related to information technology consultants that are working on strategic
initiatives. Also included in this category are legal fees and license fees. The
communications and computer maintenance category accounts for 14% of our
expenses and includes expenses to support the GLOBEX2 network, computer
equipment and software and the cost to maintain the trading floors and tenant
phone systems which are administered by our Telecommunications Department. The
telecommunications revenue approximately offsets the related expense. Occupancy
related to staff offices, trading floors and remote offices represent 8% of the
expenses in 1999. Depreciation and amortization account for 13% of total
expenses. Together, occupancy and depreciation and amortization make up our
fixed costs and account for 21% of the budget. The last two categories, other
operating expenses and marketing and promotion, account for only 11% of our
expenses.

         In general, the results of operations reflect our not-for-profit
membership structure. Only a very small percentage of our expenses are variable,
thus, revenues from volume increases flow directly to operating income. Since we
do not distribute earnings, we increase spending on discretionary items and
reduce fees as a way of providing value to our members and improving the
competitive position of the Exchange.

Results of Operations

1999 Compared to 1998

         Revenues of $208.5 million for the year ended December 31, 1999,
increased $13.3 million compared to the prior year. Clearing fees and GLOBEX2
transaction fees were $138.5 million in 1999, representing an increase of $14.0
million over 1998. This increase is attributable primarily to the effect of a
program which reduced clearing fees approximately $17.9 million in the fourth
quarter of 1998, offset by an 11% decrease in volume from 226.6 million
contracts traded in 1998 to 200.7 million contracts traded in 1999. There was no
similar fee reduction program during 1999. The decrease in volume was primarily
due to reduced volatility, continued consolidation of institutional customers
and a slowdown in business as customers prepared for Y2K. Low inflation, stable
economic conditions, and the absence of world financial crises, such as the
Asian financial crisis which added to our interest rate product volume in 1998,
contributed to reduced volatility and decreased volume in interest rate
products. Revenue from quotation data fees in 1999 was $43.0 million, an
increase of $3.0 million compared to 1998, resulting from an

                                       95
<PAGE>

increase in the number of subscribers. Investment income decreased $1.0 million
due to a decrease in average invested balances. Other revenues decreased $2.6
million as a result of a reduction in trading revenues from our GFX subsidiary
and a lower level of member fines. These reductions were partially offset by
$1.7 million in revenues from GLOBEX2 terminal charges for which there were no
similar charges in 1998.

         Operating expenses in 1999 were $201.8 million, an increase of $20.8
million over 1998. Expenses increased as a result of technology advancements in
the areas of GLOBEX2, trade order processing systems, hand-held trading devices,
infrastructure improvements, and the support of both open outcry and electronic
trading systems. Salaries and benefits increased $8.6 million in 1999 to $81.0
million, reflecting additional technology staff and merit increases. Occupancy
expense decreased $1.9 million in 1999 due primarily to a reduction in rent
expense for the trading floor resulting from our exercise of an option to extend
the term of the lease. Professional fees, outside services and license fees
amounted to $28.3 million in 1999 and include significant expenditures for
GLOBEX2, Year 2000 compliance, trading floor systems, recruiting, legal services
and S&P license fees. These expenses increased $0.3 million compared to 1998,
and are net of capitalized software development costs as described in the
following paragraph. Communications and computer and software maintenance
expenses increased $5.7 million in 1999 primarily due to the expansion of the
GLOBEX2 electronic trading network. Depreciation and amortization expense
increased $7.3 million in 1999 as a result of computer equipment additions and
the amortization of capitalized software development costs. Public relations and
promotion expenses decreased $1.9 million compared to 1998, reflecting a
reduction in advertising and new product promotions. Other operating expenses
increased $2.7 million in 1999 to $13.4 million due to increases in equipment
lease interest, travel, board stipends, department supplies, staff training, and
state and local sales and use taxes.

         We adopted Statement of Position 98-1, "Accounting for the Costs of
Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal Use" ("SOP 98-1") effective
January 1, 1999, and accordingly, commenced capitalizing certain costs of
developing internal use software which would otherwise have been expensed under
our previous accounting policy. Costs capitalized during 1999 amounted to $15.3
million, and consist primarily of staff salaries and outside consulting costs.
Amortization of capitalized software development costs in 1999 amounted to $0.9
million.

         Income from continuing operations, before a deduction for limited
partners' interest in the earnings of P-M-T Limited Partnership and a provision
for income taxes, was $6.6 million in 1999, representing a decrease of $7.5
million compared to 1998. The limited partners' interest in the earnings of
P-M-T was $2.1 million in 1999, $0.7 million less than 1998 as a result of a
$1.0 million decrease in operating income of the partnership.

         The provision for income taxes decreased in 1999 to $1.9 million
compared to $4.3 million in 1998 as a result of lower pre-tax income in 1999.
The increase in our effective income tax rate from 38% in 1998 to 41% in 1999
was primarily due to greater nondeductible expenses, including costs associated
with our pending demutualization transaction.

         Net income for the year ended December 31, 1999, was $2.7 million
compared to $7.0 million for the year ended December 31, 1998.

                                       96
<PAGE>

1998 Compared to 1997

         Revenues for the year ended December 31, 1998, were $195.2 million
compared to $177.6 million for 1997. Clearing fees and GLOBEX2 transaction fees
increased to $124.6 million from $116.9 million in 1997 primarily due to a 13%
increase in volume from 200.7 million contracts traded in 1997 to 226.6 million
contracts traded in 1998. Trading volume on GLOBEX2, included above, increased
122% to 9.7 million contracts traded in 1998. The revenue impact of this
increased volume was partially offset by a $16.9 million fee reduction program
and an additional $1.0 million waiver of lessee brokerage during the fourth
quarter of 1998. Quotation data fees increased to $40.1 million in 1998 from
$37.7 million in 1997 as a result of an increase in subscribers and devices in
service. Communication fees of $8.1 million increased $0.2 million, or 3%, over
1997. Investment income increased $1.9 million to $10.1 million in 1998 due to
an increase in the average invested balance which more than offset the impact of
declining interest rates. Other operating revenue increased to $12.3 million
from $6.9 million primarily due to an increase in GFX trading revenues and
systems consulting fees we received for enhancements to the CLEARING 21(R)
system.

         Total expenses in 1998 were $181.0 million compared to $158.6 million
in 1997. The increase was due primarily to new strategic initiatives, electronic
trading and other technology projects and enhancements. Salaries and benefits
increased $5.5 million to $72.4 million in 1998 due primarily to increases in
salaries and bonuses compared to the prior year. Professional fees, outside
services and license fees of $28.0 million were $11.1 million greater than in
1997 primarily due to expenses associated with the strategic planning process
and increased spending on GLOBEX2, Year 2000 compliance and trading floor
technology. Expenses for communications and computer equipment increased $5.5
million due, in large part, to communications cost related to the GLOBEX2
network.

         Income from continuing operations, before a deduction for limited
partners' interest in the earnings of PMT and a provision for income taxes, was
$14.2 million in 1998, a decrease of $4.9 million compared to the $19.1 million
recorded in 1997. The primary reason for the decrease was the clearing fee
reduction program and waiver of lessee brokerage for the period October 12,
1998, through December 18, 1998. The limited partners' interest in the earnings
of P-M-T was $2.8 million for 1998 compared to zero in 1997. Under the terms of
the partnership agreement, the CME, as general partner, absorbed P-M-T's entire
1997 loss of $0.9 million.

         The provision for income taxes on income from continuing operations, at
an effective tax rate of 38%, was $4.3 million in 1998 compared to $7.0 million
for the same period in 1997. The loss from discontinued operations during the
year ended December 31, 1997, consists of operating losses and the write-off of
certain assets of the CME Depository Trust Company, which ceased operation in
September 1997. No further adjustments were required in 1998. CME Depository
Trust Company had been developing collateral management services for the
over-the-counter derivatives market. It had not reported any revenue, and the
Exchange determined that additional developmental efforts were not warranted.
Net income was $7.0 million for the year ended December 31, 1998, compared to
$8.7 million for the year ended December 31, 1997.

Financial Position

         Total assets increased to $301.7 million at December 31, 1999, from
$293.2 million at December 31, 1998. Current assets decreased to $176.7 million
at December 31, 1999, from $203.3 million at December 31, 1998, due primarily to
a decrease of $27.6 million in investment

                                       97
<PAGE>

securities. Property, net of accumulated depreciation, increased to $93.5
million at the end of 1999 compared to $71.3 million at the end of 1998
primarily due to purchases of computer equipment to support technology and
electronic trading both on and off the trading floor. Other assets increased to
$31.4 million from $18.6 million at the end of 1998 due primarily to an increase
of $14.4 million in capitalized software development costs net of accumulated
amortization, an increase in computer software of $1.3 million, and an increase
of $1.6 million in securities held in connection with deferred compensation
plans partially offset by a $4.5 million decrease in net deferred tax assets. At
December 31, 1999, we held cash, cash equivalents and investment securities of
$74.4 million, had working capital of $66.8 million and had a current ratio of
1.6-to-1. This compares to cash, cash equivalents and investment securities of
$102.6 million, working capital of $92.6 and a 1.8-to-1 current ratio at
December 31, 1998.

         Total liabilities increased to $133.0 million at December 31, 1999,
from $126.3 million at December 31, 1998. Current liabilities decreased to
$110.0 million at December 31, 1999, from $110.7 million at December 31, 1998. A
decrease in accounts payable in 1999 was largely offset by an increase in the
current portion of long-term debt and an increase in cash performance bonds and
security deposits. The limited partners' interest in PMT Limited Partnership
increased to $3.0 million at December 31, 1999, compared to $0.9 million a year
earlier due to 1999 net income of this consolidated partnership in the amount of
$2.6 million. Long-term debt consists of the long-term portion of capitalized
lease obligations and increased to $8.1 million at December 31, 1999, from $5.0
million at December 31, 1998. Other liabilities increased to $11.9 million at
December 31, 1999, from $9.8 million at December 31, 1998, due primarily to a
$1.6 million increase in deferred compensation liabilities. Members' equity was
$168.7 million at December 31, 1999, and $166.9 million at December 31, 1998.


Liquidity and Capital Resources

         For the year ended December 31, 1999, net cash provided from operating
activities was $13.3 million, a decrease of $12.1 million from $25.5 million in
1998. This decrease was primarily due to an increase in capitalized software
development costs in 1999. For the year ended December 31, 1998, net cash
provided from operating activities was $25.5 million, a decrease of $0.6 million
from $26.1 million in 1997.

         For the year ended December 31, 1999, net cash used in investing
activities decreased to $11.3 million from $19.9 million in 1998. Purchases of
computer equipment and other property increased $18.7 million in 1999 compared
to 1998. This increase was more than offset by an increase of $27.3 million in
net sales of investment securities in 1999 compared to 1998. For the year ended
December 31, 1998, net cash used in investing activities decreased to $19.9
million from $24.6 million in 1997 due primarily to reduced net investment
purchases in 1998.

         Net cash used in financing activities consisted of $2.7 in payments on
capital lease obligations in the year ended December 31, 1999, and a cash
distribution to P-M-T limited partners in the amount of $2.0 million during the
year ended December 31, 1998.

         For the year ended December 31, 1999, interest payments amounted to
$0.7 million and consisted primarily of interest paid on capital lease
obligations. New capital lease additions increased $1.8 million to $7.9 million
in 1999 from $6.1 million during 1998.

                                       98
<PAGE>

         The Exchange is a designated contract market for futures and options on
futures, and clears and guarantees the settlement of all futures and options
contracts traded in our markets. The Clearing House maintains an unsecured
committed line of credit with a consortium of banks in the amount of $350
million to provide liquidity and capacity to pay settlement variation to all
clearing members even if a clearing member fails to meet its financial
obligations to the Clearing House. This line of credit is renewed annually and
has never been utilized.

         We expect that the principal use of funds in the foreseeable future
will be to fund operations, capital expenditures and working capital, and
anticipate that existing cash and investment balances will be sufficient to meet
our needs for at least the next year.

Market Risk

         Interest Rate Risk

         Interest income from investment securities, temporary cash investments
and cash performance bonds and security deposits amounted to approximately $7.9
million in 1999. Realized and unrealized gains (losses) on our investment
portfolio amounted to approximately $(1.4) million, $0.6 million and $0.6
million in 1999, 1998 and 1997, respectively. An increase (decrease) in market
interest rates would have a corresponding increase (decrease) on interest income
from temporary cash investments, cash performance bonds and security deposits,
variable rate investment securities and new purchases of investment securities.
An increase (decrease) in market interest rates would also result in an opposite
increase (decrease) in the fair value of investment securities held. At December
31, 1999, our investment portfolio consisted primarily of U.S. government agency
and state and municipal securities, including approximately $8.4 million in
variable rate securities. Contractual maturities and interest coupon rates for
fixed rate investment securities at December 31, 1999 were as follows (dollars
in thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 Weighted
                                     Principal   Average
                           Year      Amount      Interest Rate
                           ----      --------    -------------
                           <S>       <C>         <C>
                           2000      $ 5,689          5.3%
                           2001       22,220          6.1%
                           2002        7,911          6.4%
                           2003        6,000          5.2%
                           2004        9,300          6.0%
                                     -------         ----
                           Total     $51,120          5.9%
                                     -------         ----
</TABLE>

         Derivative Trading Risk

         Through our GFX trading subsidiary, we engage in the purchase and sale
of CME foreign currency futures contracts to promote liquidity in our markets,
and enter into offsetting arbitrage transactions using futures contracts or spot
foreign currency transactions to limit market risk. Net position limits are
established for each trader and currently amount to $6 million in aggregate
notional value. At December 31, 1999, we held futures positions with a notional
value of approximately $4 million, offset by a similar amount of spot foreign
currency positions resulting in a zero net position. All positions are marked to
market through a charge or credit to income on a daily basis. Net trading gains
amounted to $2.4 million, $4.8 million and $2.2

                                       99
<PAGE>

million in 1999, 1998 and 1997, respectively.

Accounting Standards

         In June, 1998, Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 133,
"Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities" was issued. This
statement requires that all derivative instruments be recorded in the statement
of financial position at fair value. This statement is effective for all fiscal
years commencing after June 15, 2000. We currently report all derivative
transactions at fair market value, with changes in fair value recognized in our
statement of income, and this practice will not be affected by SFAS No. 133.


                                    EXPERTS

         Our consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 1999 and 1998,
and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1999, are
included in this document together with Arthur Andersen LLP's audit report on
these financial statements. Arthur Andersen LLP issued their report as
independent public accountants and as experts in auditing and accounting.

                            VALIDITY OF SECURITIES

         The validity of the shares of Class A and Class B common stock to be
issued in connection with the demutualization transactions will be passed upon
for New CME by Sidley & Austin, Chicago, Illinois.

                                      100
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

                   INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            Page
                                                                            ----
<S>                                                                         <C>
Report of Independent Public Accountants..................................  F-2

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 1999 and December 31, 1998.  F-3

Consolidated Statements of Income for the Years Ended December 31, 1999,
 1998 and 1997 ...........................................................  F-4

Consolidated Statements of Members' Equity and Comprehensive Income for
 the Years Ended December 31, 1999, 1998 and 1997.........................  F-5

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31,
 1999, 1998 and 1997......................................................  F-6

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements................................  F-7
</TABLE>

                                      F-1
<PAGE>

                    REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS

To the Board of Directors and Members of the Chicago Mercantile Exchange:

   We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of the Chicago
Mercantile Exchange (an Illinois not-for-profit corporation) and subsidiaries
as of December 31, 1999 and 1998, and the related consolidated statements of
income, members' equity and comprehensive income and cash flows for each of the
years in the three-year period ended December 31, 1999. These financial
statements are the responsibility of the Exchange's management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on
our audits.

   We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of
material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence
supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit
also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant
estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial
statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis
for our opinion.

   In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly,
in all material respects, the financial position of the Chicago Mercantile
Exchange and subsidiaries as of December 31, 1999 and 1998, and the results of
their operations and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period
ended December 31, 1999, in conformity with generally accepted accounting
principles.

Arthur Andersen, LLP

Chicago, Illinois
February 2, 2000


                                      F-2
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               At December 31,
                                                              -----------------
                           ASSETS                               1999     1998
                           ------                             -------- --------
                                                                 (dollars in
                                                                 thousands)
<S>                                                           <C>      <C>
Current Assets:
  Cash and cash equivalents.................................. $ 14,249 $ 14,841
  Investments (Note 2).......................................   60,156   87,730
  Accounts receivable........................................   26,534   27,338
  Prepaid expenses...........................................    2,655    1,589
  Cash performance bonds and security deposits (Note 3)......   73,134   71,803
                                                              -------- --------
    Total current assets.....................................  176,728  203,301
Property, net of accumulated depreciation and amortization
 (Note 4)....................................................   93,531   71,266
Other assets (Notes 2, 5 and 7)..............................   31,444   18,638
                                                              -------- --------
    Total assets............................................. $301,703 $293,205
                                                              ======== ========
<CAPTION>
               LIABILITIES AND MEMBERS' EQUITY
               -------------------------------
<S>                                                           <C>      <C>
Current Liabilities:
  Accounts payable........................................... $ 15,569 $ 19,070
  Other current liabilities (Note 8).........................   21,250   19,797
  Cash performance bonds and security deposits (Note 3)......   73,134   71,803
                                                              -------- --------
    Total current liabilities................................  109,953  110,670
Limited Partners' interest in net assets of PMT Limited
 Partnership (Note 6)........................................    3,018      891
Long-term debt (Notes 10 and 11).............................    8,132    4,969
Other liabilities (Note 9)...................................   11,937    9,778
                                                              -------- --------
    Total liabilities........................................  133,040  126,308
Members' equity..............................................  168,663  166,897
                                                              -------- --------
    Total liabilities and members' equity.................... $301,703 $293,205
                                                              ======== ========
</TABLE>


          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-3
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

                       CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   Year Ended December 31,
                                                  ----------------------------
                                                    1999      1998      1997
                                                  --------  --------  --------
                                                    (dollars in thousands)
<S>                                               <C>       <C>       <C>
Revenues
  Clearing and transaction fees.................. $138,526  $124,575  $116,917
  Quotation data fees............................   43,005    40,079    37,719
  Communication fees.............................    8,165     8,128     7,885
  Investment income..............................    9,091    10,117     8,178
  Other operating revenue........................    9,701    12,317     6,945
                                                  --------  --------  --------
    Total revenues...............................  208,488   195,216   177,644
                                                  --------  --------  --------
Expenses
  Salaries and benefits (Note 9).................   80,957    72,385    66,873
  Occupancy......................................   17,773    19,702    19,779
  Professional fees, outside services and
   licenses......................................   28,319    28,038    16,913
  Communications and computer and software
   maintenance...................................   28,443    22,731    17,197
  Depreciation and amortization..................   25,274    17,943    16,689
  Public relations and promotion.................    7,702     9,586    11,175
  Other operating expense........................   13,376    10,638     9,960
                                                  --------  --------  --------
    Total expenses...............................  201,844   181,023   158,586
                                                  --------  --------  --------
Income from continuing operations before limited
 partners' interest in PMT and income taxes......    6,644    14,193    19,058
Limited partners' interest in earnings of PMT
 Limited Partnership (Note 6)....................   (2,126)   (2,849)      --
Provision for income taxes (Note 7)..............   (1,855)   (4,315)   (6,963)
                                                  --------  --------  --------
Income from continuing operations................    2,663     7,029    12,095
Loss from discontinued operations, net of income
 tax benefit of $2,285 (Note 16).................      --        --     (3,428)
                                                  --------  --------  --------
    Net income................................... $  2,663  $  7,029  $  8,667
                                                  ========  ========  ========
</TABLE>


          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-4
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

      CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF MEMBERS' EQUITY AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                 Total             Proceeds from   Unrealized
                                Members'  Retained  Issuance of    Securities
                                 Equity   Earnings  Memberships  Gains (losses)
                                --------  -------- ------------- --------------
                                            (dollars in thousands)
<S>                             <C>       <C>      <C>           <C>
Balance, December 31, 1996..... $150,631  $107,062    $43,605        $ (36)
Comprehensive income:
  Net income...................    8,667     8,667
  Unrealized net gain on
   securities,
   net of tax of $171..........      256                               256
                                --------
    Total comprehensive income.    8,923
                                --------  --------    -------        -----
Balance, December 31, 1997.....  159,554   115,729     43,605          220
Comprehensive income:
  Net income...................    7,029     7,029
  Unrealized net gain on
   securities,
   net of tax of $209..........      314                               314
                                --------
    Total comprehensive income.    7,343
                                --------  --------    -------        -----
Balance, December 31, 1998.....  166,897   122,758     43,605          534
Comprehensive income:
  Net income...................    2,663     2,663
  Unrealized net loss on
   securities,
   net of tax benefit of $597..     (897)                             (897)
                                --------
    Total comprehensive income.    1,766
                                --------  --------    -------        -----
Balance, December 31, 1999..... $168,663  $125,421    $43,605        $(363)
                                ========  ========    =======        =====
</TABLE>


          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-5
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                    Year Ended December 31,
                                                    --------------------------
                                                     1999     1998      1997
                                                    -------  -------  --------
                                                     (dollars in thousands)
<S>                                                 <C>      <C>      <C>
Cash Flows from Operating Activities
  Net income....................................... $ 2,663  $ 7,029  $  8,667
    Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash
     provided by operating activities:
      Limited partners' interest in earnings of PMT
       Partnership.................................   2,126    2,849       --
      Deferred income tax provision................   5,087   (1,311)   (3,127)
      Depreciation and amortization................  25,274   17,943    16,689
      Gain on sale of investments..................    (135)     (57)     (196)
      Loss on disposal of fixed assets.............       7      125        98
      Decrease (increase) in accounts receivable...     804   (8,367)     (533)
      Decrease (increase) in prepaid expenses......  (1,066)    (907)      127
      Decrease (increase) in other assets.......... (19,412)    (859)    1,910
      Decrease (increase) in net assets of
       discontinued operations.....................     --       --      3,363
      Increase (decrease) in accounts payable......  (3,501)   2,524     4,090
      Increase (decrease) in other current
       liabilities.................................    (661)   5,628    (3,650)
      Increase (decrease) in other liabilities.....   2,160      896    (1,367)
                                                    -------  -------  --------
        Net cash provided by operating activities..  13,346   25,493    26,071
                                                    -------  -------  --------
Cash Flows from Investing Activities
  Purchases of property, net....................... (37,480) (18,817)  (14,346)
  Purchases of investments......................... (41,938) (99,332) (139,865)
  Proceeds from sales and maturities of
   investments.....................................  68,144   98,284   129,623
                                                    -------  -------  --------
        Net cash used in investing activities...... (11,274) (19,865)  (24,588)
                                                    -------  -------  --------
Cash Flows from Financing Activities...............
  Payments on long-term debt.......................  (2,664)     --        --
  Distribution to limited partners of PMT Limited
   Partnership.....................................     --    (1,957)      --
                                                    -------  -------  --------
        Net cash used in financing activities......  (2,664)  (1,957)      --
                                                    -------  -------  --------
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash
 equivalents.......................................    (592)   3,671     1,483
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year.......  14,841   11,170     9,687
                                                    -------  -------  --------
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year............. $14,249  $14,841  $ 11,170
                                                    =======  =======  ========
Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information
  Interest paid.................................... $   705  $     2  $     26
                                                    =======  =======  ========
  Income taxes paid (refunded)..................... $  (265) $ 9,042  $  8,317
                                                    =======  =======  ========
  Leased asset additions and related obligations... $ 7,940  $ 6,118  $    --
                                                    =======  =======  ========
</TABLE>

          See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

                                      F-6
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies:

 Description of Business

   The Chicago Mercantile Exchange (the "CME") is a member-owned corporation
organized under Illinois not-for-profit law. It is subject to federal and state
corporate income tax and files a consolidated income tax return. The CME is a
designated contract market for the trading of futures and options on futures
contracts. Trades are executed through both open outcry and electronic trading
systems. Through its in-house clearing division, the CME clears, settles, nets
and guarantees performance of all matched transactions in its products. As an
Illinois not-for-profit corporation, the CME may not pay dividends to its
members.

 Basis of Presentation

   The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Chicago
Mercantile Exchange and its controlled subsidiaries, which include the PMT
Limited Partnership and GFX Corporation (collectively, the "Exchange").
Included as discontinued operations are the accounts of the CME Depository
Trust Co. ("CME-DTC") whose operations ceased in 1997 (See Note 16). All
intercompany transactions and accounts have been eliminated in consolidation.

 Cash and Cash Equivalents

   Cash equivalents consist of highly liquid investments with maturities of
three months or less when purchased.

 Investments

   Investment securities have generally been classified as available for sale
and are carried at fair value with unrealized gains and losses reported net of
tax as a component of members' equity and comprehensive income. Interest on
investment securities is recognized as income when earned and includes accreted
discount less amortized premium.

   Additional securities held in connection with non-qualified deferred
compensation plans have been classified as trading securities. These securities
are included in other assets in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets at
fair value, and unrealized gains and losses are reflected in investment income.

 Performance Bonds and Security Deposits

   Performance bonds and security deposits held by the Exchange for the account
of clearing members may be in the form of cash or securities. Cash performance
bonds and security deposits are reflected in the accompanying consolidated
balance sheets. Cash received may be invested and any interest received accrues
to the Exchange. Securities consist primarily of short-term U.S. Treasury
securities and are not reflected in the accompanying consolidated balance
sheets. These securities are held in safekeeping, and interest and gain or loss
on such securities accrues to the clearing member.

 Property

   Property is stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization.
Depreciation on furniture, fixtures and equipment is provided on the straight-
line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets, generally three to
seven years. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the lesser of their
estimated useful lives or the remaining term of the applicable leases.
Maintenance and repair items are charged to expense as incurred; renewals and
betterments are capitalized.

                                      F-7
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)


 Software Development Costs

   During 1998 and prior years, the Exchange expensed all internal and external
costs associated with the development of software for internal use. In March
1998, the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants issued Statement
of Position 98-1, "Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software Developed or
Obtained for Internal Use" ("SOP 98-1"). This pronouncement identifies the
characteristics of internal use software and provides guidance on new cost
recognition principles. SOP 98-1 is effective for financial statements for
fiscal years beginning after December 15, 1998. The Exchange adopted SOP 98-1
effective January 1, 1999, and accordingly, commenced capitalizing certain
costs of developing internal use software, which would otherwise have been
expensed under its previous accounting policy. Capitalized costs are generally
amortized over three years, commencing with the completion of the project.

 Fair Value of Financial Instruments

   SFAS No. 107, "Disclosures about Fair Value of Financial Instruments,"
requires disclosure of the fair value of financial instruments. The carrying
values of financial instruments included in assets and liabilities in the
accompanying consolidated balance sheets are reasonable estimates of their fair
values.

 Impairment of Assets

   The Exchange reviews its long-lived assets and intangible assets for
impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the
carrying amounts may not be recoverable. If such assets are considered to be
impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured by the amount by which
the carrying amount of the assets exceeds the fair value of the assets.

 Clearing and Transaction Fees

   Clearing and transaction fees include per contract charges for trade
execution and clearing and GLOBEX2 electronic system fees. Fees are charged at
various rates based on the product traded and the account owner's Exchange
membership. Rates have been adjusted or waived periodically.

 Quotation Data Fees

   Quotation revenue represents fees charged for the dissemination of market
information.

 Income Taxes

   Deferred income taxes are determined in accordance with Statement of
Financial Accounting Standards ("SFAS") No. 109, "Accounting for Income Taxes,"
and arise from temporary differences between amounts reported for income tax
and financial statement purposes.

 Use of Estimates

   The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and
assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and
disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial
statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the
reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

 Reclassifications

   Certain reclassifications have been made to the 1998 and 1997 consolidated
financial statements to conform to the presentation in 1999. In addition, the
Exchange adopted a new balance sheet presentation for performance bonds and
security deposits as described above, and the accompanying balance sheets
reflect this new presentation. The Exchange previously included performance
bonds and security deposits received from its clearing members in the form of
securities as both an asset and a liability in its consolidated balance sheets.

                                      F-8
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)


2. Investment Securities

   Investment securities included in current assets have been classified as
available for sale. The amortized cost and fair value of these investment
securities at December 31, 1999 and 1998, were as follows (dollars in
thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   1999              1998
                                             ----------------- -----------------
                                             Amortized  Fair   Amortized  Fair
                                               Cost     Value    Cost     Value
                                             --------- ------- --------- -------
      <S>                                    <C>       <C>     <C>       <C>
      U.S. Treasury.........................  $    64  $    64  $ 3,127  $ 3,127
      U.S. Government agency................   16,563   16,191   23,073   23,308
      State and municipal...................   44,135   43,901   60,641   61,295
                                              -------  -------  -------  -------
          Total investment securities.......  $60,762  $60,156  $86,841  $87,730
                                              =======  =======  =======  =======
</TABLE>

   Unrealized gains (losses) on investment securities classified as available
for sale, included in the accompanying consolidated statement of changes in
members' equity, are reported as a component of comprehensive income. The
amortized cost and fair value of these investment securities at December 31,
1999, by contractual maturity, were as follows (dollars in thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              Amortized  Fair
                                                                Cost     Value
                                                              --------- -------
      <S>                                                     <C>       <C>
      Maturity of one year or less...........................  $ 5,678  $ 5,662
      Maturity between one and five years....................   46,684   46,094
      Maturity greater than five years.......................    8,400    8,400
                                                               -------  -------
          Total..............................................  $60,762  $60,156
                                                               =======  =======
</TABLE>

   Trading securities held in connection with non-qualified deferred
compensation plans are included in other assets and amounted to approximately
$6.9 million at December 31, 1999, and $5.3 million at December 31, 1998.
Investment income includes unrealized gains relating to trading securities of
$469,000, $407,000 and $285,000 for the years ended December 31, 1999, 1998 and
1997, respectively.

3. Performance Bonds and Security Deposits

   The Exchange is a designated contract market for futures and options on
futures, and clears and guarantees the settlement of all futures and options
contracts traded in its markets. In its guarantor role, the Exchange has
precisely equal and offsetting claims to and from clearing members on opposite
sides of each contract. The CME bears counterparty credit risk in the event
that future market movements create conditions which could lead to clearing
members failing to meet their obligations to the Exchange. The CME reduces its
exposure through a risk management program which includes rigorous initial and
ongoing financial standards for clearing membership, initial and maintenance
performance bond requirements and mandatory security deposits. In addition, the
Exchange maintains an unsecured committed line of credit with a consortium of
banks (Note 12) in the amount of $350 million to provide liquidity and capacity
to pay settlement variation to all clearing members even if a clearing member
may have failed to meet its financial obligations to the CME, or in the event
of a temporary problem with the domestic payments system that would delay
payments of settlement variation between the Exchange and its clearing members.

   The Exchange is required under the Commodity Exchange Act to segregate cash
and securities deposited by clearing members on behalf of their customers. In
addition, Exchange rules require a segregation of all funds deposited by
clearing members from operating funds.

                                      F-9
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)


   Clearing members, at their option, may instruct the Exchange to invest cash
on deposit for performance bond purposes, in a portfolio of securities in the
Exchange's Interest Earning Facility ("IEF"). The IEF was organized in 1997 as
two limited liability companies, and interest earned, net of expenses, is
passed on to participating member firms. IEF principal is guaranteed by the
Exchange. The IEF investment portfolio is managed by one of the Exchange's
approved settlement banks, and eligible investments include U.S. Treasury bills
and notes, U.S. Treasury strips, and reverse repurchase agreements. Repurchase
agreements are also permitted. The maximum average portfolio maturity is 90
days, and the maximum maturity for an individual security is 13 months. IEF
principal amounted to approximately $762 million and $634 million at December
31, 1999 and 1998, respectively. Management believes that the market risk
exposure relating to its guarantee is not material to the financial statements
taken as a whole. The Exchange earned fees under the IEF program in the amount
of $932,000, $428,000 and $96,000 during 1999, 1998 and 1997, respectively.

   Each clearing member is required to deposit and maintain specified margin in
the form of cash, U.S. Government securities or bank letters of credit. These
performance bonds are available to meet only the financial obligations of that
clearing member to the Exchange. All obligations and non-cash margin deposits
are marked to market on a daily basis, and haircuts are applied for margin and
risk management purposes. Under an agreement with the CME and the Board of
Trade Clearing Corporation ("BOTCC"), firms that are clearing members of both
the CME and BOTCC may place required performance bonds in one common bank
account and designate the portion allocable to each clearing organization.

   The Exchange and the Options Clearing Corporation ("OCC") have a cross-
margin arrangement whereby a common clearing member may maintain a cross-margin
account in which the clearing member's positions in certain futures and options
on futures are combined with certain OCC cleared option positions for purposes
of calculating performance bond requirements. The performance bond deposits are
held jointly by the Exchange and the OCC.

   Each clearing member is also required to deposit and maintain specified
security deposits in the form of cash or securities. In the event that
performance bonds and security deposits of a defaulting clearing member are
inadequate to fulfill that clearing member's outstanding financial obligation,
the entire security deposit fund is available to cover potential losses after
first utilizing surplus operating funds of the Exchange.

   Cash and securities held as performance bonds and security deposits at
December 31 were as follows (dollars in thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                               1999                1998
                                        ------------------- -------------------
                                                Securities          Securities
                                                    and                 and
                                         Cash    IEF Funds   Cash    IEF Funds
                                        ------- ----------- ------- -----------
      <S>                               <C>     <C>         <C>     <C>
      Performance bonds................ $68,738 $17,841,859 $67,192 $15,469,446
      Security deposits................   4,396     351,897   4,611     184,737
      Cross-margin securities, held
       jointly with OCC................     --    1,056,709     --      576,873
                                        ------- ----------- ------- -----------
          Total........................ $73,134 $19,250,465 $71,803 $16,231,056
                                        ======= =========== ======= ===========
</TABLE>

   In addition, irrevocable letters of credit, which are not included in the
accompanying consolidated balance sheets, held at December 31 were as follows
(dollars in thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             1999       1998
                                                          ---------- ----------
      <S>                                                 <C>        <C>
      Performance bonds.................................. $1,000,350 $1,078,650
      Cross-margin accounts..............................     77,010      4,110
                                                          ---------- ----------
          Total letters of credit........................ $1,077,360 $1,082,760
                                                          ========== ==========
</TABLE>


                                      F-10
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)

4. Property

   A summary of the property accounts as of December 31 is presented below
(dollars in thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               1999      1998
                                                             --------  --------
      <S>                                                    <C>       <C>
      Furniture, fixtures and equipment..................... $140,836  $101,022
      Leasehold improvements................................   83,461    77,855
                                                             --------  --------
      Total property........................................  224,297   178,877
      Less accumulated depreciation and amortization........ (130,766) (107,611)
                                                             --------  --------
      Net property.......................................... $ 93,531  $ 71,266
                                                             ========  ========
</TABLE>

5. Other assets

   Other assets consisted of the following at December 31 (dollars in
thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                1999     1998
                                                               -------  -------
      <S>                                                      <C>      <C>
      Software development costs.............................. $15,326  $   --
        Less accumulated amortization.........................    (935)     --
      Software................................................   9,300    6,812
        Less accumulated amortization.........................  (5,469)  (4,286)
      Deferred compensation assets............................   6,934    5,345
      Net deferred tax asset..................................   5,868   10,357
      Other...................................................     420      410
                                                               -------  -------
      Total................................................... $31,444  $18,638
                                                               =======  =======
</TABLE>

6. P-M-T Limited Partnership

   The Exchange is the general partner and members and clearing members of the
Exchange are limited partners of the PMT Limited Partnership ("PMT"), an
Illinois limited partnership. PMT was formed in 1987 to initiate the
development of the GLOBEX(R) global electronic trading system ("GLOBEX"). From
May 1, 1996, through November 1998, GLOBEX was operated by Reuter Futures
Services Inc. ("Reuters") under an agreement with participating exchanges (the
Exchange and MATIF, a French futures exchange). The system previously operated
by Reuters was replaced by a new system, called GLOBEX\\2\\, which is operated
by the Exchange and uses electronic trading software licensed from
ParisBourseSBFSA. The Exchange charges PMT for services provided. PMT reported
net income (loss) of $2,578,000, $3,536,000 and $(872,000) in 1999, 1998 and
1997, respectively, and made an income distribution of $2,393,000 in 1998.
Losses in excess of limited partner capital account balances are allocated to
the Exchange as general partner. As a result, PMT's entire 1997 loss was
absorbed by the CME.

                                      F-11
<PAGE>

                 CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)


7. Income Taxes

   The provision for income taxes from continuing operations is comprised of
the following (dollars in thousands):
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                       1999     1998     1997
                                                      -------  -------  -------
      <S>                                             <C>      <C>      <C>
      Current:
        Federal...................................... $(2,721) $ 4,613  $ 8,274
        State........................................    (511)   1,013    1,816
                                                      -------  -------  -------
          Total......................................  (3,232)   5,626   10,090
                                                      -------  -------  -------
      Deferred:
        Federal......................................   4,166   (1,075)  (2,564)
        State........................................     921     (236)    (563)
                                                      -------  -------  -------
          Total......................................   5,087   (1,311)  (3,127)
                                                      -------  -------  -------
      Total continuing operations....................   1,855    4,315    6,963
      Total discontinued operations..................     --       --    (2,285)
                                                      -------  -------  -------
          Total provision for income taxes........... $ 1,855  $ 4,315  $ 4,678
                                                      =======  =======  =======
</TABLE>

   Reconciliation of the statutory U.S. federal income tax rate to the
effective tax rate on income from continuing operations is as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              1999   1998  1997
                                                              -----  ----  ----
      <S>                                                     <C>    <C>   <C>
      Statutory U.S. federal tax rate........................  35.0% 35.0% 35.0%
      State taxes, net of federal benefit....................   5.9   3.8   4.3
      Tax exempt interest income............................. (15.0) (6.6) (2.8)
      Non deductible expenses................................  21.1   3.7   2.1
      Other, net.............................................  (5.9)  2.1  (2.1)
                                                              -----  ----  ----
      Effective tax rate.....................................  41.1% 38.0% 36.5%
                                                              =====  ====  ====
</TABLE>

   At December 31, the components of deferred tax assets (liabilities) were as
follows (dollars in thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 1999    1998
                                                                ------  -------
      <S>                                                       <C>     <C>
      Deferred tax assets:
        Depreciation and amortization.......................... $6,085  $ 5,813
        Deferred compensation..................................  2,452    2,167
        Accrued expenses.......................................  2,929    2,828
        Unrealized losses on securities........................    242      --
                                                                ------  -------
          Subtotal............................................. 11,708   10,808
          Valuation allowance..................................    --       --
                                                                ------  -------
          Deferred tax assets.................................. 11,708   10,808
                                                                ------  -------
      Deferred tax liabilities:
        Software development costs............................. (5,709)     --
        Unrealized gains on securities.........................    --      (356)
        Other..................................................   (131)     (95)
                                                                ------  -------
        Deferred tax liabilities............................... (5,840)    (451)
                                                                ------  -------
      Net deferred tax asset................................... $5,868  $10,357
                                                                ======  =======
</TABLE>


                                     F-12
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)


8. Other Current Liabilities

   Other current liabilities include accrued salaries and benefits of $13.0
million and $12.7 million at December 31, 1999 and 1998, respectively. Also
included in other current liabilities is the current portion of long-term debt
which totaled $3.3 million at December 31, 1999, and $1.1 million at December
31, 1998.

9. Employee Benefit Plans

 Pension Plan

   The Exchange maintains a noncontributory defined benefit cash balance
pension plan ("Plan") for eligible employees. Employees who have completed a
continuous 12-month period of employment and have reached the age of 21 are
eligible to participate. The Plan provides for an age-based contribution to the
cash balance account and includes cash bonuses in the definition of considered
earnings. Participant cash balance accounts receive an interest credit at the
one-year U.S. Treasury Bill rate. Participants become vested in their accounts
after five years. The Exchange's policy is to currently fund required pension
costs.

   A reconciliation of beginning and ending balances of the benefit obligation
and fair value of Plan assets, the funded status of the Plan, certain actuarial
assumptions and the components of pension cost are indicated below (dollars in
thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               1999     1998
                                                              -------  -------
      <S>                                                     <C>      <C>
      Change in benefit obligation
        Benefit obligation at beginning of year.............. $11,826  $10,646
        Service cost.........................................   2,052    1,774
        Interest cost........................................     988      850
        Actuarial loss (gain)................................    (303)     401
        Benefits paid........................................  (1,095)  (1,845)
                                                              -------  -------
          Benefit obligation at end of year.................. $13,468  $11,826
                                                              =======  =======
      Change in plan assets
        Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year....... $13,522  $11,742
        Actual return on plan assets.........................   1,741    1,530
        Employer contribution................................   1,000    2,095
        Benefits paid........................................  (1,095)  (1,845)
                                                              -------  -------
          Fair value of plan assets at end of year........... $15,168  $13,522
                                                              =======  =======
      Funded status at December 31
        Plan assets in excess of benefit obligation.......... $ 1,700  $ 1,696
        Unrecognized transition asset........................    (335)    (410)
        Unrecognized prior service cost (credit).............    (227)    (278)
        Unrecognized net actuarial gain......................  (3,082)  (1,962)
                                                              -------  -------
          Accrued benefit cost............................... $(1,944) $  (954)
                                                              =======  =======
</TABLE>

                                      F-13
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          1999    1998    1997
                                                         ------  ------  ------
      <S>                                                <C>     <C>     <C>
      Actuarial assumptions as of December 31
        Discount rate...................................   7.75%   6.75%   7.25%
        Rate of compensation increase...................   5.00%   5.00%   5.00%
        Expected return on plan assets..................   8.00%   8.00%   8.00%
      Components of pension cost
        Service cost.................................... $2,052  $1,774  $1,943
        Interest cost...................................    988     850     810
        Expected return on plan assets..................   (925)   (803)   (800)
        Amortization of prior service cost..............    (51)    (51)    (51)
        Amortization of transition asset................    (74)    (74)    (74)
        Recognized net actuarial gain...................    --      --      (25)
                                                         ------  ------  ------
          Net pension cost.............................. $1,990  $1,696  $1,803
                                                         ======  ======  ======
</TABLE>

 Savings Plan

   The Exchange maintains a savings plan pursuant to Section 401(k) of the
Internal Revenue Code whereby all employees are participants and have the
option to contribute to the Plan. The Exchange matches employee contributions
up to 3% of the employee's base salary and makes an additional contribution of
up to 2% of salary based on annual trading volume. Total expense for the
savings plan amounted to $1,264,000, $1,762,000 and $1,682,000 in 1999, 1998
and 1997, respectively.

 Non-Qualified Plans

   The Exchange maintains the following non-qualified plans under which
participants may make assumed investment choices with respect to amounts
contributed on their behalf. Although not required to do so, the Exchange
invests such contributions in assets which mirror the assumed investment
choices. The balances in these plans are subject to the claims of general
creditors of the Exchange, and amounted to approximately $6.9 million and $5.3
million at December 31, 1999 and 1998, respectively.

     Supplemental Plan--The Exchange maintains a non-qualified supplemental
  plan to provide benefits for certain officers who have been impacted by
  statutory limits under the provisions of the qualified pension and savings
  plans. Total expense for the supplemental plan amounted to $319,000,
  $260,000 and $230,000 in 1999, 1998 and 1997, respectively.

     Deferred Compensation Plan--The Exchange maintains a deferred
  compensation plan under which eligible officers and board members may
  contribute a percentage of their compensation and defer income taxes
  thereon until the time of distribution.

     Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan--The Exchange maintains a non-
  qualified, defined contribution plan for senior officers. Under the plan,
  the Exchange contributes an amount equal to 8% of salary and bonus of
  eligible employees annually. Post 1996 contributions are subject to a
  vesting schedule under which each annual contribution begins to vest after
  three years and is fully vested after five years. Total expense for the
  plan amounted to $461,000, $213,000 and $186,000 in 1999, 1998 and 1997,
  respectively.

10. Lease Commitments

   The Exchange has commitments under operating and capital leases for certain
facilities and equipment. Lease commitments for office space expire in the year
2003, with annual minimum rentals of approximately $7.9 million. The Exchange
leases trading facilities from the Chicago Mercantile Exchange Trust through
October 2005, with annual minimum rentals of approximately $1.3 million, and
has an option to extend the term of the lease thereafter. Total rental expense
was approximately $15.1 million in 1999, $18.0 million in 1998 and $18.9
million in 1997.

                                      F-14
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)


   Future minimum obligations under lease commitments in effect at December 31,
1999, were as follows (dollars in thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           Capitalized Operating
                                                             Leases     Leases
                                                           ----------- ---------
      <S>                                                  <C>         <C>
      2000................................................   $ 4,037    $10,097
      2001................................................     3,856     10,008
      2002................................................     3,021      9,737
      2003................................................     2,051      9,110
      2004................................................       --       1,557
      Thereafter..........................................       --       1,124
                                                             -------    -------
          Total minimum lease payments....................    12,965     41,633
      Less sublease commitments...........................       --      (1,256)
      Less amount representing interest...................    (1,571)       --
                                                             -------    -------
          Total...........................................   $11,394    $40,377
                                                             =======    =======
</TABLE>

11. Long-Term Debt

   Long-term debt consists of the long-term portion of capitalized lease
obligations.

12. Credit Facility

   At December 31, 1999 and 1998, the Exchange had an unsecured committed line
of credit with a consortium of banks in the amount of $350 million. Interest on
amounts borrowed is calculated at the then-prevailing prime rate. The facility,
which originated in 1988 and has never been used, may be utilized if there is a
temporary problem with the domestic payments system that would delay payments
of settlement variation between the Exchange and its clearing members, or in
the event of a clearing member default. Commitment fees for this facility were
$516,000, $570,000 and $494,000 for the years ended December 31, 1999, 1998 and
1997, respectively.

13. Contingencies

   At December 31, 1999, the Exchange was contingently liable on irrevocable
letters of credit totaling $33 million in connection with its mutual offset
agreement with the Singapore Exchange Derivatives Trading Ltd. (formerly SIMEX)
and $2.5 million in connection with activities of GFX Corporation. The Exchange
is a defendant in, and is threatened with, various legal proceedings arising
from its regular business activities. While the ultimate results of such
proceedings against the Exchange cannot be predicted with certainty, management
of the Exchange believes that the resolution of these matters will not have a
material adverse effect on its consolidated financial position or results of
operations.

14. GFX Derivative Transactions

   GFX Corporation engages in the purchase and sale of CME foreign currency
futures contracts. GFX posts bids and offers in these products on the
GLOBEX\\2\\ electronic trading system in order to maintain a market and promote
liquidity in the CME's currency futures products. It limits risk from these
transactions through offsetting arbitrage transactions using futures contracts
or spot foreign currency transactions with approved counterparties in the
interbank market. Formal trading limits have been established. Futures
transactions are cleared by an independent clearing member. Any residual open
positions are marked to market on a daily basis, and all realized and
unrealized gains (losses) are included in other revenue in the accompanying
consolidated statements of income. Net trading gains amounted to $2,392,000 in
1999, $4,786,000 in 1998 and $2,173,000 in 1997.

                                      F-15
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)



15. Segment Reporting

   The Exchange has three reportable operating segments: the Chicago Mercantile
Exchange ("CME", a designated contract market and clearing house), GFX
Corporation ("GFX", a wholly owned trading subsidiary), and PMT Limited
Partnership ("PMT", a limited partnership which operates the GLOBEX\\2\\
electronic trading system). A summary by business segment follows (dollars in
thousands):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                  CME     GFX      PMT    Eliminations  Total
                                -------- ------  -------  ------------ --------
<S>                             <C>      <C>     <C>      <C>          <C>
Year Ended December 31, 1999
  Total revenues from external
   customers................... $178,792 $2,392  $18,213    $    --    $199,397
  Intersegment revenues........   15,173  1,190      --      (16,363)       --
  Investment income............    8,750    310       31         --       9,091
  Depreciation and
   amortization................   25,141    133      --          --      25,274
  Operating profit (loss)......    4,236   (675)   2,578         505      6,644
  Total assets.................  298,385  7,990    3,761      (8,433)   301,703
  Capital expenditures.........   37,438     42      --          --      37,480
Year Ended December 31, 1998
  Total revenues from external
   customers................... $170,136 $4,786  $10,177    $    --    $185,099
  Intersegment revenues........    5,441    --       --       (5,441)       --
  Investment income............    9,803    314      --          --      10,117
  Depreciation and
   amortization................   17,849     94       15         (15)    17,943
  Operating profit (loss)......   10,218  1,620    3,570      (1,215)    14,193
  Total assets.................  292,298  8,663    1,803      (9,559)   293,205
  Capital expenditures.........   18,809      8      --          --      18,817
Year Ended December 31, 1997
  Total revenues from external
   customers................... $161,746 $2,173  $ 5,547    $    --    $169,466
  Intersegment revenues........    3,542    --       --       (3,542)       --
  Investment income............    7,860    318      --          --       8,178
  Depreciation and
   amortization................   16,031    595       66          (3)    16,689
  Operating profit (loss)......   19,930      1     (872)         (1)    19,058
  Total assets.................  328,436  6,856    1,409      (7,970)   328,731
  Capital expenditures.........   14,320     26      --          --      14,346
</TABLE>

16. Discontinued Operations

   In September 1997, the operations of CME-DTC were discontinued. Accordingly,
the results of its operations and its net assets are included in the
consolidated financial statements as discontinued operations. Certain costs
associated with the start-up of CME-DTC were capitalized and were being
amortized over a thirty-six month period. Remaining deferred charges and
capitalized software license fees of approximately $1.8 million were written-
off in 1997.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         1997
                                                                      ----------
                                                                       (dollars
                                                                          in
                                                                      thousands)
      <S>                                                             <C>
      Revenues of discontinued operations............................  $   --
      Expenses of discontinued operations............................   (3,856)
      Income tax benefit.............................................    1,542
                                                                       -------
      Loss from operations...........................................   (2,314)
      Loss from discontinuance, net of income tax benefit of $743....   (1,114)
                                                                       -------
      Total loss from discontinued operations........................  $(3,428)
                                                                       =======
</TABLE>


                                      F-16
<PAGE>

                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE AND SUBSIDIARIES

            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(Continued)

17. Demutualization Plan

   On October 27, 1999, the Board of Directors approved a plan for
demutualization of the Chicago Mercantile Exchange whereby the Exchange would
be converted from an Illinois not-for-profit corporation into a Delaware for-
profit corporation. Under this plan, membership interests in the Exchange would
be converted into shares of Class B common stock, and in the cases of the CME,
IMM and IOM membership interests, shares of Class A common stock. Class B
shares would be issued in several series, each of which would contain the
traditional features of common stock and would confer the trading privileges
associated with the membership interest that was converted into such shares.
Class A shares would represent traditional common stock. Completion of the
demutualization transaction is subject to the affirmative vote of at least two-
thirds of membership votes present and voting, receipt of a favorable ruling
from the Internal Revenue Service regarding the federal income tax consequences
of the contemplated transactions, completion of the cash purchase by the
Exchange of the assets and business of PMT Limited Partnership (which requires
the approval of the holders of two-thirds of the Class A partnership units of
the Partnership), and approval by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission of
certain changes to Exchange rules to reflect the demutualization.

18. Subsequent Event

   During January 2000, the Exchange entered into an employment agreement with
James J. McNulty to serve as its President and Chief Executive Officer from
February 7, 2000, through December 31, 2003. Mr. McNulty was granted an option
to purchase up to 2.5% of the stock of the Exchange at a price equal to 2.5% of
the aggregate value of the Exchange memberships, as defined, and an option to
purchase up to an additional 2.5% of the stock of the Exchange at a price equal
to 3.75% of the aggregate value of the Exchange memberships. These options vest
40% after one year and an additional 20% after each of the succeeding three
years, and are exercisable for a period of ten years. In the event that the
Exchange does not demutualize, Mr. McNulty will be entitled to a cash payment
based on the increase in the value of Exchange memberships on the exercise date
over the value of Exchange memberships on the grant date in an amount similar
to that described above.

                                      F-17
<PAGE>

                                                                       EXHIBIT A

                             AMENDED AND RESTATED

                         CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION

                                      OF

                       Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.

     ARTICLE ONE:  The name of the corporation is CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE
INC.

     ARTICLE TWO: The address of the corporation's registered office in the
State of Delaware is 1209 Orange Street, City of Wilmington, County of New
Castle, Delaware 19801. The name of the Corporation's registered agent at such
address is The Corporation Trust Company.

     ARTICLE THREE:  The purpose of the corporation shall be to engage in any
lawful act or activity for which corporations may be organized and incorporated
under the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware.

     ARTICLE FOUR: The total number of shares of all classes of capital stock
which the corporation is authorized to issue is 110,005,332 shares which shall
be divided into three classes as follows:

          10,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock having a par value of $0.01 per
          share (the "Preferred Stock"),

          100,000,000 shares of Class A Common Stock having a par value of $0.01
          per share (the "Class A Common Stock"), and

          5,332 shares of Class B Common Stock having a par value of $0.01 per
          share (the "Class B Common Stock").

The term "Common Stock" shall mean both the Class A Common Stock and the Class B
Common Stock.

     The designations, voting powers, optional or other special rights and the
qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, of the above classes shall
be as follows:

                                  Division A
                                Preferred Stock

     The rights, preferences and privileges and qualifications, limitations and
restrictions granted to and imposed on the shares of Preferred Stock of the
corporation shall be as set forth below in this Division A.


                                      A-1
<PAGE>

     Shares of Preferred Stock may be issued in one or more series at such time
or times, and for such consideration or considerations, as the Board of
Directors shall determine.  The Board of Directors is hereby authorized to fix,
state and establish, in the resolution or resolutions providing for the issuance
of any wholly unissued series of Preferred Stock, the relative powers, rights,
designations, preferences, qualifications, limitations and restrictions of such
series in relation to any other series of Preferred Stock at the time
outstanding.  The Board of Directors is also expressly authorized to fix the
number of shares of each such series, but not below the number of shares thereof
then outstanding.  The authority of the Board of Directors with respect to each
series of Preferred Stock shall include (without limitation) the determination
of the following:

          (a)  the dividend rate on the shares of such series, whether dividends
     shall be cumulative, and, if so, from which date or dates, and the rights
     of priority, if any, with respect to the payment of dividends on the shares
     of such series relative to other series of Preferred Stock or classes of
     stock;

          (b)  whether the shares of such series shall have voting rights (other
     than the voting rights provided by law) and, if so, the terms and extent of
     such voting rights;

          (c)  whether the shares of such series shall have conversion
     privileges, and, if so, the terms and conditions of such conversion,
     including provision for adjustment of the conversion rate upon the
     occurrence of such events as the Board of Directors may prescribe;

          (d)  whether the shares of such series shall be subject to redemption
     by the corporation or at the request of the holder(s) thereof, and, if so,
     the terms and conditions of any such redemption;

          (e)  the rights of the shares of such series in the event of voluntary
     or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the corporation,
     and the rights of priority, if any, with respect to the distribution of
     assets on the shares of such series relative to other series of Preferred
     Stock or classes of stock; and

          (f)  any other preferences, privileges and powers, and relative,
     participating, optional or other special rights, and qualifications,
     limitations or restrictions of such series, as the Board of Directors may
     deem advisable and as shall not be inconsistent with the provisions of this
     Certificate of Incorporation, as the same may be amended from time to time.

                                      A-2
<PAGE>

                                  Division B
                                 Common Stock

                      Subdivision 1:  General Provisions

          (1)  Definitions.  In addition to the terms defined elsewhere, the
     following terms shall have the respective meanings set forth below:

               "Additional Common Shares" shall mean all shares of Class A
          Common Stock issued (or, pursuant to Section 6(b), deemed to be
          issued) by the corporation after the Effectiveness Date, other than
          shares of Class A Common Stock issued or issuable at any time:

                    (A)  to officers, directors and employees of, and
               consultants to, the corporation;

                    (B)  as a dividend or distribution on shares of the Class B
               Common Stock;

                    (C)  pursuant to the conversion of shares of the Series B-5
               Stock; or

                    (D)  by way of dividend or other distribution on Common
               Stock excluded from the definition of Additional Common Shares by
               the foregoing clauses (A), (B), (C) or this clause (D).

               "Applicable Equivalent Amount" means (i) with respect to shares
          of Class A Common Stock, one, (ii) with respect to shares of Series B-
          1 Stock, 1,800 (as adjusted from time to time in accordance with the
          provisions of Section 6 of this Division), (iii) with respect to
          shares of Series B-2 Stock, 1,200 (as adjusted from time to time in
          accordance with the provisions of Section 6 of this Division), (iv)
          with respect to shares of Series B-3 Stock, 600 (as adjusted from time
          to time in accordance with the provisions of Section 6 of this
          Division), (v) with respect to shares of Series B-4 Stock, 100 (as
          adjusted from time to time in accordance with the provisions of
          Section 6 of this Division), and (vi) with respect to shares of Series
          B-5 Stock, 10 (as adjusted from time to time in accordance with the
          provisions of Section 6 of this Division).  For purposes of Section 6,
          the term "Applicable Equivalent Amount" shall not include clause (i)
          of the preceding sentence, since no adjustment is to be made under
          that Section in respect of the Applicable Equivalent Amount for shares
          of Class A Common Stock.

               "Commitment to Maintain Floor Trading" shall mean the
          corporation's obligation, (i) as long as an open outcry market is
          "liquid," to maintain for such open outcry market a facility for
          conducting business, for the dissemination of price information, for
          clearing and delivery and (ii) to provide reasonable

                                      A-3
<PAGE>

          financial support (consistent with the calendar year 1999 budget
          levels established by Chicago Mercantile Exchange, an Illinois
          not-for-profit corporation) for technology, marketing and research for
          open outcry markets. If an open outcry market is not liquid, as
          determined by the Board of Directors, the Board may determine, in its
          sole discretion, whether such obligations will continue, and for how
          long, in respect of such market. For purposes of the foregoing, an
          open outcry market will be deemed "liquid" if it meets any of the
          following tests on a quarterly basis:

                    (1)  if a comparable exchange-traded product exists, the
               open outcry market has maintained at least 30 percent of the
               average daily volume of such comparable product (including for
               calculation purposes, volume from Exchange-For-Physicals
               transactions in such open outcry market); or

                    (2)  if a comparable exchange-traded product exists and the
               product trades exclusively by open outcry, the open outcry market
               has maintained at least 30 percent of the open interest of such
               comparable product; or

                    (3)  if no comparable exchange-traded product exists, the
               open outcry market has maintained at least 40 percent of the
               average quarterly volume in that market as maintained by Chicago
               Mercantile Exchange, an Illinois not-for-profit corporation, in
               1999 (including, for calculation purposes, volume from Exchange-
               For-Physicals transactions in such open outcry market); or

                    (4)  if no comparable exchange-traded product exists and the
               product trades exclusively by open outcry, the open outcry market
               has maintained at least 40 percent of the average open interest
               in that market as maintained by Chicago Mercantile Exchange, an
               Illinois not-for-profit corporation, in 1999.

               "Convertible Securities" shall mean any evidences of
          indebtedness, shares or other securities convertible into or
          exchangeable for shares of Class A Common Stock.

               "Core Rights" shall mean:

                    (1)  the divisional product allocation rules applicable to
               each series of Class B Common Stock as set forth in the rules of
               the corporation;

                    (2)  the trading floor access rights and privileges granted
               to each series of Class B Common Stock, including the Commitment
               to Maintain Floor Trading;


                                      A-4
<PAGE>

                    (3)  the number of authorized and issued shares of any
               series of Class B Common Stock; or

                    (4)  eligibility requirements for an individual or entity to
               hold shares of any series of Class B Common Stock or to exercise
               any of the trading rights or privileges inherent in any series of
               Class B Common Stock.

               "Effectiveness Date" means the date of acceptance by the Delaware
          Secretary of State of the filing of this Amended and Restated
          Certificate.

               "Fair Market Value" means (i) if shares of Class A Common Stock
          are traded on a national securities exchange, the last sales or the
          average of the bid and asked prices (if no sale has taken place), as
          reported in the principal consolidated transaction reporting system
          with respect to such exchange, (ii) if shares of Class A Common Stock
          are not listed or admitted to trading on any national securities
          exchange, the last quoted price or, if not so quoted, the average of
          the high bid and low asked prices in the over-the-counter market, as
          reported by the National Association of Securities Dealers Automated
          Quotation System or such other system then in use, or (iii) if neither
          clause (i) or (ii) apply, as determined in good faith by the Board of
          Directors.

               "Options" shall mean rights, options or warrants to subscribe
          for, purchase or otherwise acquire either shares of Class A Common
          Stock or Convertible Securities.

               "Share Equivalent Basis" means that (i) with respect to
          participation in dividends, other distributions or liquidating
          distributions, a stockholder's participation therein is determined
          based upon the number of Class A Common Stock share equivalents that
          such stockholder's shares represent in relation to the total number of
          Class A Common Stock share equivalents that all stockholders' shares
          represent, and (ii) with respect to voting, a stockholder's aggregate
          votes available to be cast is determined based on the number of Class
          A Common Stock share equivalents that such stockholder's shares
          represent (with each whole share equivalent representing one vote and
          each fractional share equivalent representing an equivalent fractional
          vote).  The number of Class A Common Stock share equivalents of a
          share of Class A Common Stock, Series B-1 Stock, Series B-2 Stock,
          Series B-3 Stock, Series B-4 Stock and Series B-5 Stock shall equal
          the Applicable Equivalent Amount for such stock.

          (2)  Liquidation Rights.  Upon the liquidation, dissolution or winding
     up of the corporation, holders of Common Stock shall be entitled to receive
     any amounts available for distribution to holders of Common Stock after the
     payment of, or provision for, obligations of the corporation and any
     preferential amounts payable to holders of any outstanding shares of
     Preferred Stock.  Such amounts as are available to the holders of

                                      A-5
<PAGE>

     Common Stock for distribution shall be distributed to such holders on a
     Share Equivalent Basis.

                     Subdivision 2:  Class A Common Stock

     The rights, preferences and privileges, and qualifications, limitations and
restrictions granted to and imposed on the shares of Class A Common Stock of the
corporation shall be as set forth in Subdivision 1 and this Subdivision 2 of
this Division B.

          (1)  Dividend Rights.  Subject to any preferential or participatory
     rights of holders of any shares of Preferred Stock, the holders of shares
     of Class A Common Stock shall be entitled to receive, when, as and if
     declared by the Board of Directors, out of any assets of the corporation
     legally available therefor, such dividends as may be declared from time to
     time by the Board of Directors on shares of the outstanding Common Stock of
     the corporation, participating with the holders of the outstanding shares
     of the Class B Common Stock on a Share Equivalent Basis.

          (2)  Voting Rights.  Each holder of shares of Class A Common Stock
     shall have the right to one vote for each share held on each matter for
     which the vote of the holders of the Class A Common Stock shall be required
     or considered to be necessary.  Each holder of Class A Common Stock shall
     have the right, voting with the holders of the Class B Common Stock on a
     Share Equivalent Basis, to vote in the election of the Equity Directors (as
     defined below).

          (3)  Transfer Restrictions.  Shares of Class A Common Stock shall be
     subject to the following transfer restrictions during the indicated period:

               (a)  During the period commencing on the Effectiveness Date and
          ending on the date occurring 180 days thereafter (inclusive), shares
          of Class A Common Stock may only be transferred, conveyed, sold or
          otherwise disposed together with the associated shares of Class B
          Common Stock (i.e., 16,200 shares of Class A Common Stock may be
          transferred with one share of Series B-1 Stock, 10,800 shares of Class
          A Common Stock may be transferred with one share of Series B-2 Stock,
          and 5,400 shares of Class A Common Stock may be transferred with one
          share of Series B-3 Stock).

               (b)  During the period commencing on the 181st day after the
          Effectiveness Date and ending on the date occurring 270 days after the
          Effectiveness Date, up to twenty-five percent (25%) of the shares of
          Class A Common Stock received by a holder on the Effectiveness Date or
          thereafter acquired may be transferred, conveyed, sold or otherwise
          disposed.  In addition, such holder may transfer, convey, sell or
          otherwise dispose of such holder's Class A Common Stock as described
          in clause (a) of this Section 3.

               (c)  During the period commencing on the 271st day after the
          Effectiveness Date and ending on the date occurring 360 days after the
          Effectiveness Date, up to fifty percent (50%) of the shares of Class A
          Common

                                      A-6
<PAGE>


          Stock received by a holder on the Effectiveness Date or thereafter
          acquired may be transferred, conveyed, sold or otherwise disposed. In
          addition, such holder may transfer, convey, sell or otherwise dispose
          of such holder's Class A Common Stock as described in clause (a) of
          this Section 3.

               (d)  During the period commencing on the 361st day after the
          Effectiveness Date and ending on the date occurring 450 days after the
          Effectiveness Date, up to seventy-five percent (75%) of the shares of
          Class A Common Stock received by a holder on the Effectiveness Date or
          thereafter acquired may be transferred, conveyed, sold or otherwise
          disposed.  In addition, such holder may transfer, convey, sell or
          otherwise dispose of such holder's Class A Common Stock as described
          in clause (a) of this Section 3.

               (e)  On and after the 451st day after the Effectiveness Date,
          there shall be no restrictions applicable to the Class A Common Stock
          under this Section 3.


                     Subdivision 3:  Class B Common Stock

     The rights, preferences and privileges, and qualifications, limitations and
restrictions granted to and imposed on the shares of Class B Common Stock of the
corporation shall be as set forth in Subdivision 1 and this Subdivision 3 of
this Division B.

          (1)  Designation and Number of Shares Constituting Series. Shares of
     the Class B Common Stock shall be issued in five series having the
     designations and consisting of the number of shares set forth below:

               625 shares designated as "Class B Common Stock, Series B-1" (the
               "Series B-1 Stock"),

               813 shares designated as "Class B Common Stock, Series B-2" (the
               "Series B-2 Stock"),

               1,287 shares designated as "Class B Common Stock, Series B-3"
               (the "Series B-3 Stock"),

               467 shares designated as "Class B Common Stock, Series B-4" (the
               "Series B-4 Stock") and

               2,140 shares designated as "Class B Common Stock, Series B-5"
               (the "Series B-5 Stock").

          (2)  Trading Rights.

               (a)  Series B-1 Stock. The holders of shares of the Series B-1
          Stock shall have the trading rights, including trading floor access
          rights and privileges, set forth in the corporation's by-laws and
          rules for its Chicago Mercantile Exchange Division Members.

                                      A-7
<PAGE>

               (b)  Series B-2 Stock. The holders of shares of the Series B-2
          Stock shall have the trading rights, including trading floor access
          rights and privileges, set forth in the corporation's by-laws and
          rules for its International Monetary Market Division Members.

               (c)  Series B-3 Stock. The holders of shares of the Series B-3
          Stock shall have the trading rights, including trading floor access
          rights and privileges, set forth in the corporation's by-laws and
          rules for its Index and Option Market Division Members.

               (d)  Series B-4 Stock. The holders of shares of the Series B-4
          Stock shall have the trading rights, including trading floor access
          rights and privileges, set forth in the corporation's by-laws and
          rules for its Growth and Emerging Markets Division Members.

               (e)  Series B-5 Stock. The holders of shares of the Series B-5
          Stock shall have the trading rights, including trading floor access
          rights and privileges, set forth in the corporation's by-laws and
          rules for holders of fractional interests in its Growth and Emerging
          Markets Division.

          (3)  Dividend Rights. Subject to any preferential or participatory
     rights of holders of any shares of Preferred Stock, the holders of shares
     of Class B Common Stock shall be entitled to receive, when, as and if
     declared by the Board of Directors, out of any assets of the corporation
     legally available therefor, such dividends as may be declared from time to
     time by the Board of Directors on shares of the outstanding Common Stock of
     the corporation, participating with the holders of the outstanding shares
     of the Class A Common Stock on a Share Equivalent Basis.

          (4)  Voting Rights. Holders of shares of Class B Common Stock shall
     have the following voting rights:

               (a)  Election of Directors.

                    (i)   Class B Directors. Holders of shares of Series B-1
               Stock shall have the sole right to elect the Series B-1 Directors
               (as defined below), and each holder of Series B-1 Stock shall
               have one vote per share held in any such election. Holders of
               shares of Series B-2 Stock shall have the sole right to elect the
               Series B-2 Directors (as defined below), and each holder of
               Series B-2 Stock shall have one vote per share held in any such
               election. Holders of shares of Series B-3 Stock shall have the
               sole right to elect the Series B-3 Director (as defined below),
               and each holder of Series B-3 Stock shall have one vote per share
               held in any such election.

                    (ii)  Equity Directors. Each holder of Class B Common Stock
               shall have the right, voting with the holders of the Class A
               Common Stock

                                      A-8
<PAGE>

               on a Share Equivalent Basis, to vote in the election of the
               Equity Directors.

               (b)  Core Rights.  Any change, amendment or modification of the
          Core Rights shall be submitted to a vote of the holders of the Class B
          Common Stock for their consideration and approval.  In any such vote,
          holders of Series B-1 Stock shall be entitled to six votes for each
          share of Series B-1 Stock held, holders of Series B-2 Stock shall be
          entitled to two votes for each share of Series B-2 Stock held, holders
          of Series B-3 Stock shall be entitled to one vote for each share of
          Series B-3 Stock held, holders of Series B-4 Stock shall be entitled
          to one-sixth vote for each share of Series B-4 Stock held and holders
          of Series B-5 Stock shall be entitled to one-sixtieth vote for each
          share of Series B-5 Stock held.  Any such change, amendment or
          modification must receive a majority of the aggregate votes cast by
          the holders of the Class B Common Stock present (in person or by
          proxy) and voting in order to be approved.

               (c)  Other Matters. Holders of shares of Class B Common Stock
          shall be entitled to vote on a Share Equivalent Basis on any matters
          not described in Sections 4(a) or (b) that require the approval of the
          holders of the Class B Common Stock, whether voting together with the
          holders of the Class A Common Stock or voting separately as a class.

          (5)  Transfer Restrictions.  Shares of Class B Common Stock may be
     transferred at any time, subject to the following restrictions:

               (a)  No individual or entity may exercise any of the trading
          rights in respect of a series of Class B Common Stock unless such
          individual or entity (i) satisfies the trading eligibility
          requirements specified for such series in the by-laws of the
          corporation and in any rules or regulations as the Board of Directors
          may provide and (ii) agrees to be bound by any rules or regulations as
          the Board of Directors may provide with respect to such series of
          Class B Common Stock.

               (b)  No lease of the trading privilege component of any series of
          Class B Common Stock shall be valid and binding on the corporation
          unless and until (x) the lessee satisfies the trading eligibility
          requirements specified for such shares in the by-laws of the
          corporation and in any other rules or regulations as the Board of
          Directors may provide, and (y) such lease has been reported to the
          corporation.

               (c)  No person who has sold a share of any series of Class B
          Common Stock shall be eligible to purchase another share of the same
          series of Class B common stock within six months of the closing of
          such sale, except as may be otherwise allowed under rules adopted by
          the Board of Directors.

                                      A-9
<PAGE>

          (6)  Adjustments to Applicable Equivalent Amounts For Dilutive Issues.


               (a)  No Adjustment Unless Economic Dilution. No adjustment in the
          Applicable Equivalent Amount of any series of Class B Common Stock
          shall be made in respect of the issuance or deemed issuance of
          Additional Common Shares unless the consideration per share for an
          Additional Common Share issued or deemed to be issued by the
          corporation is less than the Fair Market Value of a share of Class A
          Common Stock on the date of such issue or deemed issue.

               (b)  Deemed Issue of Additional Common Shares.

                    (1)  Options and Convertible Securities. In the event the
               corporation, at any time or from time to time after the
               Effectiveness Date, shall issue any Options or Convertible
               Securities or shall fix a record date for the determination of
               holders of any class of securities entitled to receive any such
               Options or Convertible Securities, then the maximum number of
               shares of Class A Common Stock (as set forth in the instrument
               relating thereto without regard to any provisions contained
               therein for a subsequent adjustment of such number) issuable upon
               the exercise of such Options or, in the case of Convertible
               Securities and Options therefor, the conversion or exchange of
               such Convertible Securities, shall be deemed to be Additional
               Common Shares (except as otherwise provided in the definition
               thereof) issued as of the time of such issue or, in case such a
               record date shall have been fixed, as of the close of business on
               such record date, provided that in any such case in which
               Additional Common Shares are deemed to be issued:

                         (A)  no further adjustment in the Applicable Equivalent
                    Amounts shall be made upon the subsequent issue of
                    Convertible Securities or shares of Class A Common Stock
                    upon the exercise of such Options or conversion or exchange
                    of such Convertible Securities;

                         (B)  if such Options or Convertible Securities by their
                    terms provide, with the passage of time or otherwise, for
                    any increase or decrease in the consideration payable to the
                    corporation, or in the number of shares of Class A Common
                    Stock issuable upon the exercise, conversion or exchange
                    thereof, the Applicable Equivalent Amounts computed upon the
                    original issue thereof (or upon the occurrence of a record
                    date with respect thereto), and any subsequent adjustments
                    based thereon, shall, upon any such increase or decrease
                    becoming effective, be recomputed to reflect such increase
                    or decrease insofar as it affects such Options or the rights
                    of conversion or exchange under such Convertible Securities;

                                      A-10
<PAGE>

                         (C)  upon the expiration of any such Options or any
                    rights of conversion or exchange under such Convertible
                    Securities which shall not have been exercised, the
                    Applicable Equivalent Amounts computed upon the original
                    issue thereof (or upon the occurrence of a record date with
                    respect thereto), and any subsequent adjustments based
                    thereon, shall, upon such expiration, be recomputed as if:

                              (I)  in the case of Convertible Securities or
                         Options for Class A Common Stock, the only Additional
                         Common Shares issued were shares of Class A Common
                         Stock, if any, actually issued upon the exercise of
                         such Options or the conversion or exchange of such
                         Convertible Securities and the consideration received
                         therefor was the consideration actually received by the
                         corporation for the issue of all such Options, whether
                         or not exercised, plus the consideration actually
                         received by the corporation upon such exercise, or for
                         the issue of all such Convertible Securities which were
                         actually converted or exchanged, plus the additional
                         consideration, if any, actually received by the
                         corporation upon such conversion or exchange, and

                              (II) in the case of Options for Convertible
                         Securities, the only Convertible Securities issued were
                         Convertible Securities, if any, actually issued upon
                         the exercise of such Options, and the consideration
                         received by the corporation for the Additional Common
                         Shares deemed to have been issued was the consideration
                         actually received by the corporation for the issue of
                         all such Options, whether or not exercised, plus the
                         consideration actually received by the corporation upon
                         the issue of the Convertible Securities with respect to
                         which such Options were actually exercised;

                         (D)  no readjustment pursuant to clause (B) or (C)
                    above shall have the effect of reducing any Applicable
                    Equivalent Amount to an amount which is less than the higher
                    of (i) the such Applicable Equivalent Amount on the original
                    adjustment date, or (ii) the Applicable Equivalent Amount
                    that would have resulted from any issuance of Additional
                    Common Shares between the original adjustment date and such
                    readjustment for which no adjustment was originally made;
                    and

                         (E)  in the case of any Options, which expire by their
                    terms not more than 60 days after the date of issue thereof,
                    no

                                      A-11
<PAGE>

                    adjustment of the Applicable Equivalent Amount shall be made
                    until the expiration or exercise of all such Options.

                    (2)  Stock Dividends. In the event the corporation, at any
               time or from time to time after the Effectiveness Date, shall
               declare or pay any dividend on shares of its capital stock
               payable in shares of Class A Common Stock, then and in any such
               event, Additional Common Shares (except as otherwise provided in
               the definition thereof) shall be deemed to have been issued
               immediately after the close of business on the record date for
               the determination of holders of any class of securities entitled
               to receive such dividend for purposes of adjusting the Applicable
               Equivalent Amounts; provided, however, that if such record date
               is fixed and such dividend is not fully paid, the only Additional
               Common Shares deemed to have been issued will be the number of
               shares of Class A Common Stock actually issued in such dividend,
               and such shares will be deemed to have been issued as of the
               close of business on such record date, and such Applicable
               Equivalent Amounts shall be recomputed accordingly.

               (c)  Adjustment of Applicable Equivalent Amounts Upon Issuance of
          Additional Common Shares. In the event the corporation shall issue
          Additional Common Shares (including Additional Common Shares deemed to
          be issued pursuant to Section 6(b)) without consideration or for a
          consideration per share less than the Fair Market Value of a share of
          Class A Common Stock in effect immediately prior to such issue, then
          and in such event, the Applicable Equivalent Amounts shall be
          increased, concurrently with such issue, to amounts (calculated to the
          nearest one-tenth of a share) determined by multiplying each
          Applicable Equivalent Amount by a fraction, the numerator of which
          shall be the number of shares of Class A Common Stock outstanding
          immediately prior to such issue plus the number of such Additional
          Common Shares so issued and the denominator of which shall be the
          number of shares of Class A Common Stock outstanding immediately prior
          to such issue plus the number of shares of Class A Common Stock which
          the aggregate consideration received by the corporation for the total
          number of Additional Common Shares so issued would purchase at such
          Fair Market Value; provided that, for the purposes of this subsection
          (c), all shares of Class A Common Stock issuable upon exercise of
          outstanding Options, and conversion of outstanding Convertible
          Securities shall be deemed to be outstanding.

               (d)  Determination of Consideration. For purposes of this
          Section, the consideration received by the corporation for the issue
          of any Additional Common Shares shall be computed as follows:

                    (1)  Cash and Property.  Such consideration shall:

                                      A-12
<PAGE>

                         (A)  insofar as it consists of cash, be computed at the
                    aggregate amount of cash received by the corporation
                    excluding amounts paid or payable for accrued interest or
                    accrued dividends;

                         (B)  insofar as it consists of property other than
                    cash, be computed at the fair value thereof at the time of
                    such issue, as determined in good faith by the Board of
                    Directors; and

                         (C)  in the event Additional Common Shares are issued
                    together with other shares or securities or other assets of
                    the corporation for the consideration so received, be
                    computed as provided in clauses (A) and (B) above, as
                    determined in good faith by the Board of Directors.

                    (2)  Options and Convertible Securities. The consideration
               per share received by the corporation for Additional Common
               Shares deemed to have been issued pursuant to Section 6(b)(1),
               relating to Options and Convertible Securities, shall be
               determined by dividing:

                         (A)  the total amount, if any, received or receivable
                    by the corporation as consideration for the issue of such
                    Options or Convertible Securities, plus the minimum
                    aggregate amount of additional consideration (as set forth
                    in the instruments relating thereto, without regard to any
                    provision contained therein for a subsequent adjustment of
                    such consideration) payable to the corporation upon the
                    exercise of such Options or the conversion or exchange of
                    such Convertible Securities, or in the case of Options for
                    Convertible Securities, the exercise of such options for
                    Convertible Securities and the conversion or exchange of
                    such Convertible Securities, by

                         (B)  the maximum number of shares of Class A Common
                    Stock (as set forth in the instruments relating thereto,
                    without regard to any provision contained therein for a
                    subsequent adjustment of such number) issuable upon the
                    exercise of such Options or the conversion or exchange of
                    such Convertible Securities.

                    (3)  Stock Dividends. Any Additional Common Shares deemed to
             have been issued relating to stock dividends shall be deemed to
             have been issued for no consideration.

          In the event that Additional Common Shares are proposed to be issued
          in connection with an acquisition or other transaction subject to
          certain conditions precedent, such that there will be a delay between
          the execution of the associated agreement and the consummation of the
          acquisition or transaction and the

                                      A-13
<PAGE>

          issuance of the Additional Common Shares, the value of the
          consideration to be received per share shall be compared to the Fair
          Market Value of a share of Class A Common Stock as of the date of
          execution of the associated agreement for the purposed of calculating
          any adjustments under this Section 6.

               (e)  Adjustments for Subdivisions, Combinations or Consolidation
          of Common Stock. In the event the outstanding Class A Common Stock
          shall be subdivided (by stock split or otherwise) into a greater
          number of shares of Class A Common Stock, the Applicable Equivalent
          Amounts then in effect shall, concurrently with the effectiveness of
          such subdivision, be proportionately increased. In the event the
          outstanding Class A Common Stock shall be combined or consolidated (by
          reclassification or otherwise) into a lesser number of shares of Class
          A Common Stock, the Applicable Equivalent Amounts then in effect
          shall, concurrently with the effectiveness of such combination or
          consolidation, be proportionately decreased.

               (f)  No Impairment. The corporation will not, by amendment of
          this Certificate of Incorporation or through any reorganization,
          transfer of assets, consolidation, merger, dissolution, issue or sale
          of securities or any other voluntary action, avoid or seek to avoid
          the observance or performance of any of the terms to be observed or
          performed under this Section by the corporation but will at all times
          in good faith assist in the carrying out of all the provisions of this
          Section.

          (7)  Conversion Rights of Series B-5.

               (a)  Conversion. Subject to and upon compliance with the
          provisions of this Section 7, each holder of any shares of Series B-5
          Stock shall have the right at such holder's option, at any time or
          from time to time prior to the close of business in Chicago, Illinois
          on November 3, 2000, to convert such shares of Series B-5 Stock into
          fully paid and nonassessable shares of Series B-4 Stock at the ratio
          of ten shares of Series B-5 Stock for each share of Series B-4 Stock
          to be received in conversion. Shares of Series B-5 Stock may be
          converted into Series B-4 Stock only in integral multiples of ten. No
          fractional shares of Series B-4 Stock will be issued upon conversion.

               (b)  Mechanics of Conversion. A holder of shares of Series B-5
          Stock may exercise the conversion right specified in Section 7(a) as
          to such holder's shares by surrendering to the corporation or any
          transfer agent of the corporation the certificate or certificates for
          the shares to be converted, accompanied by written notice stating that
          the holder elects to convert all of the shares represented thereby.
          Conversion shall be deemed to have been effected on the date when
          delivery of such written notice and share certificates is made, and
          such date is referred to herein as the Conversion Date. As promptly as
          practicable after the Conversion Date, the corporation shall issue and
          deliver to or upon the written order of such holder a certificate or
          certificates for the number of full shares of

                                      A-14
<PAGE>


               Series B-4 Stock to which such holder is entitled as a result of
               the exercise of such conversion right. The person in whose name
               the certificate or certificates for Series B-4 Stock are to be
               issued shall be deemed to have become a holder of record of such
               Series B-4 Stock on the applicable Conversion Date. After the
               initial issuance of shares of Series B-4 Stock on the
               Effectiveness Date pursuant to the recapitalization contemplated
               by Subdivision 4 of this Article, shares of Series B-4 Stock may
               only be issued upon the conversion pursuant to this Section 7 of
               shares of Series B-5 Stock.

                    (c)  Automatic Conversion. Each share of Series B-5 Stock
               shall automatically be converted into ten shares of Class A
               Common Stock on November 4, 2000.

                    (d)  Status of Converted Shares. Shares of Series B-5 Stock
               that are converted into shares of Series B-4 Stock or shares of
               Class A Common Stock shall not be reissued.

                       Subdivision 4:  Recapitalization

          Upon the filing of this Amended and Restated Certificate of
     Incorporation with the Secretary of State of Delaware:

               (1)  Each of the then outstanding shares of the corporation's CME
          Class Common Stock, $0.01 par value, authorized immediately prior to
          the effectiveness of such filing, shall be converted into (i) 16,200
          shares of Class A Common Stock, $0.01 par value, and (ii) one share of
          Class B Common Stock, Series B-1, $0.01 par value.

               (2)  Each of the then outstanding shares of the corporation's IMM
          Class Common Stock, $0.01 par value, authorized immediately prior to
          the effectiveness of such filing, shall be converted into (i) 10,800
          shares of Class A Common Stock, $0.01 par value, and (ii) one share of
          Class B Common Stock, Series B-2, $0.01 par value.

               (3)  Each of the then outstanding shares of the corporation's IOM
          Class Common Stock, $0.01 par value, authorized immediately prior to
          the effectiveness of such filing, shall be converted into (i) 5,400
          shares of Class A Common Stock, $0.01 par value, and (ii) one share of
          Class B Common Stock, Series B-3, $0.01 par value.

               (4)  Each of the then outstanding shares of the corporation's GEM
          Class Common Stock, $0.01 par value, authorized immediately prior to
          the effectiveness of such filing, shall be converted into one share of
          Class B Common Stock, Series B-4, $0.01 par value.

               (5)  Each of the then outstanding shares of the corporation's
          Fractional GEM Class Common Stock, $0.01 par value per share,
          authorized immediately prior to the effectiveness of such filing,
          shall be converted into one share of Class B Common Stock, Series B-5,
          $0.01 par value.

                                      A-15
<PAGE>

     ARTICLE FIVE:  (A)  The initial Board of Directors shall consist of thirty-
nine members.  The terms of eighteen of the directors shall expire at the annual
meeting of the stockholders held in December 2000, and the terms of the
remaining twenty-one directors shall expire at the annual meeting of the
stockholders held in December 2001.

     (B)  At the annual meeting of stockholders held in December 2000, the size
of the Board of Directors shall be reduced to thirty members and nine directors
shall be elected to serve two-year terms as follows:

          (1)  Six directors shall be elected by the holders of Common Stock
     voting together as a single class on a Share Equivalent Basis from a Board-
     nominated slate of candidates nominated in accordance with the nominating
     provisions as provided in the corporation's bylaws;

          (2)  One director shall be elected by the holders of Series B-1 Stock;

          (3)  One director shall be elected by the holders of Series B-2 Stock;
     and

          (4)  One director shall be elected by the holders of Series B-3 Stock.

     (C)  At the annual meeting of stockholders held in December 2001, the size
of the Board of Directors shall be reduced to nineteen members and ten directors
shall be elected to serve two-year terms as follows:

          (1)  Seven directors shall be elected by the holders of Common Stock
     voting together as a single class on a Share Equivalent Basis from a Board-
     nominated slate of candidates nominated in accordance with the nominating
     provisions provided in the corporation's bylaws.

          (2)  Two directors shall be elected by the holders of Series B-1
     Stock; and

          (3)  One director shall be elected by the holders of Series B-2 Stock.

The directors elected as provided in Sections (B)(1) and (C)(1) are referred to
as the "Equity Directors;" the directors elected as provided in Sections (B)(2)
and (C)(2) are referred to as the "Series B-1 Directors;" the directors elected
as provided in Sections (B)(3) and (C)(3) are referred to as the "Series B-2
Directors;" and the director elected as provided in Section (B)(4) is referred
to as the "Series B-3 Director."  The Equity Directors shall include persons
fulfilling the requirements of any regulatory authority having jurisdiction over
the corporation.

     (D)  At each succeeding annual meeting of stockholders, the successors of
the Series B-1 Directors, the Series B-2 Directors, any Series B-3 Director and
the Equity Directors whose terms expire at that meeting shall be elected by the
holders of the Series B-1 Stock, the Series B-2 Stock, the Series B-3 Stock, and
the Common Stock voting as a single class on a Share Equivalent Basis,
respectively.  The directors so elected shall be elected for a term expiring at
the annual meeting of stockholders held in the second year following the year of
their election, and

                                      A-16
<PAGE>

until their successors are duly elected and qualified and have accepted office,
subject to death, resignation or removal from office. Any vacancy occurring in a
directorship may be filled by the Board of Directors; provided, however, that
any vacancy occurring with respect to a Series B-1 Director, a Series B-2
Director or a Series B-3 Director shall be filled from the candidates who lost
for such position from the most recent election, with the candidates being
selected to fill such vacancy in the order of the aggregate number of votes
received in such previous election. Any persons so elected shall serve for the
remaining term of his or her predecessor in office.

     (E)  No person shall be eligible for election as a Series B-1 Director, a
Series B-2 Director or a Series B-3 Director unless he or she shall own, or be
recognized under rules adopted by the Board of Directors as a permitted
transferee (other than temporary lease-type transfers) of, at least one share of
the series of Class B Common Stock entitled to elect such director.

     (F)  Any director may be removed from office at any time, but only for
cause and only by the affirmative vote of the holders of at least two-thirds of
the voting power of the shares entitled to elect such person as a director under
this Article.

     ARTICLE SIX:  The Board of Directors is hereby authorized to create and
issue, whether or not in connection with the issuance and sale of any of its
stock or other securities or property, rights entitling the holders thereof to
purchase from the corporation shares of Preferred Stock, Class A Common Stock or
securities of any other corporation.  The times at which and the terms upon
which such rights are to be issued will be determined by the Board of Directors
and set forth in the contracts or instruments that evidence such rights.  The
authority of the Board of Directors with respect to such rights shall include,
without limitation, determination of the following:

          (A)  The initial purchase price per share or other unit of the stock
     or other securities or property to be purchased upon exercise of such
     rights;

          (B)  Provisions relating to the times at which and the circumstances
     under which such rights may be exercised or sold or otherwise transferred,
     either together with or separately from, any other stock or other
     securities of the corporation;

          (C)  Provisions which adjust the number or exercise price of such
     rights or amount or nature of the stock or other securities or property
     receivable upon exercise of such rights in the event of a combination,
     split or recapitalization of any stock of the corporation, a change in
     ownership of the corporation's stock or other securities or a
     reorganization, merger, consolidation, sale of assets or other occurrence
     relating to the corporation or any stock of the corporation, and provisions
     restricting the ability of the corporation to enter into any such
     transaction absent an assumption by the other party or parties thereto of
     the obligations of the corporation under such rights;

          (D)  Provisions which deny the holder of a specified percentage of the
     outstanding stock or other securities of the corporation the right to
     exercise such rights and/or cause the rights held by such holder to become
     void;

                                      A-17
<PAGE>

          (E)  Provisions which permit the corporation to redeem or to exchange
     such rights; and

          (F)  The appointment of a rights agent with respect to such rights.

     ARTICLE SEVEN:  (A)  In furtherance of and not in limitation of the powers
conferred by law, the Board of Directors is expressly authorized and empowered
to adopt, amend, or repeal the bylaws of the corporation, provided, however,
that the bylaws may also be altered, amended, or repealed by the affirmative
vote of the holders of two-thirds of the voting power of the then outstanding
Common Stock, voting together as a single class on a Share Equivalent Basis.

     (B)  Unless and except to the extent that the by-laws of the corporation
shall so require, the election of directors of the corporation need not be by
written ballot.

     ARTICLE EIGHT:   No stockholder shall have any preemptive right to
subscribe to an additional issue of any class or series of the corporation's
capital stock or to any securities of the corporation convertible into such
stock.

     ARTICLE NINE:  Notwithstanding anything contained in this Certificate of
Incorporation to the contrary, the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of
the voting power of the then outstanding Common Stock, voting together as a
single class on a Share Equivalent Basis, shall be required to amend, repeal, or
adopt any provisions inconsistent with paragraph (F) of Article Five or Articles
Six, Nine, Ten, Eleven, Twelve, Thirteen or Fourteen of this Certificate of
Incorporation.

     ARTICLE TEN:  No director of the corporation shall be personally liable to
the corporation or its stockholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary
duty as a director, except for liability (i) for any breach of the director's
duty of loyalty to the corporation or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or
omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing
violation of law, (iii) under Section 174 of the General Corporation Law of the
State of Delaware, or (iv) for any transaction from which the director derived
an improper personal benefit.  Any amendment or repeal of this Article by the
stockholders shall not adversely affect any right or protection of a director of
the corporation existing hereunder in respect of any act or omission occurring
prior to such amendment or repeal.

     ARTICLE ELEVEN:  The corporation shall, to the fullest extent permitted by
Section 145 of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, as the same
may be amended and supplemented, have the power to indemnify any and all persons
whom it shall have the power to indemnify under said Section from and against
any and all expenses, liabilities or other matters referred to in or covered by
said Section, and the power provided for herein shall not be deemed exclusive of
any other right to which those indemnified may be entitled under any bylaw,
agreement, or vote of stockholders, disinterested directors or otherwise, both
as to action in his or her official capacity and as to action in another
capacity while holding such office.

     ARTICLE TWELVE:  In furtherance and not in limitation of the powers
conferred by law or in this Certificate of Incorporation, the Board of Directors
(and any committee of the Board of Directors) is expressly authorized, to the
extent permitted by law, to take such action or actions as the Board of
Directors or such committee may determine to be reasonably necessary

                                      A-18
<PAGE>

or desirable to (A) encourage any individual, limited partnership, general
partnership, corporation or other firm or entity (a "person") to enter into
negotiations with the Board of Directors and management of the corporation with
respect to any transaction which may result in a change in control of the
corporation which is proposed or initiated by such person or (B) contest or
oppose any such transaction which the Board of Directors or such committee
determines to be unfair, abusive or otherwise undesirable with respect to the
corporation and its business, assets or properties or the stockholders of the
corporation, including, without limitation, the adoption of such plans or the
issuance of such rights, options, capital stock, notes, debentures or other
evidences of indebtedness or other securities of the corporation, which rights,
options, capital stock, notes, debentures or other evidences of indebtedness and
other securities (i) may be exchangeable for or convertible into cash or other
securities on such terms and conditions as may be determined by the Board of
Directors or such committee and (ii) may provide for the treatment of any holder
or class of holders thereof designated by the Board of Directors or any such
committee in respect of the terms, conditions, provisions and rights of such
securities which is different from, and unequal to, the terms, conditions,
provisions and rights applicable to all other holders thereof.

     ARTICLE THIRTEEN:  No action required to, or which may, be taken at an
annual or special meeting of stockholders of the corporation may be taken
without a meeting, and the power of the stockholders of the corporation to act
by written consent, whether pursuant to Section 228 of the General Corporation
Law or otherwise, is specifically denied.

     ARTICLE FOURTEEN:  Special meetings of the stockholders, for any purpose or
purposes, unless otherwise prescribed by statute or by this Certificate of
Incorporation, may be called by the Chairman of the Board, in his discretion,
and shall be called by the Chairman of the Board or the Secretary at the request
in writing of a majority of the directors then holding office. Any such written
request shall state the purpose or purposes of the proposed meeting.

                                      A-19
<PAGE>

                                                                       EXHIBIT B

                         AGREEMENT AND PLAN OF MERGER
                                      of
              Chicago Mercantile Exchange and CME Transitory Co.

     THIS AGREEMENT AND PLAN OF MERGER (the "Agreement") is made and entered
into as of April 1, 2000, between Chicago Mercantile Exchange, an Illinois not-
for-profit corporation ("CME"), and CME Transitory Co., a Delaware nonstock
corporation ("Transitory" or "Surviving Corporation"), said corporations
hereinafter sometimes referred to jointly as the "Constituent
Corporations";

                                  WITNESSETH:

     WHEREAS, CME is a not-for-profit corporation duly organized and existing
under the Illinois Act, having as its registered agent Craig S. Donohue;

     WHEREAS, Transitory is a nonstock corporation duly organized and existing
under the Delaware General Corporation Law, having as its registered agent The
Corporation Trust Company;

     WHEREAS, the Constituent Corporations propose, pursuant to the applicable
provisions of the Illinois General Not For Profit Corporation Act and the
Delaware General Corporation Law, for CME to merge with and into Transitory,
which shall be the Surviving Corporation in consideration for which Members of
CME will receive Membership Interests in Transitory (the "Merger");

     WHEREAS, all rights and privileges that Members of CME derive from their
Membership Interests shall be and remain as they exist immediately prior to the
Effective Date of this Agreement, preserved in the rights and privileges of the
Membership Interests in Transitory received by Members of CME in the Merger; and

     WHEREAS, the respective Boards of Directors of the Constituent Corporations
have determined that it is advisable that CME be merged with and into Transitory
and have approved such Merger on the terms and conditions hereinafter set forth
in accordance with the applicable provisions of law permitting such Merger;

     NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and of the agreements,
covenants and provisions hereinafter set forth, the parties hereto, intending to
be legally bound, do hereby agree as follows:

                                   ARTICLE I
                                  DEFINITIONS

     In in addition to the words defined elsewhere in this Agreement, the
following words have the following respective meanings, and such definitions
shall be equally applicable to both the singular and plural forms of any of the
words herein defined:


                                       1
<PAGE>

     "Consent" means any consent, license, permit, waiver, approval,
authorization or other action of, by or with respect to, or registration,
declaration or filing with, any court, Governmental Authority or Person.

     "DGCL" means the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, as
 amended.

     "Effective Date" means the date on which the Merger becomes effective as
provided by the applicable provisions of the Illinois Act and the DGCL.

     "Governmental Approval" means any Consent of, with or to any Governmental
Authority, including the expiration of any waiting or other time period required
to pass before governmental consent or acquiescence may be assumed or relied on.

     "Governmental Authority" means any court or governmental authority,
department, commission, board, bureau, agency or instrumentality, domestic or
foreign, any tribunal or arbitrators of competent jurisdiction and any self-
regulatory organization.

     "Illinois Act" means the Illinois' General Not For Profit Corporation Act
of 1986, as amended.

     "Member" means the owner of a Membership Interest, or any portion thereof,
in a Constituent Corporation. An owner of two or more Membership Interests, or
portions thereof, in a single Constituent Corporation shall be deemed to be a
separate Member with respect to each individual Membership Interest owned.

     "Membership Interest" means, with respect to a Constituent Corporation, all
the rights or interests of a Member in such Constituent Corporation, including,
but not limited to, any floor access and electronic trading rights, any right to
vote, any rights with regard to earnings, surplus or assets of such Constituent
Corporation, and any other rights in liquidation, merger, reorganization or
conversion of such Constituent Corporation.

     "Person" means an individual, corporation, joint venture, partnership,
association, trust, trustee, unincorporated entity, organization or government
or any department or agency thereof. A Person who owns a Membership Interest in
more than one capacity shall be deemed to be a separate Person in each such
capacity.

     "SEC" means the Securities and Exchange Commission.

     "Securities Act" means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

                                       2
<PAGE>

                                  ARTICLE II
                                    MERGER

     Section 2.1  Effect of the Merger.  Subject to the terms of this Agreement,
and as more fully set forth and supplemented by the other provisions herein,
upon the Effective Date and pursuant to the Merger:

          (a)  CME will merge with and into Transitory, the separate existence
     of CME shall cease, except to the extent provided by the laws of the State
     of Illinois in the case of a corporation after its merger into another
     corporation, and Transitory shall be the Surviving Corporation.

          (b)  Each Membership Interest in CME shall be converted into a
     Membership Interest in Transitory pursuant to and in accordance with this
     Agreement.

          (c)  The Surviving Corporation shall possess all the rights,
     privileges, immunities, powers and franchises, of a public or private
     nature, of each of the Constituent Corporations, and all property, real,
     personal and mixed, all debts due on whatever account, including
     subscriptions to membership interests and all other choses in action, and
     all and every other interest, of or belonging to or due to each of the
     Constituent Corporations, shall be taken and deemed to be transferred to
     and vested in the Surviving Corporation without further act or deed; and
     the title to all real estate, or any interest therein, vested in either of
     the Constituent Corporations shall not revert or be in any way impaired by
     reason of the Merger.

          (d)  The Surviving Corporation shall be responsible and liable for all
     of the liabilities and obligations of each of the Constituent Corporations,
     and any claim existing or action or proceeding pending by or against either
     of the Constituent Corporations may be prosecuted to judgment as if the
     Merger had not taken place, or the Surviving Corporation may be substituted
     in its place, and neither the rights of creditors nor any liens upon the
     property of either of the Constituent Corporations shall be impaired by the
     Merger.

          (e)  (i) The respective assets of CME and Transitory shall be taken up
     or continued on the books of the Surviving Corporation in the amounts at
     which such assets shall have been carried on their respective books
     immediately prior the Effective Date; and (ii) the respective liabilities
     and reserves of CME and Transitory shall be taken up or continued on the
     books of the Surviving Corporation in the amounts at which such liabilities
     and reserves shall have been carried on their respective books immediately
     prior to the Effective Date.

          (f)  All corporate acts, plans, policies, agreements, arrangements,
     approvals and authorizations of CME, its Members, Board of Directors and
     committees thereof, officers and agents, which were valid and effective
     immediately prior to the Effective Date shall be taken for all purposes as
     the acts, plans, policies, agreements, arrangements, approvals and
     authorizations of the Surviving Corporation and shall be as effective and
     binding thereon as the same were with respect to CME.

                                       3
<PAGE>

     Section 2.2  Charter and By-Laws.  The Certificate of Incorporation and By-
laws of Transitory as in effect on the Effective Date shall be and constitute
the Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws of the Surviving Corporation until
the same shall be altered, amended or changed in accordance with their
respective terms and applicable law.

     Section 2.3  Directors and Officers.  The directors and officers of CME
prior to the Effective Date shall serve as the directors and officers of the
Surviving Corporation on and after the Effective Date, until new directors and
officers have been duly elected and qualified pursuant to the Certificate of
Incorporation and By-laws of the Surviving Corporation, or until their earlier
resignation, removal or replacement.

     Section 2.4  Employees and Agents.  The employees and agents of CME shall
become the employees and agents of the Surviving Corporation and shall continue
to be entitled to the same rights and benefits which they enjoyed as employees
and agents of CME.

                                  ARTICLE III
                      CONVERSION OF MEMBERSHIP INTERESTS

     Section 3.1  Conversion of Membership Interests.  On the Effective Date,
and without any further action by CME or Transitory, all the Membership
Interests in CME shall be converted into Membership Interests in Transitory. The
Membership Interests in CME shall be converted in accordance with the following:

          (a)  Each individual Chicago Mercantile Exchange division Membership
     Interest in CME shall be converted into one Chicago Mercantile Exchange
     division Membership Interest in Transitory.

          (b)  Each individual International Monetary Market division Membership
     Interest in CME shall be converted into one International Monetary Market
     division Membership Interest in Transitory.

          (c)  Each individual Index and Option Market division Membership
     Interest in CME shall be converted into one Index and Option Market
     division Membership Interest in Transitory.

          (d)  Each individual Growth and Emerging Markets division Membership
     Interest in CME shall be converted into one Growth and Emerging Markets
     division Membership Interest in Transitory.

          (e)  Each fractional Growth and Emerging Markets division Membership
     Interest in CME shall be converted into an equivalent fractional Growth and
     Emerging Markets division Membership Interest in Transitory.

Each of the Membership Interests in Transitory described in the foregoing
clauses (a) through (e) (inclusive) shall have the rights, preferences and
privileges provided for in the Consolidated Rules of CME for the corresponding
Membership Interests in CME as of the Effective Date.

                                       4
<PAGE>

     Section 3.2  Further Rules.  CME and Transitory are empowered to adopt
further rules and regulations, not inconsistent with the provisions of this
Agreement, regarding the conversion of the Membership Interests in CME into
Membership Interests in Transitory.

                                  ARTICLE IV
                                   COVENANTS

     Section 4.1  Further Actions.  Each of the Constituent Corporations agrees
to use its reasonable efforts to take, or to cause to be taken, all actions and
to do, or to cause to be done, all things necessary, proper or advisable to
consummate and to make effective the transactions contemplated by this
Agreement, including, but not limited to:

          (a)  making, or causing to be made, all such filings and submissions
     under any applicable law and giving such reasonable undertakings, as may be
     necessary to consummate this Agreement and the transactions contemplated
     hereby;

          (b)  using its reasonable efforts to obtain, or causing to be
     obtained, all Governmental Approvals and other Consents necessary to be
     obtained in order to consummate this Agreement and the transactions
     contemplated hereby; and

          (c)  using its reasonable efforts to take, or cause to be taken, all
     other actions, necessary, proper or advisable in order to fulfill its
     obligations in respect of this Agreement and the transactions contemplated
     hereby.

     Each of the parties hereto shall coordinate and cooperate with the other
party in exchanging such information and supplying such reasonable assistance as
may be requested by such other party in connection with the filings and other
actions contemplated by this Section 4.1.

     Section 4.2  Service in Illinois.  Transitory, as the Surviving
Corporation, agrees that it may be served with process in Illinois in any
proceeding for enforcement of (i) any obligation of CME as well as (ii) any of
its obligations arising from this Merger. Transitory hereby irrevocably appoints
the Secretary of State of Illinois as its agent to accept service of process in
any such suit or other proceedings, and any such process so accepted shall be
mailed by the Secretary of State of Illinois to Chicago Mercantile Exchange
Inc., 30 South Wacker Drive, Chicago, Illinois 60606, attention: General
Counsel.

                                   ARTICLE V
                             CONDITIONS TO MERGER

     Section 5.1  Conditions to Effectiveness.  The obligation of each of the
parties hereto to consummate the transactions contemplated by this Agreement
shall be subject to the fulfillment on or prior to the Effective Date of the
following conditions:

          (a)  No Injunctions or Restraints. Consummation of the transactions
     contemplated by this Agreement shall not have been restrained, enjoined or
     otherwise

                                       5
<PAGE>

     prohibited by any applicable law, including any order, injunction, decree
     or judgment of any court or other Governmental Authority, and no action or
     proceeding shall be pending or threatened by any Governmental Authority on
     the Effective Date before any court or other Governmental Authority to
     restrain, enjoin or otherwise prevent the consummation of the transactions
     contemplated hereby or to recover any material damages or obtain other
     material relief as a result of such transactions. There shall not have been
     promulgated, entered, issued, or determined by any court or other
     Governmental Authority to be applicable to this Agreement any applicable
     law making illegal the consummation of the transactions contemplated
     hereby, and no proceeding with respect to the application of any such
     applicable law shall be pending.

          (b)  Effectiveness of the Registration Statement. The Registration
     Statement on Form S-4 filed with the SEC by Chicago Mercantile Exchange
     Inc., a Delaware corporation ("New CME"), relating to its issuance of its
     common stock (including the proxy statement and prospectus constituting
     part thereof, the "Registration Statement") shall have become and remain
     effective under the Securities Act. No stop order suspending the
     effectiveness of the Registration Statement shall have been issued by the
     SEC and no proceedings for that purpose and no similar proceeding in
     respect of the Registration Statement shall have been initiated or
     threatened by the SEC.

          (c)  Requisite Approvals.  The Members of CME shall have approved this
     Agreement as required by law.

          (d)  Internal Revenue Service Ruling. Issuance by the Internal Revenue
     Service of a ruling to the effect that the Merger and the ultimate issuance
     of common stock by New CME qualify for tax-free treatment under the
     Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

          (e)  P-M-T.  The offer by New CME to purchase the assets and business
     of P-M-T Limited Partnership, an Illinois limited partnership, for cash
     shall have been approved by the holders of two-thirds of the outstanding P-
     M-T Class A partnership units (excluding units held by CME).

                                  ARTICLE VI
                    AMENDMENT; TERMINATION AND CORRECTIONS

     Section 6.1  Amendment of Agreement.  At any time prior to the Effective
Date, the parties hereto may agree to amend this Agreement. No such amendment
may, in the sole judgment of the Board of Directors of CME, materially and
adversely affect the rights of the Members of CME.

     Section 6.2  Abandonment of Agreement.  At any time prior to the Effective
Date, CME may abandon this Agreement by appropriate resolution of its Board of
Directors, notwithstanding prior approval at the Special Meeting. No Person
shall have any rights or claims against either Constituent Corporation or its
respective Board of Directors based on abandonment of this Agreement.

                                       6
<PAGE>

     Section 6.3  Corrections.  The Constituent Corporations may, until the
Effective Date, by an instrument executed by a Chairman, Vice Chairman,
President or any Vice President of each Constituent Corporation, make such
modifications as are appropriate to correct errors, clarify existing items or
make additions to correct manifest omissions in this Agreement.

                                  ARTICLE VII
                             ADDITIONAL PROVISIONS

     Section 7.1  Notices.  If CME complies substantially and in good faith with
the requirements of the Illinois Act or the terms of this Agreement with respect
to the giving of any required notice to its Members, its failure in any case to
give such notice to any Person or Persons entitled thereto shall not impair the
validity of the actions and proceedings taken under the Illinois Act or this
Agreement or entitle such Person or Persons to any injunctive or other equitable
relief with respect thereto.

     Section 7.2  Severability.  To the extent possible, each provision of this
Agreement shall be interpreted in a manner as to be valid, legal and
enforceable. Any determination that any provision of this Agreement or any
application thereof is invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect or in
any instance shall be effective only to the extent of such invalidity,
illegality or unenforceablity and shall not effect the validity, legality or
enforceability of any other provision of this Agreement.

     Section 7.3  Headings.  Article and Section headings contained in this
Agreement are inserted for convenience and reference only, and shall not be
considered in construing or interpreting any of the provisions hereof.

     Section 7.4  Entire Agreement.  This Agreement supersedes any and all oral
or written agreements heretofore made relating to the subject matter hereof and
constitutes the entire Agreement of the parties relating to the subject matter
hereof.

     Section 7.5  Expenses.  Transitory, as the Surviving Corporation, shall pay
all expenses of carrying this Merger into effect and accomplishing the Merger
herein provided for.

     Section 7.6  Counterparts.  This Agreement may be executed simultaneously
in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original,
but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

     Section 7.7  Governing Law.  This Agreement shall be governed by and
construed in accordance with the internal laws of the State of Delaware, without
giving effect to any conflicts or choice of law provisions that would make
applicable the substantive laws of any other jurisdiction.

                                       7
<PAGE>

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, each of the Constituent Corporations, pursuant to
authority duly given by resolutions adopted by its Board of Directors, has
caused this Agreement to be executed in its name by its duly authorized officer
as of the day and year aforesaid.

                                  CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE

                                  By: ____________________________
                                      Name:  Scott Gordon
                                      Title: Chairman of the Board



                                  CME TRANSITORY CO.

                                  By: ____________________________
                                      Name:  Scott Gordon
                                      Title: Chairman of the Board

                                       8
<PAGE>

                                    PART II

                     INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

Item 20.  Indemnification of Directors and Officers

Section 145 of the Delaware General Corporation Law provides that the Registrant
may, and in some circumstances must, indemnify the directors and officers of the
Registrant against liabilities and expenses incurred by such person by reason of
the fact that such person was serving in such capacity, subject to certain
limitations and conditions set forth in the statute. The Registrant's
Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws provide that the Registrant will
indemnify its directors and officers, and may indemnify any person serving as
director or officer of another business entity at the Registrant's request, to
the extent permitted by the statute. In addition, the Registrant's Certificate
of Incorporation provides, as permitted by the the Delaware General Corporation
Law, that directors shall not be personally liable for monetary damages for
breach of fiduciary duty as a director, except (i) for breaches of their duty of
loyalty to the Registrant or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or omissions not in
good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of
law, (iii) under Section 174 of the Delaware General Corporation Law, and (iv)
for transactions from which a director derived an improper personal benefit.

Item 21.  Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

(a)       Exhibits

          The following is a list of Exhibits included as part of this
          Registration Statement. The Registrant agrees to furnish
          supplementally a copy of any omitted schedule to the Securities and
          Exchange Commission upon request.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
          Exhibit
          Number    Description of Exhibit
          ------    ----------------------
          <S>       <C>
          2.1       Form of Agreement and Plan of Merger dated as of April 1, 2000 between Chicago Mercantile Exchange and CME
                    Transitory Co. (included as Exhibit B to the Proxy Statement/Prospectus).
          2.2       Form of Agreement and Plan of Merger dated as of April 1, 2000 between CME Transitory Co. and the
                    Registrant
          2.3       Plan of Recapitalization dated as of April 1, 2000
          3.1*      Certificate of incorporation of the Registrant
          3.2       Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (as in effect immediately prior to the recapitalization
                    contemplated by the Plan of Recapitalization)
          3.3*      By-laws of the Registrant
          3.4       Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Registrant (as in effect immediately after the
                    recapitalization contemplated by the Plan of Recapitalization) (included as Exhibit A to the Proxy
                    Statement/Prospectus)
          5.1       Opinion of Sidley & Austin regarding legality of securities being registered
          8.1       Opinion of Sidley & Austin regarding tax matters
          10.1*     Chicago Mercantile Exchange Omnibus Stock Plan, effective February 7, 2000.
          10.2*     Chicago Mercantile Exchange Senior Management Supplemental Deferred Savings Plan, including First Amendment
                    thereto dated December 14, 1994, Second Amendment thereto dated December 8, 1998 and Administrative Guidelines
                    thereto.
          10.3*     Chicago Mercantile Exchange Directors' Deferred Compensation Plan, including First Amendment thereto dated
                    December 8, 1998.
          10.4*     Chicago Mercantile Exchange Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, including First Amendment thereto dated
                    December 31, 1996, Second Amendment thereto dated January 14, 1998 and Third Amendment thereto dated December
                    __, 1998.
          10.5*     Chicago Mercantile Exchange Supplemental Executive Retirement Trust, including First Amendment thereto dated
                    September 7, 1993.
          10.6*     Agreement dated March 21, 1997 between Chicago Mercantile Exchange and T. Eric Kilcollin.
          10.7*     Separation Agreement and General Release, executed December 31, 1998 between T. Eric Kilcollin and Chicago
                    Mercantile Exchange.
          10.8**    Agreement dated February 7, 2000 between Chicago Mercantile Exchange and James J. McNulty.
          10.9*     Employment Agreement dated October 27, 1998 between Chicago Mercantile Exchange and Frederick Arditti, and
                    First Amendment thereto dated October 27, 1998 and Second Amendment thereto dated October 27, 1998.
          10.10*    Employment Agreement dated December 10, 1999 between Chicago Mercantile Exchange and Gerald D. Beyer.
          10.11*    Employment Agreement, executed September 8, 1999 between Chicago Mercantile Exchange and Phupinder Gill.
          10.12*    Employment Agreement dated July 17, 1998 between Chicago Mercantile Exchange and William Jenks
          10.13*    License Agreement, effective as of September 24, 1997 between Standard & Poor's, a Division of The McGraw-Hill
                    Companies, Inc., and Chicago Mercantile Exchange. (confidential material appearing in this document has been
                    omitted and filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission in accordance with the Securities Act
                    of 1933, as amended, and 17 C.F.R. 230.406 and 200.80 promulgated thereunder. Omitted information has been
                    replaced with asterisks.)
          10.14*    Lease dated as of November 11, 1983 between Chicago Mercantile Exchange Trust (successor to CME Real Estate
                    Co. of Chicago, Illinois) and Chicago Mercantile Exchange, including amendment thereto dated as of December 6,
                    1989.
          10.15*    Lease dated March 31, 1988 between EOP -- 10 & 30 South Wacker, L.L.C., as beneficiary of a land trust dated
                    October 1, 1997 and known as American National Bank and Trust Company of Chicago Trust No. 123434 (as successor
                    in interest to American National Bank and Trust Company of Chicago, not individually but solely as trustee
                    under Trust Agreement dated June 2, 1981 and known as Trust No. 51234) and Chicago Mercantile Exchange relating
                    to 10 South Wacker Drive, including First Amendment thereto dated as of November 1, 1999.
          10.16*    Lease dated May 11, 1981 between EOP -- 10 & 30 South Wacker, L.L.C., as beneficiary of a land trust dated
                    October 1, 1997 and known as American National Bank and Trust Company of Chicago Trust No. 123434-06 (as
                    successor in interest to American National Bank and Trust Company of Chicago, not individually but solely as
                    trustee under Trust Agreement dated March 20, 1980 and known as Trust No. 48268) and Chicago Mercantile
                    Exchange relating to 30 South Wacker Drive, including First Amendment thereto dated as of February 1, 1982,
                    Second Amendment thereto dated as of April 26, 1982, Third Amendment thereto dated as of June 29, 1982, Fourth
                    Amendment thereto dated as of July 28, 1982, Fifth Amendment thereto dated as of October 7, 1982, Sixth
                    Amendment thereto dated as of July 5, 1983, Seventh Amendment thereto dated as of September 19, 1983, Eighth
                    Amendment thereto dated as of October 17, 1983, Ninth Amendment thereto dated as of December 3, 1984, Tenth
                    Amendment thereto dated as of March 16, 1987, Eleventh Amendment thereto dated as of January 1, 1999, Twelfth
                    Amendment thereto dated as of June 30, 1999.
          10.17     Third Amendment to Employment Agreement dated March 3, 2000, between Chicago Mercantile Exchange and Frederick
                    Arditti.
          10.18     Separation Agreement and General Release dated March 21, 2000 between Gerald D. Beyer and Chicago Mercantile
                    Exchange.
          10.19     Separation Agreement and General Release dated March 21, 2000 between William W. Jenks and Chicago Mercantile
                    Exchange.
          21.1*     Subsidiaries of the Registrant
          23.1      Consent of Sidley & Austin (included in Exhibit 5.1)
          23.2      Consent of Arthur Andersen LLP
          24.1*     Form of Power of Attorney executed by Directors of Registrant
          27.1*     Financial Data Schedule
          99.1*     Form of proxy
</TABLE>
______________________
*  Previously filed.
** To be filed by amendment.
<PAGE>

(b)       Financial Statement Schedules

          None.

Item 22.  Undertakings.

     The Registrant hereby undertakes:

          (1)  To file, during any period in which offers or sales are being
     made, a post-effective amendment to this registration statement:

               (i)    To include any prospectus required by Section 10(a)(3) of
          the Securities Act of 1933.

               (ii)   To reflect in the prospectus any facts or events arising
          after the effective date of the registration statement (or the most
          recent post-effective amendment thereof) which, individually or in the
          aggregate, represent a fundamental change in the information set forth
          in the registration statement.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, any
          increase or decrease in volume of securities offered (if the total
          dollar value of securities offered would not exceed that which was
          registered) and any deviation from the low or high end of the
          estimated maximum offering range may be reflected in the form of
          prospectus filed with the Commission pursuant to Rule 424(b) if, in
          the aggregate, the changes in volume and price represent no more than
          20 percent change in the maximum aggregate offering price set forth in
          the "Calculation of Registration Fee" table in the effective
          registration statement.

               (iii)  To include any material information with respect to the
          plan of distribution not previously disclosed in the registration
          statement or any material change to such information in the
          registration statement.

          (2)  That, for the purpose of determining any liability under the
     Securities Act of 1933, each such post-effective amendment shall be deemed
     to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered
     therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed
     to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

          (3)  To remove from registration by means of a post-effective
     amendment any of the securities being registered which remain unsold at the
     termination of the offering.

          (4)  That prior to any public reoffering of the securities registered
     hereunder through use of a prospectus which is a part of this registration
     statement, by any person or party who is deemed to be an underwriter within
     the meaning of Rule 145(c), the issuer undertakes that such reoffering
     prospectus will contain the information called for by the applicable
     registration form with respect to reofferings by persons who may be deemed
     underwriters, in addition to the information called for by the other items
     of the applicable form.

          (5)  That every prospectus: (i) that is filed pursuant to paragraph
     (4) immediately preceding, or (ii) that purports to meet the requirements
     of Section 10(a)(3) of the Act and is used in connection with an offering
     of securities subject to Rule 415, will be filed as a part of an amendment
     to the registration statement and will not be used until such amendment is
     effective, and that, for purposes of determining any liability under the
     Securities Act of 1933, each such

                                       2
<PAGE>

     post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be a new registration statement
     relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such
     securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide
     offering thereof.

          (6)  To respond to requests for information that is incorporated by
     reference into the prospectus pursuant to Item 4, 10(b), 11, or 13 of this
     form, within one business day of receipt of such request, and to send the
     incorporated documents by first class mail or other equally prompt means.
     This includes information contained in documents filed subsequent to the
     effective date of the registration statement through the date of responding
     to the request.

          (7)  To supply by means of a post-effective amendment all information
     concerning a transaction, and the company being acquired involved therein,
     that was not the subject of and included in the registration statement when
     it became effective.

     Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act
of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the
registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant
has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission
such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is,
therefore, unenforceable.  In the event that a claim for indemnification against
such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred
or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the
successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such
director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being
registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter
has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate
jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public
policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of
such issue.

                                       3
<PAGE>

                                   SIGNATURES

     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act, the registrant has duly
caused this Amendment No. 3 to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Chicago, State of
Illinois, on April 6, 2000.

                                    CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE INC.

                                    By: /s/ M. Scott Gordon
                                       -------------------------------------
                                        M. Scott Gordon
                                        Chairman of the Board

          Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this
registration statement has been signed by the following persons in the
capacities indicated on this 6th day of April, 2000.

     Name                     Title
     ----                     -----


M. Scott Gordon               Chairman of the Board and Director
- ---------------------------
M. Scott Gordon               (Chief Executive Officer)


David G. Gomach               Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
- ---------------------------
David G. Gomach               (Principal Financial Officer)


Raymond C. Repede             Vice President and Controller
- ---------------------------
Raymond C. Repede             (Principal Accounting Officer)

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
H. Jack Bouroudjian

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Timothy R. Brennan

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Leslie Henner Burns

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Jeffrey R. Carter

                              Director
- ---------------------------
E. Gerald Corrigan

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Terrence A. Duffy

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Rahm Emanuel
                                       4
<PAGE>

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Martin J. Gepsman

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Yra G. Harris

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Robert L. Haworth

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Bruce F. Johnson

                              Director
- ---------------------------
Gary M. Katler

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Paul Kimball

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Thomas A. Kloet

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
John W. Lacey

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Leo Melamed

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Merton H. Miller

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
William P. Miller II

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Laurence E. Mollner

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Patrick J. Mulchrone

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
John D. Newhouse

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
James E. Oliff

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Mark G. Papadopoulos

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Ward Parkinson

                                       5
<PAGE>

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Robert J. Prosi

                              Director
- ---------------------------
David M. Pryde

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Irwin Rosen

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
William G. Salatich, Jr.

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
John F. Sandner

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Verne O. Sedlacek

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Leon C. Shender

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
William R. Shepard

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Howard J. Siegel

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
David I. Silverman

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Jeffrey L. Silverman

        *                     Director
- ---------------------------
Paul Simon

* By: /s/ Craig S. Donohue
     ----------------------
     Craig S. Donohue
     Attorney-in-Fact

                                       6

<PAGE>


                                         Exhibit 2.2
                                         Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
                                         Registration Statement on Form S-4

                         AGREEMENT AND PLAN OF MERGER
                                      OF
            CME Transitory Co. and Chicago Mercantile Exchange INC.

          THIS AGREEMENT AND PLAN OF MERGER (this "Agreement") is made and
entered into as of April 1, 2000, between CME Transitory Co., a Delaware
nonstock corporation ("Transitory"), and Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc., a
Delaware stock corporation ("CME" or "Surviving Corporation"), said corporations
hereinafter sometimes referred to jointly as the "Constituent Corporations."

                                  WITNESSETH:

          WHEREAS, Transitory is a nonstock corporation duly organized and
existing under the Delaware General Corporation Law, having as its registered
agent The Corporation Trust Company;

          WHEREAS, CME is a stock corporation duly organized and existing under
the Delaware General Corporation Law, having as its registered agent The
Corporation Trust Company;

          WHEREAS, the Constituent Corporations propose, pursuant to the
applicable provisions of the Delaware General Corporation Law, for Transitory to
merge with and into CME in consideration for which the Membership Interests in
Transitory will be converted into shares of the Common Stock of CME (the
"Merger"); and

          WHEREAS, the respective Boards of Directors of the Constituent
Corporations have determined that it is advisable that Transitory be merged with
and into CME and have approved such Merger on the terms and conditions
hereinafter set forth in accordance with the applicable provisions of law
permitting such Merger;

          NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and of the
agreements, covenants and provisions hereinafter set forth, the parties hereto,
intending to be legally bound, do hereby agree as follows:

                                   ARTICLE I
                                  DEFINITIONS

     In addition to the words defined elsewhere in this Agreement, the following
words have the following respective meanings, and such definitions shall be
equally applicable to both the singular and plural forms of any of the words
herein defined:
<PAGE>

          "CME Certificate of Incorporation" means the amended and restated
     certificate of incorporation of CME as in effect on the Effective Date.

          "Consent" means any consent, license, permit, waiver, approval,
     authorization or other action of, by or with respect to, or registration,
     declaration or filing with, any court, Governmental Authority or Person.

          "DGCL" means the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, as
     amended.

          "Effective Date" means the date on which the Merger becomes effective
     as provided by the applicable provisions of the DGCL.

          "Exchange Act" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

          "Governmental Approval" means any Consent of, with or to any
     Governmental Authority, including the expiration of any waiting or other
     time period required to pass before governmental consent or acquiescence
     may be assumed or relied on.

          "Governmental Authority" means any court or governmental authority,
     department, commission, board, bureau, agency or instrumentality, domestic
     or foreign, any tribunal or arbitrators of competent jurisdiction and any
     self-regulatory organization.

          "Member" means the owner of a Membership Interest, or any portion
     thereof, in Transitory.  An owner of two or more Membership Interests, or
     portions thereof, shall be deemed to be a separate Member with respect to
     each individual interest owned.

          "Membership Division" means a Membership Interest in any one or more
     of the following four divisions of Membership Interests in Transitory: (i)
     Chicago Mercantile Exchange; (ii) International Monetary Market; (iii)
     Index and Options Market; and (iv) Growth and Emerging Markets.

          "Membership Interest" means all the rights or interests of each Member
     of Transitory, including, but not limited to, any floor access and
     electronic trading rights, rights to clearing membership and clearing fees,
     any right to vote, any rights with regard to earnings, surplus or assets of
     Transitory, and any other rights in liquidation, merger, reorganization or
     conversion of Transitory.

          "Person" means an individual, corporation, joint venture, partnership,
     association, trust, trustee, unincorporated entity, organization or
     government or any department or agency thereof.  A Person who owns a
     Membership Interest in more than one capacity shall be deemed to be a
     separate Person in each such capacity.

          "SEC" means the Securities and Exchange Commission.

          "Securities Act" means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.



                                       2
<PAGE>

                                  ARTICLE II
                                    MERGER

     Section 2.1   Effect of the Merger.   Subject to the terms of this
Agreement, and as more fully set forth and supplemented by other provisions
herein, upon the Effective Date and pursuant to the Merger:

          (a) Transitory will merge with and into CME, the separate existence of
     Transitory shall cease, except to the extent provided by the laws of the
     State of Delaware in the case of a corporation after its merger into
     another corporation, and CME shall be the Surviving Corporation.

          (b) All Membership Interests in Transitory shall be converted into
     shares of the common stock of CME as provided in Section 3.1 of this
     Agreement.

          (c) The Surviving Corporation shall thereupon and thereafter possess
     all the rights, privileges, immunities, powers and franchises, as well of a
     public as of a private nature, of each of the Constituent Corporations, and
     all property, real, personal and mixed, all debts due on whatever account,
     including subscriptions to shares or membership interests and all other
     choses in action, and all and every other interest of, or belonging to,
     each of the Constituent Corporations shall be taken and deemed to be
     transferred to and vested in the Surviving Corporation without further act
     or deed; and the title to all real estate, or any interest therein, vested
     in either of the Constituent Corporations shall not revert or be in any way
     impaired by reason of the Merger.

          (d) The Surviving Corporation shall be responsible and liable for all
     the liabilities and obligations of each of the Constituent Corporations,
     and any claim existing or action or proceeding pending by or against either
     of the Constituent Corporations may be prosecuted to judgment as if the
     merger had not taken place, or the Surviving Corporation may be substituted
     in its place, and neither the rights of creditors nor any liens upon the
     property of either of the Constituent Corporations shall be impaired by the
     Merger.

          (e) (i) The respective assets of Transitory and CME shall be taken up
     or continued on the books of the Surviving Corporation in the amounts at
     which such assets shall have been carried on their respective books
     immediately prior the Effective Date; and (ii) the respective liabilities
     and reserves of Transitory and CME shall be taken up or continued on the
     books of the Surviving Corporation in the amounts at which such liabilities
     and reserves shall have been carried on their respective books immediately
     prior to the Effective Date.

          (f) All corporate acts, plans, policies, agreements, arrangements,
     approvals and authorizations of Transitory, its Members, Board of Directors
     and committees thereof, officers and agents, which were valid and effective
     immediately prior to the Effective Date shall be taken for all purposes as
     the acts, plans, policies, agreements, arrangements, approvals and
     authorizations of the Surviving Corporation and shall be as effective and
     binding thereon as the same were with respect to Transitory.

                                       3
<PAGE>

     Section 2.2   Charter and By-Laws.  The CME Certificate of Incorporation
and By-Laws as in effect on the Effective Date shall be and constitute the
certificate of incorporation and by-laws of the Surviving Corporation until the
same shall be altered, amended or changed in accordance with their respective
terms and applicable law.

     Section 2.3   Directors and Officers.   The directors and officers of
Transitory prior to the Effective Date shall serve as the directors and officers
of the Surviving Corporation on and after the Effective Date, until new
directors and officers have been duly elected and qualified pursuant to the CME
Certificate of Incorporation and CME's By-laws, or until their earlier
resignation, removal or replacement.

     Section 2.4   Employees and Agents.  The employees and agents of Transitory
shall become the employees and agents of the Surviving Corporation and shall
continue to be entitled to the same rights and benefits which they enjoyed as
employees and agents of Transitory.

                                  ARTICLE III
                      CONVERSION OF MEMBERSHIP INTERESTS

     Section 3.1   Conversion of Membership Interests.   On the Effective Date,
and without any further action by Transitory or CME, all Membership Interests in
Transitory shall be converted into common stock of CME in accordance with the
following:

          (a) Each individual Chicago Mercantile Exchange division Membership
     Interest in Transitory shall be converted into one fully paid and
     nonassessable share of CME Class Common Stock, $.01 par value of CME;

          (b) Each individual International Monetary Market division Membership
     Interest in Transitory shall be converted into one fully paid and
     nonassessable share of IMM Class Common Stock, $.01 par value of CME;

          (c) Each individual Index and Option Market division Membership
     Interest in Transitory shall be converted into one fully paid and
     nonassessable share of IOM Class Common Stock, $.01 par value of CME;

          (d) Each full individual Growth and Emerging Markets division
     Membership Interest in Transitory shall be converted into one fully paid
     and nonassessable share of GEM Class Common Stock, $.01 par value of CME;
     and

          (e) Each fractional Growth and Emerging Markets division Membership
     Interest in Transitory shall be converted into one fully paid and
     nonassessable share of Fractional GEM Class Common Stock, $.01 par value of
     CME.

     Section 3.2   Further Rules.   Transitory and CME are empowered to adopt
further rules and regulations, not inconsistent with the provisions of this
Agreement, regarding the conversion of Membership Interests in Transitory into
shares of the common stock of CME.

     Section 3.3   Authority to Remedy Errors.   Subject to the terms of this
Agreement, the Board of Directors of the Surviving Corporation may authorize and
issue additional shares of

                                       4
<PAGE>

common stock and take any other action it deems appropriate to remedy errors or
miscalculations made in connection with this Agreement.

                                  ARTICLE IV
                                   COVENANTS

     Section 4.1   Further Actions.   Each of the Constituent Corporations
agrees to use its reasonable efforts to take, or to cause to be taken, all
actions and to do, or to cause to be done, all things necessary, proper or
advisable to consummate and to make effective the transactions contemplated by
this Agreement, including, but not limited to:

          (a) making, or causing to be made, all such filings and submissions
     under any applicable law and giving such reasonable undertakings as may be
     necessary to consummate this Agreement and the transactions contemplated
     hereby;

          (b) using reasonable efforts to obtain, or to cause to be obtained,
     all Governmental Approvals and other Consents necessary to be obtained in
     order to consummate this Agreement and the transactions contemplated
     hereby; and

          (c) using its reasonable efforts to take, or to cause to be taken, all
     other actions, necessary, proper or advisable in order to fulfill its
     obligations in respect of this Agreement and the transactions contemplated
     hereby.

     Each of the parties hereto will coordinate and cooperate with the other
party in exchanging such information and supplying such reasonable assistance as
may be requested by the other party in connection with the filings and other
actions contemplated by this Section 4.1.

                                   ARTICLE V
                             CONDITIONS TO MERGER

     Section 5.1   Conditions to Effectiveness.  The obligation of each of the
parties hereto to consummate the transactions contemplated by this Agreement
shall be subject to the satisfaction on or prior to the Effective Date of the
Merger of following conditions:

     (a) Consummation of Merger of Chicago Mercantile Exchange into and with
     Transitory.   The merger of Chicago Mercantile Exchange, an Illinois not-
     for-profit corporation ("Existing CME"), into and with Transitory shall
     have been consummated as provided in that certain Agreement and Plan of
     Merger dated as of April 1, 2000 between Existing CME and Transitory.

          (b) No Injunctions or Restraints.   Consummation of the transactions
     contemplated by this Agreement shall not have been restrained, enjoined or
     otherwise prohibited by any applicable law, including any order,
     injunction, decree or judgment of any court or other Governmental
     Authority, and no action or proceeding shall be pending or threatened by
     any Governmental Authority on the Effective Date before any court or other
     Governmental Authority to restrain, enjoin or otherwise prevent the
     consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby or to recover any
     material damages or obtain

                                       5
<PAGE>

     other material relief as a result of such transactions. There shall not
     have been promulgated, entered, issued or determined by any court or other
     Governmental Authority to be applicable to this Agreement any applicable
     law making illegal the consummation of the transactions contemplated
     hereby, and no proceeding with respect to the application of any such
     applicable law shall be pending.

          (c) Governmental and Regulatory Consents.   All filings required to be
     made prior to the Effective Date with, and all Consents, approvals, permits
     and authorizations required to be obtained prior to the Effective Date from
     any Governmental Authority, in connection with the execution and delivery
     of this Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated
     hereby by the Constituent Corporations, and which, either individually or
     in the aggregate, if not obtained would have a material adverse effect on
     the business, assets, financial condition or results of operations of the
     Surviving Corporation or would prevent consummation of this Agreement, will
     have been made or obtained (as the case may be).

          (d) Requisite Approvals.   This Agreement shall have been approved by
     the members or the stockholders, as the case may be, of each Constituent
     Corporation, as required by applicable law.

                                  ARTICLE VI
                             MEMBERSHIP INTERESTS

     Section 6.1   Determination of Membership.   The owner of a Membership
Interest as of a given date shall be the Person or Persons whose name or names
appear, as of such date, on the records of and as determined in good faith by
Transitory.  Such Person or Persons, determined in accordance with the foregoing
sentence, shall conclusively be presumed to be the owner or owners of such
Membership Interest for purposes of this Agreement and Transitory shall not be
required to examine or consider any other facts or circumstances.

     Section 6.2   Mailing Address.   The mailing address of a Member,
determined in accordance with the foregoing Section, as of any date, for
purposes of this Agreement, shall be the Member's last known address as it
appears on the records of Transitory as of such date.

                                  ARTICLE VII
                    CORRECTIONS, AMENDMENTS AND TERMINATION

     Section 7.1   Corrections.   The Constituent Corporations may, until the
Effective Date, by an instrument executed by a Chairman, Vice Chairman,
President or any Vice President of each Constituent Corporation, make such
modifications as are appropriate to correct errors, clarify existing items or
make additions to correct manifest omissions in this Agreement.

     Section 7.2   Amendment of Agreement.   At any time prior to the merger of
Existing CME into and with Transitory, the parties hereto may agree to amend
this Agreement.  No amendment may, in the sole judgment of the Board of
Directors of Transitory, materially and adversely affect the rights of the
Members of Existing CME.

                                       6
<PAGE>

     Section 7.3   Abandonment of Agreement.   At any time prior to the merger
of Existing CME into and with Transitory, Transitory may abandon this Agreement
by appropriate resolution of its Board of Directors, notwithstanding prior
Member approval.  No Person shall have any rights or claims against either
Constituent Corporation or its respective Board of Directors based on the
abandonment of this Agreement.

                                 ARTICLE VIII
                             ADDITIONAL PROVISIONS

     Section 8.1   Severability.   To the extent possible, each provision of
this Agreement shall be interpreted in a manner as to be valid, legal and
enforceable.  Any determination that any provision of this Agreement or any
application thereof is invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect or in
any instance shall be effective only to the extent of such invalidity,
illegality or unenforceablity and shall not effect the validity, legality or
enforceability of any other provision of this Agreement.

     Section 8.2   Headings.   Article and Section headings contained in this
Agreement are inserted for convenience and reference only, and shall not be
considered in construing or interpreting any of the provisions hereof.

     Section 8.3   Entire Agreement.   This Agreement supersedes any and all
oral or written agreements heretofore made relating to the subject matter hereof
and constitutes the entire Agreement of the parties relating to the subject
matter hereof.

     Section 8.4   Expenses.   CME, as the Surviving Corporation, shall pay all
expenses of carrying the Merger into effect and accomplishing the Merger herein
provided for.

     Section 8.5   Counterparts.   This Agreement may be executed simultaneously
in two or more counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original,
but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

     Section 8.6   Governing Law.   This Agreement shall be governed by and
construed in accordance with the internal laws of the State of Delaware, without
giving effect to any conflicts or choice of law provisions that would make
applicable the substantive laws of any other jurisdiction.

                                       7
<PAGE>

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, each of the Constituent Corporations, pursuant to
authority duly given by resolutions adopted by its Board of Directors, has
caused this Agreement to be executed in its name by its duly authorized officer
as of the day and year aforesaid.


                         CME TRANSITORY CO.

                         By:______________________________
                             Name:  Scott Gordon
                             Title: Chairman of the Board



                         CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE INC.

                         By:______________________________
                             Name:  Scott Gordon
                             Title: Chairman of the Board

                                       8

<PAGE>

                                              Exhibit 2.3
                                              Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
                                              Registration Statement on Form S-4


                           Plan Of Recapitalization

            THIS PLAN OF RECAPITALIZATION (this "Plan") is hereby adopted by the
 Board of Directors of Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc., a Delaware corporation
 (the "Corporation"), as of this 1st day of April, 2000.

                             W I T N E S S E T H:

      WHEREAS, immediately prior to the consummation of the recapitalization
 contemplated by this Plan, the Corporation will have outstanding five classes
 of common stock (the "Common Shares"); and

      WHEREAS, under this Plan, the Certificate of Incorporation of the
 Corporation, as theretofore amended, shall be further amended and restated in
 the form attached to this Plan as Exhibit A (the "Amended and Restated
 Charter") and upon the filing of the Amended and Restated Charter, the Common
 Shares shall be converted and exchanged as described in this Plan; and

      WHEREAS, the Board of Directors believes that the recapitalization
provided for in this Plan is advisable and in the best interests of the
Corporation, its stockholders, and all other parties concerned;

      NOW, THEREFORE, BE IT RESOLVED, the Board has a adopted and approved this
 Plan as follows:

                                   ARTICLE I
                             THE RECAPITALIZATION

      Section 1.1 The Recapitalization.

      (a) Subject to the terms and conditions of this Plan, at the Effective
Time (as defined below), the Corporation shall be recapitalized in accordance
with Section 1.2 hereof and the provisions of the Delaware General Corporation
Law ("DGCL").

      (b) The Recapitalization shall become effective upon the filing of the
Amended and Restated Charter substantially in the form attached hereto as
Exhibit A with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware in accordance
with the provisions of the DGCL or at such time as is specified in the Amended
and Restated Charter. The Amended and Restated Charter shall be filed as soon as
practicable after the consummation of the transactions resulting in the merger
(the "Merger") of CME Transitory Co. with and into the Corporation pursuant to
that certain Agreement and Plan of Merger dated as of April 1, 2000 (the "Merger
Agreement") between CME Transitory Co. and the Corporation. The consummation of
the Merger shall be evidenced by or in a Certificate of Merger filed with the
Secretary of State of Delaware regarding the
<PAGE>

Merger. The date and time when the Recapitalization shall become effective is
referred to as the "Effective Time."

     Section 1.2 Recapitalization of Stock. At the Effective Time, and without
any action on the part of the holder thereof

          (a) Each of the then outstanding shares of the Corporation's CME Class
     Common Stock, $0.01 par value, authorized immediately prior to the
     effectiveness of the Amended and Restated Charter, shall be converted into
     (i) 16,200 shares of Class A Common Stock, $0.01 par value, and (ii) one
     share of Class B Common Stock, Series B-1, $0.01 par value.

          (b) Each of the then outstanding shares of the Corporation's IMM Class
     Common Stock, $0.01 par value, authorized immediately prior to the
     effectiveness of the Amended and Restated Charter, shall be converted into
     (i) 10,800 shares of Class A Common Stock, $0.01 par value, and (ii) one
     share of Class B Common Stock, Series B-2, $0. 01 par value.

          (c) Each of the then outstanding shares of the Corporation's IOM Class
     Common Stock, $0.01 par value, authorized immediately prior to the
     effectiveness of the Amended and Restated Charter, shall be converted into
     (i) 5,400 shares of Class A Common Stock, $0.01 par value, and (ii) one
     share of Class B Common Stock, Series B-3, $0.01 par value.

          (d) Each of the then outstanding shares of the Corporation's GEM Class
     Common Stock, $0.01 par value, authorized immediately prior to the
     effectiveness of the Amended and Restated Charter, shall be converted into
     one share of Class B Common Stock, Series B-4, $0.01 par value.

          (e) Each of the then outstanding shares of the Corporation's
     Fractional GEM Class Common Stock, $0.01 par value per share, authorized
     immediately prior to the effectiveness of the Amended and Restated Charter,
     shall be converted into one share of Class B Common Stock, Series B-5,
     $0.01 par value.

As soon as practicable after the Effective Time, there shall be distributed to
each holder of record of Common Shares a certificate or certificates
representing the shares into which such holder's shares have been converted
pursuant to the foregoing provisions of this Section 1.2 and the certificate
representing such holder's Common Shares shall be cancelled.

     Section 1.3 Certificate of Incorporation. The Corporation's Certificate of
Incorporation, as in effect immediately prior to the Effective Time, shall be
amended at the Effective Time as provided in the Amended and Restated Charter
and, as so amended and restated, shall be the Certificate of Incorporation of
the Corporation until thereafter amended as provided therein and in accordance
with the DGCL.

                                       2
<PAGE>

                                  ARTICLE II
                             CONDITIONS PRECEDENT

     Section 2.1  Conditions Precedent to Consummation of the Recapitalization.
The consummation of the Recapitalization is subject to the satisfaction or,
subject to applicable law, the waiver at or prior to the Effective Time of each
of the following conditions:

            (a)  This Plan shall have been approved by the Corporation's
     stockholder.

            (b)  The transactions contemplated by the Merger Agreement shall
     have been consummated.

            (c)  No action, proceeding or investigation shall have been
     instituted or threatened prior to the Effective Time before any court or
     administrative body to restrain, enjoin or otherwise prevent the
     consummation of this Plan or the transactions contemplated hereby or to
     recover any damages or obtain other relief as a result of this Plan or the
     transactions contemplated hereby, and no restraining order or injunction
     issued by any court of competent jurisdiction shall be in effect
     prohibiting the consummation of this Plan or any of the transactions
     contemplated hereby.

                                  ARTICLE III
                                 MISCELLANEOUS

     Section 3.1  Changes, Interpretation; Other Actions. Subject to applicable
law, the provisions of this Plan may be amended or waived in any respect by the
Board of Directors of the Corporation at any time prior to the filing of the
Amended and Restated Charter in accordance with 1. 1 (b) of this Plan; provided,
however, that after the approval of this Plan by the Corporation's stockholder,
no such amendment or waiver shall, without the further approval of such
stockholder, modify the Amended and Restated Charter. The Board of Directors
shall have the power and authority to interpret the provisions of this Plan and
to make, execute and deliver such other certificates and documents, and take
such other action, as such Board of Directors shall deem necessary or desirable
in order to effect the recapitalization contemplated by this Plan.

     Section 3.2  Termination. This Plan may be terminated and the
Recapitalization contemplated hereby may be abandoned by action of the Board of
Directors at any time prior to the filing of the Amended and Restated Charter
for any reason whatsoever including, without limitation, to proceed with an
alternative plan of recapitalization or other transaction. No person shall have
any rights or claims against the Corporation or the Board of Directors based on
the abandonment of this Plan.

     Section 3.3  Governing Law. This Plan shall be governed by and construed in
accordance with the internal laws of the State of Delaware, without giving
effect to any conflicts or choice of law provisions thereof

                                       3
<PAGE>

                                   EXHIBIT A

           Form of Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation
           ---------------------------------------------------------


                See Exhibit A to the Proxy Statement/Prospectus

<PAGE>

                                           Exhibit 3.2
                                           Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
                                           Registration Statement on Form S-4

                             AMENDED AND RESTATED

                         CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION

                                      OF

                       Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.

       ARTICLE ONE: The name of the corporation is CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE
INC.

       ARTICLE TWO: The address of the corporation's registered office in the
State of Delaware is 1209 Orange Street, City of Wilmington, County of New
Castle, Delaware 19801. The name of the Corporation's registered agent at such
address is The Corporation Trust Company.

       ARTICLE THREE: The purpose of the corporation shall be to engage in any
lawful act or activity for which corporations may be organized and incorporated
under the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware.

       ARTICLE FOUR: The total number of shares of all classes of capital stock
which the corporation is authorized to issue is 5,332 shares which shall be
divided into five classes as follows:

          625 shares of CME Class Common Stock having a par value of $0.01 per
          share (the "CME Class Common Stock"),

          813 shares of IMM Class Common Stock having a par value of $0.01 per
          share (the "IMM Class Common Stock"),

          1,287 shares of IOM Class Common Stock having a par value of $0.01
          per share (the "IOM Class Common Stock"),

          467 shares of GEM Class Common Stock having a par value of $0.01 per
          share (the "GEM Class Common Stock"), and

          2,140 shares of Fractional GEM Class Common Stock having a par value
          of $0.01 per share (the "Fractional GEM Class Common Stock").

The term "Common Stock" shall mean all of the CME Class Common Stock, the IMM
Class Common Stock, the IOM Class Common Stock, the GEM Class Common Stock and
the Fractional GEM Class Common Stock.

                                       1
<PAGE>

       The designations, voting powers, optional or other special rights and the
qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, of the above classes shall
be as follows:

                                  Division A
                              General Provisions

           (1)  Definitions.  As used in this Certificate of Incorporation, the
       following terms shall have the respective meanings set forth below:

           "Issues Pertaining to Core Rights" shall include matters relating to:

                (i)   voting;

                (ii)  representation on the Board of Directors;

                (iii) trading rights;

                (iv)  the fight to share in the assets of the corporation upon
           dissolution; or

                (v)   any other issue where the Board of Directors determines
           that weighted voting is appropriate because the issue directly
           affects the governance rights of stockholders or it has a direct and
           disproportionate impact on the value of the stock of a particular
           class.

           (2)  Transfer Restrictions. Shares of Common Stock may be transferred
       at any time, subject to the following restrictions:

                (a)  No individual or entity may acquire shares of Common Stock,
           or receive or exercise rights in respect thereof, unless such
           individual or entity (i) satisfies the trading eligibility
           requirements specified for such series in the by laws of the
           corporation and in any rules or regulations as the Board of Directors
           may provide and (ii) agrees to be bound by any rules or regulations
           as the Board of Directors may provide with respect to the Common
           Stock.

                (b)  No sale, transfer or hypothecation of any share of Common
           Stock or lease of the trading privilege component thereof shall be
           valid and binding on the corporation unless and until (x) the
           purchaser, lessee or transferee satisfies the trading eligibility
           requirements specified for such shares in the by-laws of the
           corporation and in any other rules or regulations as the Board of
           Directors may provide, and (y) such sale, transfer, hypothecation or
           lease has been reported to the corporation.

                (c)  No person who has sold a share of any class of Common Stock
           shall be eligible to purchase another share of the same class of
           common stock within six months of the closing of such sale, except as
           may be otherwise allowed under rules adopted by the Board of
           Directors.

                                       2
<PAGE>

                                  Division B
                            CME Class Common Stock

       The rights, preferences and privileges and qualifications, limitations
and restrictions granted to and imposed on the shares of CME Class Common Stock
of the corporation shall be as set forth below in this Division B.

           (1)  No Right to Dividends. The holders of shares of CME Class Common
       Stock shall not be entitled to receive dividends.

           (2)  Voting Rights.

                (a)  Election of Directors.  The holders of shares of CME Class
           Common Stock shall have the right to elect twelve members (the "CME
           Directors") of the Board of Directors. Each holder of shares of CME
           Class Common Stock shall have the right to one vote for each such
           share held in the election of any of the CME Directors.

                (b)  Issues Pertaining to Core Rights.  Each holder of shares of
           CME Class Common Stock shall have the right to six votes for each
           such share held on Issues Pertaining to Core Rights.

                (c)  Other Matters.  Except as otherwise provided in Sections
           2(a) and (b) of this Division B, each holder of shares of CME Class
           Common Stock shall have the right to one vote for each such share
           held on each matter for which the vote of the holders of the CME
           Class Common Stock shall be required or considered to be necessary.

           (3)  Trading Rights.  Each holder of shares of the CME Class Common
       Stock shall have the trading rights, including trading floor access
       rights and privileges, set forth in the corporation's bylaws and rules
       for its Chicago Mercantile Exchange Division Members.

           (4)  Liquidation Rights. Upon the dissolution and liquidation of the
       corporation, the holders of the CME Class Common Stock shall be entitled
       in the aggregate to receive 23.84% of any assets available for
       distribution to the holders of Common Stock.

                                  Division C
                            IMM Class Common Stock

       The rights, preferences and privileges, and qualifications, limitations
and restrictions granted to and imposed on the shares of IMM Class Common Stock
of the corporation shall be as set forth in this Division C.

                                       3
<PAGE>

                    (1)  No Right to Dividends. The holders of shares of IMM
               Class Common Stock shall not be entitled to receive dividends.

                    (2)  Voting Rights.

                         (a)  Election of Directors. The holders of shares of
                    IMM Class Common Stock shall have the right to elect eight
                    members (the "IMM Directors") of the Board of Directors.
                    Each holder of shares of IMM Class Common Stock shall have
                    the right to one vote for each such share held in the
                    election of any of the IMM Directors.

                         (b)  Issues Pertaining to Core Rights. Each holder of
                    shares of IMM Class Common Stock shall have the right to two
                    votes for each such share held on Issues Pertaining to Core
                    Rights.

                         (c)  Other Matters. Except as otherwise provided in
                    Sections 2(a) and (b) of this Division C, each holder of
                    shares of IMM Class Common Stock shall have the right to one
                    vote for each such share held on each matter for which the
                    vote of the holders of the IMM Class Common Stock shall be
                    required or considered to be necessary.

                    (3)  Trading Rights. Each holder of shares of the IMM Class
              Common Stock shall have the trading rights, including trading
              floor access rights and privileges, set forth in the corporation's
              bylaws and rules for its International Monetary Market Division
              Members.

                    (4)  Liquidation Rights. Upon the dissolution and
              liquidation of the corporation, the holders of the IMM Class
              Common Stock shall be entitled in the aggregate to receive 5.34%
              of any assets available for distribution to the holders of Common
              Stock.

                                  Division D
                            I0M Class Common Stock

              The rights, preferences and privileges, and qualifications,
         limitations and restrictions granted to and imposed on the shares of
         IOM Class Common Stock of the corporation shall be as set forth in this
         Division D.

                    (1)  No Right to Dividends. The holders of shares of IOM
              Class Common Stock shall not be entitled to receive dividends.

                    (2)  Voting Rights.

                         (a)  Election of Directors. The holders of shares of
                    IOM Class Common Stock shall have the right to elect four
                    members (the "IOM Directors") of the Board of Directors.
                    Each holder of shares of IOM Class Common Stock

                                       4
<PAGE>

                 shall have the right to one vote for each such share held in
                 the election of any of the IOM Directors.

                         (b)  Issues Pertaining to Core Rights. Each holder of
                 shares of IOM Class Common Stock shall have the right to one
                 vote for each such share held on Issues Pertaining to Core
                 Rights.

                         (c)  Other Matters. Except as otherwise provided in
                 Sections 2(a) and (b) of this Division D, each holder of shares
                 of IOM Class Common Stock shall have the right to one vote for
                 each such share held on each matter for which the vote of the
                 holders of the IOM Class Common Stock shall be required or
                 considered to be necessary.

                 (3)     Trading Rights. Each holder of shares of the IOM Class
           Common Stock shall have the trading rights, including trading floor
           access rights and privileges, set forth in the corporation's bylaws
           and rules for its Index and Option Market Division Members.

                 (4)     Liquidation Rights. Upon the dissolution and
           liquidation of the corporation, the holders of the IOM Class Common
           Stock shall be entitled in the aggregate to receive 69.73% of any
           assets available for distribution to the holders of Common Stock.

                                  Division E
                          GEM Class Common Stock and
                       Fractional GEM Class Common Stock

          The rights, preferences and privileges, and qualifications,
      limitations and restrictions granted to and imposed on the shares of the
      GEM Class Common Stock and the Fractional GEM Class Common Stock of the
      corporation shall be as set forth in this Division E.

                 (1)  No Right to Dividends. The holders of shares of GEM Class
          Common Stock and of Fractional GEM Class Common Stock shall not be
          entitled to receive dividends.

                 (2)  Voting Rights.

                      (a)  Election of Directors. The holders of shares of GEM
                 Class Common Stock and of Fractional GEM Class Common Stock
                 shall have the right, voting as a single class, to elect one
                 member (the "GEM Director") of the Board of Directors. Each
                 holder of shares of GEM Class Common Stock shall have the right
                 to one vote for each such share held and each holder of
                 Fractional GEM Class Common Stock shall have the right to one-
                 tenth vote for each such share held in the election of the GEM
                 Director.

                      (b)  Issues Pertaining to Core Rights. Each holder of
                 shares of GEM Class Common Stock shall have the right to one-
                 sixth vote for each such share held and each holder of shares
                 of Fractional GEM Class Common Stock shall


                                       5
<PAGE>

                 have the right to one-sixtieth vote for each such share held on
                 Issues Pertaining to Core Rights.


                      (c)  Other Matters. Except as otherwise provided in
                 Sections 2(a) and (b) of this Division E, each holder of shares
                 of GEM Class Common Stock shall have the right to one vote for
                 each such share held and each holder of shares of Fractional
                 GEM Class Common Stock shall have the right to one-tenth vote
                 for each such share held on each matter for which the vote of
                 the holders of the GEM Class Common Stock or of the Fractional
                 GEM Class Common Stock shall be required or considered to be
                 necessary.

                 (3)  Trading Rights. Each holder of shares of the GEM Class
             Common Stock or of the Fractional GEM Class Common Stock shall have
             the trading rights, including trading floor access rights and
             privileges, set forth in the corporation's bylaws and rules for its
             Growth and Emerging Markets Division Members.

                 (4)  Liquidation Rights. Upon the dissolution and liquidation
             of the corporation, the holders of the GEM Class Common Stock and
             of the Fractional GEM Class Common Stock together shall be entitled
             in the aggregate to receive 1.09% of any assets available for
             distribution to the holders of Common Stock. The assets as are
             available for distribution to the holders of the GEM Class Common
             Stock and Fractional GEM Class Common Stock shall be distributed
             among the holders thereof based upon the number of shares held
             (with each share of Fractional GEM Class Common Stock constituting
             one-tenth share of GEM Class Common Stock for such purpose).

                 (5)  Conversion Rights of Fractional GF.M Class Common Stock.

                      (a)  Conversion. Subject to and upon compliance with the
             provisions of this Section 5, each holder of any shares of
             Fractional GEM Class Common Stock shall have the right at such
             holder's option, at any time or from time to time prior to the
             close of business in Chicago, Illinois on November 3, 2000, to
             convert such shares of Fractional GEM Class Common Stock into fully
             paid and nonassessable shares of GEM Class Common Stock at the
             ratio of ten shares of Fractional GEM Class Common Stock for each
             share of GEM Class Common Stock to be received in conversion.
             Shares of Fractional GEM Class Common Stock may be converted into
             GEM Class Common Stock only in integral multiples of ten. No
             fractional shares of GEM Class Common Stock will be issued upon
             conversion.

                      (b)  Mechanics of Conversion. A holder of shares of
             Fractional GEM Class Common Stock may exercise the conversion right
             specified in Section 5(a) as to such holder's shares by
             surrendering to the corporation or any transfer agent of the
             corporation the certificate or certificates for the shares to be
             converted, accompanied by written notice stating that the holder
             elects to convert all of the shares represented thereby. Conversion
             shall be deemed to have been effected on the date when delivery of
             such written notice and share certificates is made, and such date
             is referred to herein as the Conversion Date. As promptly as
             practicable

                                       6
<PAGE>

          after the Conversion Date, the corporation shall issue and deliver to
          or upon the written order of such holder a certificate or certificates
          for the number of full shares of GEM Class Common Stock to which such
          holder is entitled as a result of the exercise of such conversion
          right. The person in whose name the certificate or certificates for
          GEM Class Common Stock are to be issued shall be deemed to have become
          a holder of record of such GEM Class Common Stock on the applicable
          Conversion Date.

               (c)  Status of Converted Shares. Shares of Fractional GEM Class
          Common Stock that are converted into shares of GEM Class Common Stock
          shall not be reissued.

     ARTICLE FIVE: (A) The Board of Directors shall consist of thirty-nine
members.

     (B)  At each annual meeting of stockholders (commencing with the annual
meeting to be held in December 2000), eighteen directors shall be elected as
follows:

          (1)  Six CME Directors shall be elected by the holders of CME Class
     Common Stock from a slate of candidates nominated in accordance with the
     nominating provisions provided in the corporation's bylaws;

          (2)  Four IMM Directors shall be elected by the holders of IMM Class
     Common Stock from a slate of candidates nominated in accordance with the
     nominating provisions provided in the corporation's bylaws;

          (3)  Two IOM Directors shall be elected by the holders of IOM Class
     Common Stock from a slate of candidates nominated in accordance with the
     nominating provisions provided in the corporation's bylaws; and

          (4)  Six directors (the "Appointed Directors") shall be elected by the
     holders of Common Stock, voting as a single class, from candidates
     nominated by the Chairman of the Board of Directors and approved by the
     Board of Directors.

     (D)  At each annual meeting of stockholders in an odd year (commencing with
the annual meeting to be held in December 2001), one GEM Director shall be
elected by the holders of GEM Class Common Stock and of Fractional GEM Class
Common Stock, voting as a single class, from a slate of candidates nominated in
accordance with the nominating provisions provided in the corporation's bylaws.

     (E)  Commencing with the annual meeting of stockholders to be held in
December 2000, each director shall be elected for a term expiring at the annual
meeting of stockholders held in the second year following the year of their
election, and until their successors are duly elected and qualified and have
accepted office, subject to death, resignation or removal from

                                       7
<PAGE>

office. Any vacancy occurring in a CME Directorship, an IMM Directorship, an IOM
Directorship or a GEM Directorship shall be filled from the candidates who lost
for such position in the most recent election, with the candidates being
selected to fill such vacancy in the order of the aggregate number of votes
received in such previous election. Any persons so elected shall serve for the
remaining term of his or her predecessor in office. Any vacancy occurring in an
Appointed Directorship may be filled by the Board of Directors from persons
nominated by the Chairman of the Board of Directors.

     (E)  No person shall be eligible for election as a CME Director, an IMM
Director, an IOM Director or a GEM Director unless he or she shall own, or be
recognized under rules adopted by the Board of Directors as a permitted
transferee (other than temporary lease-type transfers) of, at least one share of
the class of Common Stock entitled to elect such director.

     ARTICLE SIX: (A) In furtherance of and not in limitation of the powers
conferred by law, the Board of Directors is expressly authorized and empowered
to adopt, amend, or repeal the bylaws of the corporation.

     (B)  Unless and except to the extent that the by-laws of the corporation
shall so require, the election of directors of the corporation need not be by
written ballot.

     ARTICLE SEVEN: No stockholder shall have any preemptive right to subscribe
to an additional issue of any class or series of the corporation's capital stock
or to any securities of the corporation convertible into such stock.

     ARTICLE EIGHT: Notwithstanding anything contained in this Certificate of
Incorporation to the contrary, the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of
the voting power of the then outstanding Common Stock, voting together as a
single class, shall be required:

          (i)   to amend, repeal, or adopt any provisions of this Certificate of
     Incorporation;

          (ii)  to authorize or approve any merger, consolidation or sale of
     all, or substantially all, of the assets of the corporation; or

          (iii) to authorized or approve any dissolution and liquidation of the
     corporation.

     ARTICLE NINE: No director of the corporation shall be personally liable to
the corporation or its stockholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary
duty as a director, except for liability (i) for any breach of the director's
duty of loyalty to the corporation or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or
omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing
violation of law, (iii) under Section 174 of the General Corporation Law of the
State of Delaware, or (iv) for any transaction from which the director derived
an improper personal benefit. Any amendment or repeal of this Article by the
stockholders shall not adversely affect any right or protection of a director of
the corporation existing hereunder in respect of any act or omission occurring
prior to such amendment or repeal.

                                       8
<PAGE>

     ARTICLE TEN: The corporation shall, to the fullest extent permitted by
Section 145 of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, as the same
may be amended and supplemented, have the power to indemnify any and all persons
whom it shall have the power to indemnify under said Section from and against
any and all expenses, liabilities or other matters referred to in or covered by
said Section, and the power provided for herein shall not be deemed exclusive of
any other right to which those indemnified may be entitled under any bylaw,
agreement, or vote of stockholders, disinterested directors or otherwise, both
as to action in his or her official capacity and as to action in another
capacity while holding such office.

     ARTICLE ELEVEN: Special meetings of the stockholders, for any purpose or
purposes, unless otherwise prescribed by statute or by this Certificate of
Incorporation, shall be called by the Chairman of the Board or the Secretary at
the request in writing of (i) a majority of the directors then holding office or
(ii) 350 holders of shares of Common Stock. Any such written request shall state
the purpose or purposes of the proposed meeting.

                                       9

<PAGE>

                                              Exhibit 5.1
                                              Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
                                              Registration Statement on Form S-4


                                Sidley & Austin
                                Bank One Plaza
                            10 South Dearborn Plaza
                            Chicago, Illinois 60603

                                 April 6, 2000


 Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
 30 South Wacker Drive
 Chicago, Illinois 60606

            Re:  Registration Statement on Form S-4
                 Registration No. 333-95561
                 ----------------------------------

Ladies and Gentlemen:

            We are acting as special counsel to Chicago Mercantile Exchange
Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company"), in connection with the preparation
of a Registration Statement on Form S-4 (the "Registration Statement") filed by
the Company with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") under
the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"). The Registration
Statement relates to the issuance of (i) up to 25,855,200 shares of Class A
Common Stock, $.01 par value (the "Class A Common Stock"), and up to 5,118
shares of five series of Class B Common Stock, $.01 par value (collectively, the
"Recap Shares"), of the Company in connection with the recapitalization (the
"Recapitalization") of its outstanding capital stock pursuant to a Plan of
Recapitalization dated as of April 1, 2000 (the "Plan of Recapitalization")
following the merger of CME Transitory Co., a Delaware nonstock corporation
("Transitory"), with and into the Company pursuant to an Agreement and Plan of
Merger dated as of April 1, 2000 between the Company and Transitory and (ii) up
to 21,400 shares of Class A Common Stock and up to 214 shares of Class B Common
Stock, Series B-4, $.01 par value (collectively, the "Conversion Shares"),
issuable upon the conversion of the shares of Class B Common Stock, Series B-5,
$.01 par value (the "Series B-5 Stock"), of the Company issued in connection
with the Recapitalization.

            In rendering the opinions expressed in this opinion letter, we have
reviewed (a) the Registration Statement and the exhibits thereto, (b) the
Company's Certificate of Incorporation, including the proposed amendment and
restatement thereof in the form attached as Exhibit A to the proxy
statement/prospectus included in the Registration Statement (the "Charter
Restatement"), (c) the Company's By-Laws and (d) such statutes, records and
other documents that we have deemed to be relevant, and we have satisfied
ourselves as to such matters of fact as we have considered relevant and
necessary as a basis for this opinion letter.

            Based on the foregoing, we are of the opinion that:
<PAGE>

SIDLEY & AUSTIN                                                          CHICAGO


Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
April 6, 2000
Page 2


            (1)   The Company is a corporation duly incorporated, validly
       existing and in good standing under the laws of the State of Delaware.

            (2)   Upon the filing of a certificate of amendment to the Company's
       Certificate of Incorporation setting forth the Charter Restatement
       pursuant to the Plan of Recapitalization, the Recap Shares will be duly
       authorized. The Recap Shares, when issued upon the effectiveness of the
       Recapitalization in accordance with the terms of the Plan of
       Recapitalization, will be validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable,
       and the Conversion Shares, when issued upon the conversion of the shares
       of Series B-5 Stock in accordance with the terms of the Charter
       Restatement, will be validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.

            We hereby consent to the filing of this opinion letter with the
Commission as Exhibit 5.1 to the Registration Statement. We also consent to the
reference to our firm under the heading "Validity of Securities" in the
Registration Statement. In giving this consent, we do not thereby admit that we
are in the category of persons whose consent is required under Section 7 of the
Securities Act or the rules and regulations of the Commission.

            The foregoing opinions are limited to the General Corporation Law of
the State of Delaware and the federal laws of the United States of America. We
do not find it necessary for the purposes of the opinions expressed in this
opinion letter, and accordingly we do not purport to cover herein, the
application of the securities or "Blue Sky" laws of the various states to the
issuance of the Recap Shares or the Conversion Shares.


                                   Very truly yours,


                                   Sidley & Austin



<PAGE>

                                           Exhibit 8.1
                                           Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
                                           Registration Statement on Form S-4


                                Sidley & Austin
                                Bank One Plaza
                           10 South Dearborn Street
                            Chicago, Illinois 60603

                                 April 6, 2000


Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
30 South Wacker Drive
Chicago, Illinois 60606

Ladies and Gentlemen:

          We have acted as counsel to the Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc., a
Delaware corporation ("New CME") in connection with the proposed conversion of
the Chicago Mercantile Exchange, an Illinois not for profit corporation ("Old
CME"), from a not-for-profit membership corporation to a for-profit stock
corporation (the "demutualization"), as described in the Registration Statement
on Form S-4 (the "Registration Statement"), filed by New CME with the Securities
and Exchange Commission pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. The
Registration Statement includes the Proxy Statement/Prospectus (the
"Prospectus") relating to the dernutualization. Capitalized terms not defined
herein have the meanings specified in the Prospectus.

          As more fully described in the Prospectus, the dernutualization will
be effected in a three-step process. First, Old CUE will be merged into CME
Transitory Co. ("Transitory Co."), a newly formed, not for profit Delaware
corporation (the "First Merger"). Second, Transitory Co. will be merged into New
CME (the "Second Merger"). Third, the stock issued by New CME in the Second
Merger will be converted into Class A and Class B common stock of New CME in a
recapitalization (the "Recapitalization").

          In rendering the opinions expressed below, we have examined the
Prospectus and such other documents as we have deemed relevant and necessary,
including, without limitation, the forms of Certificate of Incorporation of New
CME, the Agreement and Plan of Merger between Old CME and Transitory Co., the
Agreement and Plan of Merger between Transitory Co. and New CME and the Plan of
Recapitalization of New CME. Such opinions are conditioned, among other things,
upon the accuracy and completeness of the facts, information and representations
contained in the Prospectus and such other documents as of the date hereof and
the continuing accuracy and completeness thereof as of the date of the
consummation of the dernutualization. We have assumed that the transactions
contemplated by the Prospectus and such other documents will occur as provided
therein and that there will be no material change to the Prospectus or any of
such other documents between the date hereof and the date of the consummation of
the dernutualization.
<PAGE>

SIDLEY & AUSTIN                                                          CHICAGO

Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
April 6, 2000
Page 2

          We have assumed the authenticity of all documents submitted to us as
originals, the genuineness of all signatures, the legal capacity of all natural
persons and the conformity with original documents of all copies submitted to us
for our examination. We have further assumed that: (i) the First Merger will
qualify as a statutory merger under the laws of the States of Delaware and of
Illinois, (ii) the Second Merger will qualify as a statutory merger under the
laws of the State of Delaware, (iii) Old CME will receive all of the rulings it
has requested from the Internal Revenue Service pursuant to its ruling request
submission dated December 30, 1999, as supplemented by letter dated March 17,
2000 (as supplemented, the "Ruling Request") or rulings having substantially
similar effect; and (iv) the written statements made by the executives of Old
CME contained in the Ruling Request are accurate in all respects as of the date
hereof and will continue to be accurate in all respects as of the consummation
of the dernutualization.

         In rendering the opinions expressed below, we have considered the
applicable provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the
"Code"), Regulations promulgated thereunder by the United States Treasury
Department (the "Regulations"), pertinent judicial authorities, rulings and
interpretations of the Internal Revenue Service and such other authorities as we
have considered relevant. It should be noted that the Code, the Regulations and
such judicial authorities, rulings, interpretations and other authorities are
subject to change at any time and, in some circumstances, with retroactive
effect; and any such change could affect the opinions stated herein.

          Based upon and subject to the foregoing, we are of the opinion that,
for federal income tax purposes:

          (i)    The First Merger and the Second Merger will each constitute a
     "reorganization" within the meaning of section 368(a)(1)(F) of the Code.

          (ii)   No gain or loss will be recognized by a member on the
     conversion, through the three-step dernutualization, of his or her
     membership interest in Old CME into Class A common stock and Class B common
     stock or Class B common stock only.

          (iii)  The aggregate basis of the shares of New CME received by a
     member in conversion of a membership interest will equal the basis of the
     membership interest. In the case of a member who receives both Class A
     common stock and Class B common stock, such basis will be allocated in
     proportion to the fair market value of each on the date of the
     dernutualization.

          (iv)   The holding period of the Class A common stock and Class B
     common stock received by a member in conversion of a membership interest
     will include the period for which the membership interest has been held,
     provided that such membership interest is held as a capital asset on the
     date of the conversion.
<PAGE>

SIDLEY & AUSTIN                                                          CHICAGO

Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
April 6, 2000
Page 3


          (v)    No gain or loss will be recognized by Old CME as a result of
     the transfer of its assets to New CME and the assumption by New CME of the
     liabilities of Old CME.

          Based upon and subject to the foregoing, we are also of the opinion
that the discussion set forth in the Prospectus under the caption
"Demutualization Proposal--Federal Income Tax Consequences" constitutes, in all
material respects, a fair and accurate summary of the matters addressed therein,
based upon current law and the assumptions stated or referred to therein.

          Except as expressly set forth above, you have not requested, and we do
not herein express, any opinion concerning the tax consequences of, or any other
matters related to, the demutualization.

          We assume no obligation to update or supplement this letter to reflect
any facts or circumstances which may hereafter come to our attention with
respect to the opinions expressed above, including any changes in applicable law
which may hereafter occur.

          We hereby consent to the filing of this letter as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement and to all references to our Firm included in or made a
part of the Registration Statement.


                                   Very truly yours,




                                   Sidley & Austin

<PAGE>

                                              Exhibit 10.17
                                              Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
                                              Registration Statement on Form S-4

                    THIRD AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT
                    ---------------------------------------


     Reference is hereby made to the Employment Agreement entered into between
the CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE ("CME") and FREDERICK ARDITTI ("Arditti") on
October 27, 1998 ("Agreement").  This Third Amendment supercedes the prior First
and Second Amendments.

     The Agreement is hereby amended as follows:

1.   Subparagraph c of Paragraph 5. - Payment Upon Termination or Expiration.
     -----------------------------------------------------------------------

     Subparagraph c of Paragraph 5 is hereby deleted and replaced in its
     entirety with the following provision.

     In the event of termination by Arditti pursuant to Paragraph 4.d of this
     Agreement, and provided that such termination does not take place prior to
     April 1, 2000, the CME shall:

     (i)    pay Arditti, within thirty days of such termination, a lump sum
            payment, in cash, of $640,385, less appropriate withholding
            representing: (A) Arditti's base salary for a one (1) year period
            following such termination (the "Continuation Period"); and (B)
            Arditti's accrued and unused vacation days as of his date of
            termination. No vacation shall accrue during the Continuation
            Period.
     (ii)   pay Arditti, within thirty days of such termination, a lump sum
            payment, in cash, equal to his then-current non-vested amounts in
            the following plans: Tax Efficient Savings Plan (401K Plan); Pension
            for Employees of the Chicago Mercantile Exchange; Senior Management
            Supplemental Deferred Savings Plan; and Supplemental Executive
            Retirement Plan, less appropriate withholding deductions.
     (iii)  during the Continuation Period, provide Arditti and any covered
            dependents with continued coverage under the CME's health, dental
            and vision insurance program in effect for active employees;
            provided, however, that effective at the end of the Continuation
            Period, health, dental and vision insurance benefits will be
            provided to Arditti and any covered dependents pursuant to the
            Consolidated Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act ("COBRA"), as set
            forth in Section 4980B of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as
            amended, and in Sections 601 through 609 of the Employee Retirement
            Income Security Act. Arditti's contribution and the CME's
            contribution toward the cost of the foregoing
<PAGE>

            coverages shall be determined and paid as though Arditti's
            employment with the CME continued through the end of the
            Continuation Period. The foregoing insurance coverages will earlier
            terminate upon Arditti obtaining other employment which offers
            comparable health insurance coverage and when he first becomes
            eligible for such coverage. Arditti agrees that he will promptly
            notify the CME upon obtaining such coverage from another employer.
            Arditti shall have no duty to seek or obtain other employment.
     (iv)   during the Continuation Period, and subject to CME's discretion,
            either reimburse Arditti for the cost of converting the life and
            accidental death and dismemberment insurance programs referred to in
            the Agreement in effect on the date of Arditti's termination to
            individual coverage, or obtaining equivalent coverage individually,
            or, where applicable, continuing individual coverage already in
            place. It is understood and agreed that Arditti's coverage under the
            CME's disability insurance plan will cease on the date of Arditti's
            termination and that the CME has no obligation to provide or pay for
            other disability coverage. The CME will cooperate with Arditti,
            (e.g., providing documentation) in his efforts to obtain at his
             ----
            expense individual disability coverage.

2.   Paragraph 21. - Mutual General Releases.
     ---------------------------------------

     A new paragraph 21 is hereby added as follows:

     Mutual General Releases.  Except for a claim based upon an alleged breach
     -----------------------
     of this Amendment or Section 7, 9 and 10 of the Agreement, Arditti, for
     himself and for his estate, heirs, personal representatives, executors,
     administrators and assigns, hereby releases and forever discharges the CME,
     any parent, subsidiaries and related and affiliated entities, and each of
     its and their officers, directors, representatives, agents, employees,
     related and participating members, insurers, as well as each of its and
     their respective estates, heirs, personal representatives, executors,
     administrators, successors and assigns (hereinafter collectively and
     individually the "CME Releasees"), and the CME Releasees hereby release and
     forever discharge Arditti, his estate, heirs, personal representatives,
     executors, administrators and assigns, from any and all rights, claims,
     demands, debts, dues, sums of money, accounts, attorneys' fees, complaints,
     judgments, executions, actions and causes of action of any nature
     whatsoever, cognizable at law or equity, past, present or future, which
     either party now has or claims, or might hereafter have or claim, against
     the other party, based upon or arising out of any matter or thing
     whatsoever from the beginning of the world through the date of this
     Amendment, including, without limitation, any claim, action or cause of
     action which was or is related to or arises out of Arditti's employment
     with the CME, or his separation and/or resignation therefrom, or which is
     based upon or arises under this Agreement, or any local, state, or federal
     law dealing with employment, including without limitation Title VII of the
     Civil Rights Act of 1964, the Americans with Disabilities Act and the Age
     Discrimination in
<PAGE>

     Employment Act, the Illinois Human Rights Act, ERISA or any common law tort
     or contract claim.

     The following provisions are applicable to and made a part of this
Agreement and the foregoing general release and waiver:

               (i)    Arditti does not release and waive any right or claim
     which he may have under the Age Discrimination in Employment Act which
     arises after the date of execution of this Third Amendment.

               (ii)   In exchange for this general release and waiver, Arditti
     hereby acknowledges that he has received separate consideration beyond that
     which he is otherwise entitled to under the CME policy, this Agreement, or
     applicable law.

               (iii)  CME hereby expressly advises Arditti to consult with an
     attorney of his choosing prior to executing this Third Amendment which
     contains a general release and waiver.

               (iv)   Arditti has twenty-one (21) days from the date of
     presentment to consider whether or not to execute this Third Amendment. In
     the event of such execution, Arditti has a further period of seven (7) days
     from such date in which to revoke said execution, notice of which must be
     received by Craig Donohue of the CME within such seven (7) day period.

          A new paragraph 22 is hereby added as follows:

          Paragraph 22. - The parties agree and acknowledge that this Amendment
          ------------
     shall never be construed as an admission by either of them of any
     liability, wrongdoing, or responsibility on their part.

          A new paragraph 23 is hereby added as follows:

          Paragraph 23. - The parties agree that they shall not disclose the
          ------------
     existence of terms of this Agreement to any third party except that: (i)
     with respect to Arditti, his accountants, attorneys and spouse, each of
     whom shall be bound as a condition of this Amendment by this
     confidentiality provision or as may be required to comply with legal
     process, and (ii) with respect to CME in the normal course of its business
     reporting, or as may be required to comply with legal process and reporting
     requirements.

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Agreement as of the date
set forth below.

CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE
<PAGE>

By:   ________________________________
      Scott Gordon, Chairman
Date: March 3, 2000


By:   ________________________________
      Frederick Arditti
Date: March 3, 2000

<PAGE>

                                              Exhibit 10.18
                                              Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
                                              Registration Statement on Form S-4

                   SEPARATION AGREEMENT AND GENERAL RELEASE
                   ----------------------------------------


          THIS SEPARATION AGREEMENT and GENERAL RELEASE (hereinafter
"Agreement") is made and entered into by and between GERALD D. BEYER
(hereinafter "Beyer") and THE CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE, however constituted
or organized, and its successors or assigns (hereinafter collectively referred
to as "CME"), an Illinois not-for-profit corporation.

          WHEREAS, the parties have engaged in discussions resulting in an
amicable and mutually satisfactory agreement concerning Beyer's resignation from
his employment with CME or any related entity, and all matters arising out of or
relating thereto;

          NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants and promises
set forth below, the parties hereby agree as follows:

          1.  The Employment Agreement.  Beyer and CME are parties to an
              ------------------------
"Agreement" dated April 12, 1996, and amended December 10, 1999, with a term
extending through April 12, 2001 (hereinafter "Employment Agreement"). Except
for the obligations set forth in Paragraphs 6, 8, and 9 thereof, which shall
continue, or except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement, the terms
and provisions of this Agreement shall supersede the terms and provisions of the
Employment Agreement, which is terminated effective April 12, 2000, and shall
thereafter be null and void and without further effect. In the event of any
conflict or inconsistency between this Agreement and the Employment Agreement,
the terms of this Agreement shall take precedence.
<PAGE>

          2.  Beyer's Resignation.  Beyer has resigned his employment with CME
              -------------------
and all of the Released parties, and his position on all committee and boards
effective April 12, 2000.  However, Beyer shall provide reasonable transition
assistance and cooperation for a reasonable period of time in light of his
ability to obtain full time employment elsewhere with respect to his former
duties to CME after that date.  During his employment through April 12, 2000,
Beyer shall continue to receive all compensation, as well as insurance,
vacation, fringe, pension and retirement benefits due to him under and pursuant
to the terms of the Employment Agreement; it being understood that Beyer shall
be allowed reasonable time to pursue other employment opportunities and he will
be on vacation from March 27, 2000 until April 4, 2000.  Beyer acknowledges that
he has reviewed and approved the announcement of his resignation prepared by CME
as set forth in Exhibit A attached hereto, and distributed on or about March 21,
2000.

          3.  The Obligations of CME.  Upon the Resignation Date, and in
              ----------------------
consideration of the promises of Beyer contained in this Agreement, CME shall be
obligated to Beyer as set forth herein.  Except as expressly set forth in this
Agreement, CME shall have no obligation to Beyer of any kind or nature
whatsoever.  On or before May 1, 2000, and provided that this Agreement is not
revoked pursuant to Section 8(iii) of this Agreement CME shall pay to Beyer as
severance pay the sum of One Million Dollars ($1,000,000) less applicable
federal and state withholding deductions.  It is understood that the sum
satisfies CME's obligations for Beyer's accrued and unused vacation as of April
12, 2000 and Beyer acknowledges that no additional sums are due with respect to
vacation.  It is further understood that no additional sums are due or owed to
Beyer for future or past bonuses, severance pay under any plan or policy or for
any other form of compensation except as provided in Paragraph 7 below.  It is
further understood that should Beyer revoke or not sign this Agreement, he has
and shall be offered the

                                       2
<PAGE>

position of Executive Consultant to CME's Chief Executive Officer as previously
discussed with him.

          4.  Business Expenses.  On or before April 12, 2000, CME shall pay to
              -----------------
Beyer, in a single lump sum, an amount equal to all reimbursements which Beyer
has or may claim with respect to business and transportation expenses incurred
by him on behalf of CME through April 12, 2000 in accordance with CME's
policies.  There shall be no reimbursement of Beyer for any other business and
transportation expenses incurred by him after April 12, 2000 except as provided
in Paragraph 9 of the Employment Agreement.

          5.  In the event of Beyer's death prior to receipt of any payments to
be made to him hereunder, such payment shall be made to his estate.

          6.  Insurance Continuation.  Effective May 1, 2000 Beyer shall be
              ----------------------
eligible to participate in CME's health, dental and vision insurance plans in
accordance with the terms of such plans for former employees pursuant to the
Consolidated Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act ("COBRA"), at his cost.  Such
coverages will terminate upon Beyer obtaining other employment which offers
comparable insurance coverage and when he first becomes eligible for such
coverage.  Beyer agrees that he will promptly notify CME upon obtaining such
coverage.  Beyer shall have no duty to seek or obtain other employment.

          7.  Beyer shall be eligible for payments, benefits and any rollover or
other options available under CME's Pension Plan for Employees, the Tax
Efficient Savings Plan, the SMSDSP, and the Supplemental Executive Retirement
Plan in accordance with the terms and restrictions as applicable to him
consistent with an employment termination date of April 12, 2000.  In addition
his eligibility for benefits under all other insurance and other benefit plans,
if

                                       3
<PAGE>

any, shall be determined in accordance with the terms and restrictions of such
plans as applicable to him consistent with an employment termination date of
April 12, 2000.

          8.  Mutual General Releases and Indemnification.  Except for a claim
              -------------------------------------------
based upon an alleged breach of this Agreement, Beyer, for himself and for
anyone claiming through him, including his estate, heirs, personal
representatives, executors, administrators, agents and assigns, hereby releases,
forever discharges and agrees not to sue CME, any parent, subsidiaries and
related and affiliated entities, and each of its and their officers, directors,
representatives, agents, employees, related and participating members, insurers,
as well as each of its and their respective estates, heirs, personal
representatives, executors, administrators, successors and assigns (hereinafter
collectively and individually the "CME Releasees"), and CME, its parents,
subsidiaries and related and affiliated entities, hereby releases, forever
discharges, and agrees not to sue Beyer, his estate, heirs, personal
representatives, executors, administrators, agents and assigns, from any and all
rights, claims, demands, debts, dues, sums of money, accounts, attorneys' fees,
complaints, judgments, executions, actions and causes of action of any nature
whatsoever, cognizable at law or equity, past, present or future, which either
party now has or claims, or might hereafter have or claim, against the other
party, based upon or arising out of any matter or thing whatsoever from the date
of Beyer's initial employment with CME through the date of this release,
including, without limitation, any claim, action or cause of action which was or
is related to or arises out of Beyer's employment with CME, or his separation
and/or resignation therefrom, or which is based upon or arises under the
Employment Agreement, or any local, state or federal law dealing with employment
discrimination, including, without limitation, Title VII of the Civil Rights Act
of 1964, as amended, the Civil Rights Act of 1991, the Americans with
Disabilities Act, the Age Discrimination in Employment Act, the Illinois

                                       4
<PAGE>

Human Rights Act, the Chicago Human Rights Ordinance or any common law tort,
contract or other claim. CME further agrees to fully indemnify and hold Beyer
harmless for any claims by any individual or entity against Beyer relating to
Beyer's actions or omissions while employed by CME, as provided in CME's by-
laws.

          The following provisions are applicable to and made a part of this
Agreement and the foregoing general release and waiver.

     (i)   In exchange for this general release and waiver, Beyer hereby
           acknowledges that he has received separate consideration beyond that
           which he is otherwise entitled to under any CME policy or program,
           the Employment Agreement, or applicable law.

     (ii)  CME hereby expressly advises Beyer to consult with an attorney of his
           choosing prior to executing this Agreement which contains a general
           release and waiver and Beyer acknowledges that he has consulted with
           an attorney of his choice.

     (iii) Beyer has twenty-one (21) days from the date of presentment to
           consider whether or not to execute this Agreement. In the event of
           such execution, Beyer has a further period of seven (7) days from
           such date in which to revoke said execution, notice of which must be
           received by CME within such seven (7) day period.

               9.  Non-Disparagement. Beyer represents that he has not and will
                   -----------------
not, nor will he cause or assist another person to, disparage or make defamatory
statements about CME or the other CME Released Parties to any third parties. CME
represents that its present executive officers and present officers of CME's
Board of Directors have not and will not cause or assist another person to
disparage or make defamatory statements about Beyer to any third parties.

                                       5
<PAGE>

CME agrees that any reference it provides to prospective employers of Beyer or
other third parties shall be in substantial conformity with the provisions of
this Paragraph 6 and in the form of Exhibit B, attached hereto and incorporated
herein.

          10.  Confidentiality of Agreement.   The parties agree that this
               ----------------------------
Agreement and all of its terms and provisions are strictly confidential, and
shall not be divulged or disclosed in any way to any person other than their
legal counsel, tax or financial advisors, to Beyer's spouse, pursuant to lawful
subpoena or similar legal process, and with respect to CME in the course of
customary business reporting or making disclosures required by law.  Should
either party choose to divulge the terms and conditions of this Agreement to his
or its legal counsel or Beyer's spouse, tax or financial advisor he or it shall
insure that they will be similarly bound to protect its confidentiality and that
a breach of this Paragraph by such party's legal counsel or Beyer's spouse, tax
or financial advisor shall be considered a breach of this Paragraph by such
party.

          11.  The Obligations of Beyer.  In consideration of the promises of
               ------------------------
CME contained in this Agreement, and other good and valuable consideration, the
receipt and sufficiency of which is hereby acknowledged, Beyer, in addition to
the mutual promises contained in Paragraphs 5, 6 and 7 herein, hereby agrees to
abide by the obligations contained in Paragraphs 6, 8 and 9 of the Employment
Agreement.

          12.  Effective Date.  The Effective Date of this Agreement shall be
               --------------
the eighth day after Beyer's execution of this Agreement without receipt by CME
of a signed statement from Beyer revoking such execution.  All obligations of
the parties contained in this Agreement shall, in addition to any other express
requirement, be conditioned upon and shall not be effective until the Effective
Date of this Agreement as defined in this Paragraph.

                                       6
<PAGE>

          13.  Arbitration.  Any controversy or claim arising out of or relating
               -----------
to this Agreement shall be resolved in accordance with the procedures contained
in Paragraph 7 of the Employment Agreement.

          14.  Binding Effect.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure
               --------------
to the benefit of the heirs, assigns, administrators, executors, and legal
representatives of Beyer, and shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of
the CME Releasees.  Both parties represent that they have all necessary legal
authority to execute this Agreement.

          15.  Entire Agreement.  This instrument constitutes the entire
               ----------------
Agreement between the parties.  It may not be amended or modified except by a
subsequent written instrument signed by both parties hereto.

          16.  Governing Law.  This Agreement shall be construed in accordance
               -------------
with the laws of the State of Illinois.

          17   Counterparts.  This Agreement may be signed in multiple
               ------------
counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original for all purposes.

          18.  Acknowledgement.  Beyer acknowledges that he has carefully read
               ---------------
and fully understands the terms and provisions of this Separation Agreement and
General Release, has been represented in this matter by counsel of his own
choosing, and that his execution of this Separation Agreement and General
Release is voluntary.  The parties agree that the language used in this
Agreement is the language chosen by the parties to express their mutual intent,
and that no rule of strict construction is to be applied to or against any party
hereto.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Agreement on the date(s) set
forth below.

THE CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE

                                       7
<PAGE>

By:_____________________________          ______________________________________
                                          Gerald D. Beyer


Title:__________________________          Date:_________________________________

Date:___________________________


                                       8
<PAGE>

                                   EXHIBIT A

                            [FOR GORDON LETTERHEAD]

                               March _____, 2000

To All members and CME Staff:

Please be advised that Jerry Beyer, our Executive Vice President and Chief
Operating Officer, has resigned from the Exchange, effective April 12/th/.

Jerry has been an important contributor to the success of the CME in the last
two decades, having first started at the Exchange in 1979. During his career
here, Jerry held the positions of In-house Counsel, Vice President, Legal,
Senior Vice President, Legal & Regulatory Affairs, Executive Vice President and
Chief Financial Officer, Executive Vice President & Chief Administrative
Officer, and Executive Vice President & Chief Operating Officer. His breadth of
experience, and his familiarity with virtually every facet of our operations,
has benefited us greatly over the years.

In addition to his many responsibilities, Jerry set the standard for service to
our membership, acting as the principal liaison between the membership and the
staff.  Throughout his career at the CME, Jerry worked tirelessly to balance the
competing demands of the various constituencies at the Exchange.  His ability to
work well with members and staff, and his ability to reach consensus on complex
issues, has helped us through many difficult times.  I am particularly grateful
to Jerry for his longstanding and unwavering commitment to the CME and for his
exemplary work ethic.

Please join us in wishing Jerry tremendous success in his future endeavors.

(Scott's signature - first name only)

                                       9

<PAGE>

                                         Exhibit 10.19
                                         Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
                                         Registration Statement on Form S-4

                   SEPARATION AGREEMENT AND GENERAL RELEASE
                   ----------------------------------------


          THIS SEPARATION AGREEMENT and GENERAL RELEASE (hereinafter
"Agreement") is made and entered into by and between WILLIAM W. JENKS
(hereinafter "Jenks") and THE CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE, however constituted
or organized, and its successors or assigns (hereinafter collectively referred
to as "CME"), an Illinois not-for-profit corporation.

          WHEREAS, the parties have engaged in discussions resulting in an
amicable and mutually satisfactory agreement concerning Jenks' resignation from
his employment with CME or any related entity, and all matters arising out of or
relating thereto;

          NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants and promises
set forth below, the parties hereby agree as follows:

          1.  The Employment Agreement. Jenks and CME are parties to an
"Agreement" dated July 17, 1998, with a term extending though June 30, 2000
(hereinafter "Employment Agreement"). Except for the obligations set forth in
Paragraphs 6, 8, and 9 thereof, which shall continue, or except as otherwise
expressly provided in this Agreement, the terms and provisions of this Agreement
shall supersede the terms and provisions of the Employment Agreement, which is
terminated effective March 24, 2000, and shall thereafter be null and void and
without further effect. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between
this Agreement and the Employment Agreement, the terms of this Agreement shall
take precedence.
<PAGE>

          2.  Jenks' Resignation. Jenks has resigned his employment with CME and
all of the Released parties, and his position on all committee and boards
effective March 24, 2000. However, Jenks shall provide reasonable transition
assistance and cooperation with respect to his former duties to CME after that
date. Jenks acknowledges that he has reviewed and approved the announcement of
his resignation prepared by CME as set forth in Exhibit A attached hereto, and
distributed on or about March 21, 2000.

          3.  The Obligations of CME. Upon the Resignation Date, and in
consideration of the promises of Jenks contained in this Agreement, CME shall be
obligated to Jenks as set forth herein. Except as expressly set forth in this
Agreement, CME shall have no obligation to Jenks of any kind or nature
whatsoever. Promptly after the eighth day on which Jenks signs this Agreement,
and provided that this Agreement is not revoked pursuant to Section 8(iii) CME
shall pay to Jenks as severance pay the sum of one hundred-eight thousand, seven
hundred and fifty dollars ($108,750.00) less applicable federal and state
withholding deductions. It is understood that the sum satisfies CME's
obligations for Jenks' accrued and unused vacation as of March 24, 2000 and
Jenks acknowledges that no sums are due with respect to vacation. It is further
understood that no additional sums are due or owed to Jenks for future or past
bonuses, severance pay under any plan or policy or for any other form of
compensation.

          4.  Business Expenses. On or before March 31, 2000, CME shall pay to
Jenks, in a single lump sum, an amount equal to all reasonable reimbursements
which Jenks has or may claim with respect to business and transportation
expenses incurred by him on behalf of CME through March 24, 2000 in accordance
with CME's policies. There shall be no reimbursement of Jenks for any other
business and transportation expenses incurred by him after March 24, 2000.

                                       2
<PAGE>

          5.  In the event of Jenks' death prior to receipt of the payment to be
made to him hereunder, such payment shall be made to his estate.

          6.  Insurance Continuation. Effective April 1, 2000 Jenks shall be
eligible to participate in CME's health, dental and vision insurance plans in
accordance with the terms of such plans for former employees pursuant to the
Consolidated Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act ("COBRA"), at his cost. Such
coverages will terminate upon Jenks obtaining other employment which offers
comparable insurance coverage and when he first becomes eligible for such
coverage. Jenks agrees that he will promptly notify CME upon obtaining such
coverage. Jenks shall have no duty to seek or obtain other employment.

          7.  Benefits. Jenks shall be eligible for benefits under CME's Pension
Plan for Employees, the Tax Efficient Savings Plan, the SMSDSP, and the
Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan in accordance with the terms and
restrictions of such plans with respect to terminated employees as of March 24,
2000. In addition his eligibility for benefits under all other insurance and
other benefit plans, if any, shall be determined in accordance with the terms of
such plans for terminated employees as of March 24, 2000.

          8.  Mutual General Releases and Indemnification. Except for a claim
based upon an alleged breach of this Agreement, Jenks, for himself and for
anyone claiming through him, including his estate, heirs, personal
representatives, executors, administrators, agents and assigns, hereby releases,
forever discharges and agrees not to sue CME, any parent, subsidiaries and
related and affiliated entities, and each of its and their officers, directors,
representatives, agents, employees, related and participating members, insurers,
as well as each of its and their respective estates, heirs, personal
representatives, executors, administrators, successors and assigns (hereinafter
collectively and individually the "CME Releasees"), and CME hereby

                                       3
<PAGE>

releases, forever discharges, and agrees not to sue Jenks, his estate, heirs,
personal representatives, executors, administrators, agents and assigns, from
any and all rights, claims, demands, debts, dues, sums of money, accounts,
attorneys' fees, complaints, judgments, executions, actions and causes of action
of any nature whatsoever, cognizable at law or equity, past, present or future,
which either party now has or claims, or might hereafter have or claim, against
the other party, based upon or arising out of any matter or thing whatsoever
from the date of this world through the date of this release, including, without
limitation, any claim, action or cause of action which was or is related to or
arises out of Jenks' employment with CME, or his separation and/or resignation
therefrom, or which is based upon or arises under the Employment Agreement, or
any local, state or federal law dealing with employment discrimination,
including, without limitation, Title VII of the Civil Rights Act of 1964, as
amended, the Civil Rights Act of 1991, the Americans with Disabilities Act, the
Age Discrimination in Employment Act, the Illinois Human Rights Act, the Chicago
Human Rights Ordinance or any common law tort, contract or other claim. CME
further agrees to fully indemnify and hold Jenks harmless for any claims by any
individual or entity against Jenks relating to Jenks' actions or omissions while
employed by CME, as provided in CME's by-laws.

          The following provisions are applicable to and made a part of this
Agreement and the foregoing general release and waiver.

(i)    In exchange for this general release and waiver, Jenks hereby
       acknowledges that he has received separate consideration beyond that
       which he is otherwise entitled to under any CME policy or program, the
       Employment Agreement, or applicable law.

                                       4
<PAGE>

(ii)   CME hereby expressly advises Jenks to consult with an attorney of his
       choosing prior to executing this Agreement which contains a general
       release and waiver and Jenks acknowledges that he has consulted with an
       attorney of his choice.

(iii)  Jenks has twenty-one (21) days from the date of presentment to consider
       whether or not to execute this Agreement. In the event of such execution,
       Jenks has a further period of seven (7) days from such date in which to
       revoke said execution, notice of which must be received by CME within
       such seven (7) day period.

          9.  Non-Disparagement. Jenks represents that he has not and will not,
nor will he cause or assist another person to, disparage or make defamatory
statements about CME or the other CME Released Parties to any third parties. CME
represents that its executive officers have not and will not cause or assist
another person to disparage or make defamatory statements about Jenks to any
third parties.

          10.  Confidentiality of Agreement. The parties agree that this
Agreement and all of its terms and provisions are strictly confidential, and
shall not be divulged or disclosed in any way to any person other than their
legal counsel, tax or financial advisors, to Jenks' spouse, pursuant to lawful
subpoena, and with respect to CME in the course of customary business reporting
or making disclosures required by law. Should either party choose to divulge the
terms and conditions of this Agreement to his or its legal counsel or Jenks'
spouse, tax or financial advisor he or it shall insure that they will be
similarly bound to protect its confidentiality and that a breach of this
Paragraph by such party's legal counsel or Jenks' spouse, tax or financial
advisor shall be considered a breach of this Paragraph by such party.

                                       5
<PAGE>

          11.  The Obligations of Jenks.  In consideration of the promises of
CME contained in this Agreement, and other good and valuable consideration, the
receipt and sufficiency of which is hereby acknowledged, Jenks, in addition to
the mutual promises contained in this Agreement, hereby agrees to abide by the
obligations contained in Paragraphs 6, 8 and 9 of the Employment Agreement.
Further, with the exception of Maureen Graszer, Administrative Assistant to
Jenks, Jenks agrees not to solicit, suggest or encourage anyone employed by CME
to leave his or her employment with CME for a period of time commencing with the
Effective Date of this Agreement and for two (2) years thereafter.

          12.  Effective Date.  The Effective Date of this Agreement shall be
the eighth day after Jenks' execution of this Agreement without receipt by CME
of a signed statement from Jenks revoking such execution.  All obligations of
the parties contained in this Agreement shall, in addition to any other express
requirement, be conditioned upon and shall not be effective until the Effective
Date of this Agreement as defined in this Paragraph.

          13.  Arbitration.  Any controversy or claim arising out of or relating
to this Agreement shall be resolved in accordance with the procedures contained
in Paragraph 7 of the Employment Agreement.

          14.  Binding Effect.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure
to the benefit of the heirs, assigns, administrators, executors, and legal
representatives of Jenks, and shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of
the CME Releasees.  Both parties represent that they have all necessary legal
authority to execute this Agreement.

          15.  Entire Agreement.  This instrument constitutes the entire
Agreement between the parties.  It may not be amended or modified except by a
subsequent written instrument signed by both parties hereto.

                                       6
<PAGE>

          16.  Governing Law.  This Agreement shall be construed in accordance
with the laws of the State of Illinois.

          17   Counterparts.  This Agreement may be signed in multiple
counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original for all purposes.

          18.  Acknowledgement.  Jenks acknowledges that he has carefully read
and fully understands the terms and provisions of this Separation Agreement and
General Release, has been represented in this matter by counsel of his own
choosing, and that his execution of this Separation Agreement and General
Release is voluntary.  The parties agree that the language used in this
Agreement is the language chosen by the parties to express their mutual intent,
and that no rule of strict construction is to be applied to or against any party
hereto.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Agreement on the date(s) set
forth below.

THE CHICAGO MERCANTILE EXCHANGE

By:  /s/ James J. McNulty             /s/ William W. Jenks
     --------------------             --------------------
                                      William W. Jenks

Title: President and CEO              Date: 3-21-00

Date: March 21, 2000

                                       7
<PAGE>

                                                                       EXHIBIT A

                     [FOR JOINT GORDON/MCNULTY LETTERHEAD]

                                March ___, 2000

To All Members and CME Staff:

Bill Jenks, our Executive Vice President and Chief Information Officer, will be
leaving the Exchange, effective March 24, to join Heller Financial, Inc. as
Executive Vice President and Chief Information Officer.

Bill joined us in mid-1997 as our Senior Vice President and Chief Information
Officer, and he was promoted to Executive Vice President for Management
Information Systems in 1998.  He brought to the Exchange his many years of
experience in the aerospace and technology industries.  During his tenure he has
overseen our intensive and successful Y2K efforts, the introduction and
continued enhancement of our GLOBEX(R)2 electronic trading system, the
development and introduction of our innovative GALAX-C(TM) hand-held device, the
successful deployment of our CUBS\2\ system, and much more.

Technology has been among our highest priorities, and Bill has worked diligently
to ensure that the CME has continued to lead the industry in technological
innovation.

Please join us in wishing Bill success as he takes on his new role at Heller
Financial.

(Scott's signature - first name only)        (Jim's signature - first name only)

                                       8

<PAGE>

                                              Exhibit 23.2
                                              Chicago Mercantile Exchange Inc.
                                              Registration Statement on Form S-4

To the Board of Directors and Members
of the Chicago Mercantile Exchange:


As independent public accountants, we hereby consent to the use of our report
(and to all references to our Firm) included in or made a part of the
registration statement on Form S-4, Amendment No. 3 to Registration Statement
No. 333-95561.



                                                        /s/ Arthur Andersen LLP
                                                        ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
Chicago, Illinois
April 6, 2000


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission